// Code generated by private/model/cli/gen-api/main.go. DO NOT EDIT. package iam import ( "fmt" "time" "github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws" "github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awsutil" "github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/request" "github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/private/protocol" "github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/private/protocol/query" ) const opAddClientIDToOpenIDConnectProvider = "AddClientIDToOpenIDConnectProvider" // AddClientIDToOpenIDConnectProviderRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the AddClientIDToOpenIDConnectProvider operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See AddClientIDToOpenIDConnectProvider for more information on using the AddClientIDToOpenIDConnectProvider // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the AddClientIDToOpenIDConnectProviderRequest method. // req, resp := client.AddClientIDToOpenIDConnectProviderRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/AddClientIDToOpenIDConnectProvider func (c *IAM) AddClientIDToOpenIDConnectProviderRequest(input *AddClientIDToOpenIDConnectProviderInput) (req *request.Request, output *AddClientIDToOpenIDConnectProviderOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opAddClientIDToOpenIDConnectProvider, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &AddClientIDToOpenIDConnectProviderInput{} } output = &AddClientIDToOpenIDConnectProviderOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Remove(query.UnmarshalHandler) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBackNamed(protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // AddClientIDToOpenIDConnectProvider API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Adds a new client ID (also known as audience) to the list of client IDs already // registered for the specified IAM OpenID Connect (OIDC) provider resource. // // This action is idempotent; it does not fail or return an error if you add // an existing client ID to the provider. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation AddClientIDToOpenIDConnectProvider for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInput" // The request was rejected because an invalid or out-of-range value was supplied // for an input parameter. // // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/AddClientIDToOpenIDConnectProvider func (c *IAM) AddClientIDToOpenIDConnectProvider(input *AddClientIDToOpenIDConnectProviderInput) (*AddClientIDToOpenIDConnectProviderOutput, error) { req, out := c.AddClientIDToOpenIDConnectProviderRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // AddClientIDToOpenIDConnectProviderWithContext is the same as AddClientIDToOpenIDConnectProvider with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See AddClientIDToOpenIDConnectProvider for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) AddClientIDToOpenIDConnectProviderWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *AddClientIDToOpenIDConnectProviderInput, opts ...request.Option) (*AddClientIDToOpenIDConnectProviderOutput, error) { req, out := c.AddClientIDToOpenIDConnectProviderRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opAddRoleToInstanceProfile = "AddRoleToInstanceProfile" // AddRoleToInstanceProfileRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the AddRoleToInstanceProfile operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See AddRoleToInstanceProfile for more information on using the AddRoleToInstanceProfile // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the AddRoleToInstanceProfileRequest method. // req, resp := client.AddRoleToInstanceProfileRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/AddRoleToInstanceProfile func (c *IAM) AddRoleToInstanceProfileRequest(input *AddRoleToInstanceProfileInput) (req *request.Request, output *AddRoleToInstanceProfileOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opAddRoleToInstanceProfile, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &AddRoleToInstanceProfileInput{} } output = &AddRoleToInstanceProfileOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Remove(query.UnmarshalHandler) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBackNamed(protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // AddRoleToInstanceProfile API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Adds the specified IAM role to the specified instance profile. An instance // profile can contain only one role, and this limit cannot be increased. // // The caller of this API must be granted the PassRole permission on the IAM // role by a permission policy. // // For more information about roles, go to Working with Roles (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/WorkingWithRoles.html). // For more information about instance profiles, go to About Instance Profiles // (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/AboutInstanceProfiles.html). // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation AddRoleToInstanceProfile for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeEntityAlreadyExistsException "EntityAlreadyExists" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create a resource that already // exists. // // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeUnmodifiableEntityException "UnmodifiableEntity" // The request was rejected because only the service that depends on the service-linked // role can modify or delete the role on your behalf. The error message includes // the name of the service that depends on this service-linked role. You must // request the change through that service. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/AddRoleToInstanceProfile func (c *IAM) AddRoleToInstanceProfile(input *AddRoleToInstanceProfileInput) (*AddRoleToInstanceProfileOutput, error) { req, out := c.AddRoleToInstanceProfileRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // AddRoleToInstanceProfileWithContext is the same as AddRoleToInstanceProfile with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See AddRoleToInstanceProfile for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) AddRoleToInstanceProfileWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *AddRoleToInstanceProfileInput, opts ...request.Option) (*AddRoleToInstanceProfileOutput, error) { req, out := c.AddRoleToInstanceProfileRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opAddUserToGroup = "AddUserToGroup" // AddUserToGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the AddUserToGroup operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See AddUserToGroup for more information on using the AddUserToGroup // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the AddUserToGroupRequest method. // req, resp := client.AddUserToGroupRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/AddUserToGroup func (c *IAM) AddUserToGroupRequest(input *AddUserToGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *AddUserToGroupOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opAddUserToGroup, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &AddUserToGroupInput{} } output = &AddUserToGroupOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Remove(query.UnmarshalHandler) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBackNamed(protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // AddUserToGroup API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Adds the specified user to the specified group. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation AddUserToGroup for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/AddUserToGroup func (c *IAM) AddUserToGroup(input *AddUserToGroupInput) (*AddUserToGroupOutput, error) { req, out := c.AddUserToGroupRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // AddUserToGroupWithContext is the same as AddUserToGroup with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See AddUserToGroup for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) AddUserToGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *AddUserToGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*AddUserToGroupOutput, error) { req, out := c.AddUserToGroupRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opAttachGroupPolicy = "AttachGroupPolicy" // AttachGroupPolicyRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the AttachGroupPolicy operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See AttachGroupPolicy for more information on using the AttachGroupPolicy // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the AttachGroupPolicyRequest method. // req, resp := client.AttachGroupPolicyRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/AttachGroupPolicy func (c *IAM) AttachGroupPolicyRequest(input *AttachGroupPolicyInput) (req *request.Request, output *AttachGroupPolicyOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opAttachGroupPolicy, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &AttachGroupPolicyInput{} } output = &AttachGroupPolicyOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Remove(query.UnmarshalHandler) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBackNamed(protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // AttachGroupPolicy API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Attaches the specified managed policy to the specified IAM group. // // You use this API to attach a managed policy to a group. To embed an inline // policy in a group, use PutGroupPolicy. // // For more information about policies, see Managed Policies and Inline Policies // (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation AttachGroupPolicy for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInput" // The request was rejected because an invalid or out-of-range value was supplied // for an input parameter. // // * ErrCodePolicyNotAttachableException "PolicyNotAttachable" // The request failed because AWS service role policies can only be attached // to the service-linked role for that service. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/AttachGroupPolicy func (c *IAM) AttachGroupPolicy(input *AttachGroupPolicyInput) (*AttachGroupPolicyOutput, error) { req, out := c.AttachGroupPolicyRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // AttachGroupPolicyWithContext is the same as AttachGroupPolicy with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See AttachGroupPolicy for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) AttachGroupPolicyWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *AttachGroupPolicyInput, opts ...request.Option) (*AttachGroupPolicyOutput, error) { req, out := c.AttachGroupPolicyRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opAttachRolePolicy = "AttachRolePolicy" // AttachRolePolicyRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the AttachRolePolicy operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See AttachRolePolicy for more information on using the AttachRolePolicy // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the AttachRolePolicyRequest method. // req, resp := client.AttachRolePolicyRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/AttachRolePolicy func (c *IAM) AttachRolePolicyRequest(input *AttachRolePolicyInput) (req *request.Request, output *AttachRolePolicyOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opAttachRolePolicy, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &AttachRolePolicyInput{} } output = &AttachRolePolicyOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Remove(query.UnmarshalHandler) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBackNamed(protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // AttachRolePolicy API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Attaches the specified managed policy to the specified IAM role. When you // attach a managed policy to a role, the managed policy becomes part of the // role's permission (access) policy. // // You cannot use a managed policy as the role's trust policy. The role's trust // policy is created at the same time as the role, using CreateRole. You can // update a role's trust policy using UpdateAssumeRolePolicy. // // Use this API to attach a managed policy to a role. To embed an inline policy // in a role, use PutRolePolicy. For more information about policies, see Managed // Policies and Inline Policies (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation AttachRolePolicy for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInput" // The request was rejected because an invalid or out-of-range value was supplied // for an input parameter. // // * ErrCodeUnmodifiableEntityException "UnmodifiableEntity" // The request was rejected because only the service that depends on the service-linked // role can modify or delete the role on your behalf. The error message includes // the name of the service that depends on this service-linked role. You must // request the change through that service. // // * ErrCodePolicyNotAttachableException "PolicyNotAttachable" // The request failed because AWS service role policies can only be attached // to the service-linked role for that service. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/AttachRolePolicy func (c *IAM) AttachRolePolicy(input *AttachRolePolicyInput) (*AttachRolePolicyOutput, error) { req, out := c.AttachRolePolicyRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // AttachRolePolicyWithContext is the same as AttachRolePolicy with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See AttachRolePolicy for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) AttachRolePolicyWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *AttachRolePolicyInput, opts ...request.Option) (*AttachRolePolicyOutput, error) { req, out := c.AttachRolePolicyRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opAttachUserPolicy = "AttachUserPolicy" // AttachUserPolicyRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the AttachUserPolicy operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See AttachUserPolicy for more information on using the AttachUserPolicy // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the AttachUserPolicyRequest method. // req, resp := client.AttachUserPolicyRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/AttachUserPolicy func (c *IAM) AttachUserPolicyRequest(input *AttachUserPolicyInput) (req *request.Request, output *AttachUserPolicyOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opAttachUserPolicy, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &AttachUserPolicyInput{} } output = &AttachUserPolicyOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Remove(query.UnmarshalHandler) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBackNamed(protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // AttachUserPolicy API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Attaches the specified managed policy to the specified user. // // You use this API to attach a managed policy to a user. To embed an inline // policy in a user, use PutUserPolicy. // // For more information about policies, see Managed Policies and Inline Policies // (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation AttachUserPolicy for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInput" // The request was rejected because an invalid or out-of-range value was supplied // for an input parameter. // // * ErrCodePolicyNotAttachableException "PolicyNotAttachable" // The request failed because AWS service role policies can only be attached // to the service-linked role for that service. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/AttachUserPolicy func (c *IAM) AttachUserPolicy(input *AttachUserPolicyInput) (*AttachUserPolicyOutput, error) { req, out := c.AttachUserPolicyRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // AttachUserPolicyWithContext is the same as AttachUserPolicy with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See AttachUserPolicy for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) AttachUserPolicyWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *AttachUserPolicyInput, opts ...request.Option) (*AttachUserPolicyOutput, error) { req, out := c.AttachUserPolicyRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opChangePassword = "ChangePassword" // ChangePasswordRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the ChangePassword operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See ChangePassword for more information on using the ChangePassword // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the ChangePasswordRequest method. // req, resp := client.ChangePasswordRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/ChangePassword func (c *IAM) ChangePasswordRequest(input *ChangePasswordInput) (req *request.Request, output *ChangePasswordOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opChangePassword, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &ChangePasswordInput{} } output = &ChangePasswordOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Remove(query.UnmarshalHandler) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBackNamed(protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // ChangePassword API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Changes the password of the IAM user who is calling this action. The root // account password is not affected by this action. // // To change the password for a different user, see UpdateLoginProfile. For // more information about modifying passwords, see Managing Passwords (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/Using_ManagingLogins.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation ChangePassword for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeInvalidUserTypeException "InvalidUserType" // The request was rejected because the type of user for the transaction was // incorrect. // // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeEntityTemporarilyUnmodifiableException "EntityTemporarilyUnmodifiable" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that is temporarily // unmodifiable, such as a user name that was deleted and then recreated. The // error indicates that the request is likely to succeed if you try again after // waiting several minutes. The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodePasswordPolicyViolationException "PasswordPolicyViolation" // The request was rejected because the provided password did not meet the requirements // imposed by the account password policy. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/ChangePassword func (c *IAM) ChangePassword(input *ChangePasswordInput) (*ChangePasswordOutput, error) { req, out := c.ChangePasswordRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // ChangePasswordWithContext is the same as ChangePassword with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See ChangePassword for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) ChangePasswordWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ChangePasswordInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ChangePasswordOutput, error) { req, out := c.ChangePasswordRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opCreateAccessKey = "CreateAccessKey" // CreateAccessKeyRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the CreateAccessKey operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See CreateAccessKey for more information on using the CreateAccessKey // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the CreateAccessKeyRequest method. // req, resp := client.CreateAccessKeyRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/CreateAccessKey func (c *IAM) CreateAccessKeyRequest(input *CreateAccessKeyInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateAccessKeyOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opCreateAccessKey, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &CreateAccessKeyInput{} } output = &CreateAccessKeyOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // CreateAccessKey API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Creates a new AWS secret access key and corresponding AWS access key ID for // the specified user. The default status for new keys is Active. // // If you do not specify a user name, IAM determines the user name implicitly // based on the AWS access key ID signing the request. Because this action works // for access keys under the AWS account, you can use this action to manage // root credentials even if the AWS account has no associated users. // // For information about limits on the number of keys you can create, see Limitations // on IAM Entities (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/LimitationsOnEntities.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // To ensure the security of your AWS account, the secret access key is accessible // only during key and user creation. You must save the key (for example, in // a text file) if you want to be able to access it again. If a secret key is // lost, you can delete the access keys for the associated user and then create // new keys. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation CreateAccessKey for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/CreateAccessKey func (c *IAM) CreateAccessKey(input *CreateAccessKeyInput) (*CreateAccessKeyOutput, error) { req, out := c.CreateAccessKeyRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // CreateAccessKeyWithContext is the same as CreateAccessKey with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See CreateAccessKey for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) CreateAccessKeyWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateAccessKeyInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateAccessKeyOutput, error) { req, out := c.CreateAccessKeyRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opCreateAccountAlias = "CreateAccountAlias" // CreateAccountAliasRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the CreateAccountAlias operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See CreateAccountAlias for more information on using the CreateAccountAlias // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the CreateAccountAliasRequest method. // req, resp := client.CreateAccountAliasRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/CreateAccountAlias func (c *IAM) CreateAccountAliasRequest(input *CreateAccountAliasInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateAccountAliasOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opCreateAccountAlias, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &CreateAccountAliasInput{} } output = &CreateAccountAliasOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Remove(query.UnmarshalHandler) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBackNamed(protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // CreateAccountAlias API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Creates an alias for your AWS account. For information about using an AWS // account alias, see Using an Alias for Your AWS Account ID (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/AccountAlias.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation CreateAccountAlias for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeEntityAlreadyExistsException "EntityAlreadyExists" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create a resource that already // exists. // // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/CreateAccountAlias func (c *IAM) CreateAccountAlias(input *CreateAccountAliasInput) (*CreateAccountAliasOutput, error) { req, out := c.CreateAccountAliasRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // CreateAccountAliasWithContext is the same as CreateAccountAlias with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See CreateAccountAlias for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) CreateAccountAliasWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateAccountAliasInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateAccountAliasOutput, error) { req, out := c.CreateAccountAliasRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opCreateGroup = "CreateGroup" // CreateGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the CreateGroup operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See CreateGroup for more information on using the CreateGroup // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the CreateGroupRequest method. // req, resp := client.CreateGroupRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/CreateGroup func (c *IAM) CreateGroupRequest(input *CreateGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateGroupOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opCreateGroup, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &CreateGroupInput{} } output = &CreateGroupOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // CreateGroup API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Creates a new group. // // For information about the number of groups you can create, see Limitations // on IAM Entities (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/LimitationsOnEntities.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation CreateGroup for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeEntityAlreadyExistsException "EntityAlreadyExists" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create a resource that already // exists. // // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/CreateGroup func (c *IAM) CreateGroup(input *CreateGroupInput) (*CreateGroupOutput, error) { req, out := c.CreateGroupRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // CreateGroupWithContext is the same as CreateGroup with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See CreateGroup for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) CreateGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateGroupOutput, error) { req, out := c.CreateGroupRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opCreateInstanceProfile = "CreateInstanceProfile" // CreateInstanceProfileRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the CreateInstanceProfile operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See CreateInstanceProfile for more information on using the CreateInstanceProfile // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the CreateInstanceProfileRequest method. // req, resp := client.CreateInstanceProfileRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/CreateInstanceProfile func (c *IAM) CreateInstanceProfileRequest(input *CreateInstanceProfileInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateInstanceProfileOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opCreateInstanceProfile, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &CreateInstanceProfileInput{} } output = &CreateInstanceProfileOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // CreateInstanceProfile API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Creates a new instance profile. For information about instance profiles, // go to About Instance Profiles (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/AboutInstanceProfiles.html). // // For information about the number of instance profiles you can create, see // Limitations on IAM Entities (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/LimitationsOnEntities.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation CreateInstanceProfile for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeEntityAlreadyExistsException "EntityAlreadyExists" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create a resource that already // exists. // // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/CreateInstanceProfile func (c *IAM) CreateInstanceProfile(input *CreateInstanceProfileInput) (*CreateInstanceProfileOutput, error) { req, out := c.CreateInstanceProfileRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // CreateInstanceProfileWithContext is the same as CreateInstanceProfile with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See CreateInstanceProfile for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) CreateInstanceProfileWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateInstanceProfileInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateInstanceProfileOutput, error) { req, out := c.CreateInstanceProfileRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opCreateLoginProfile = "CreateLoginProfile" // CreateLoginProfileRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the CreateLoginProfile operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See CreateLoginProfile for more information on using the CreateLoginProfile // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the CreateLoginProfileRequest method. // req, resp := client.CreateLoginProfileRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/CreateLoginProfile func (c *IAM) CreateLoginProfileRequest(input *CreateLoginProfileInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateLoginProfileOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opCreateLoginProfile, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &CreateLoginProfileInput{} } output = &CreateLoginProfileOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // CreateLoginProfile API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Creates a password for the specified user, giving the user the ability to // access AWS services through the AWS Management Console. For more information // about managing passwords, see Managing Passwords (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/Using_ManagingLogins.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation CreateLoginProfile for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeEntityAlreadyExistsException "EntityAlreadyExists" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create a resource that already // exists. // // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodePasswordPolicyViolationException "PasswordPolicyViolation" // The request was rejected because the provided password did not meet the requirements // imposed by the account password policy. // // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/CreateLoginProfile func (c *IAM) CreateLoginProfile(input *CreateLoginProfileInput) (*CreateLoginProfileOutput, error) { req, out := c.CreateLoginProfileRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // CreateLoginProfileWithContext is the same as CreateLoginProfile with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See CreateLoginProfile for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) CreateLoginProfileWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateLoginProfileInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateLoginProfileOutput, error) { req, out := c.CreateLoginProfileRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opCreateOpenIDConnectProvider = "CreateOpenIDConnectProvider" // CreateOpenIDConnectProviderRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the CreateOpenIDConnectProvider operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See CreateOpenIDConnectProvider for more information on using the CreateOpenIDConnectProvider // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the CreateOpenIDConnectProviderRequest method. // req, resp := client.CreateOpenIDConnectProviderRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/CreateOpenIDConnectProvider func (c *IAM) CreateOpenIDConnectProviderRequest(input *CreateOpenIDConnectProviderInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateOpenIDConnectProviderOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opCreateOpenIDConnectProvider, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &CreateOpenIDConnectProviderInput{} } output = &CreateOpenIDConnectProviderOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // CreateOpenIDConnectProvider API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Creates an IAM entity to describe an identity provider (IdP) that supports // OpenID Connect (OIDC) (http://openid.net/connect/). // // The OIDC provider that you create with this operation can be used as a principal // in a role's trust policy to establish a trust relationship between AWS and // the OIDC provider. // // When you create the IAM OIDC provider, you specify the URL of the OIDC identity // provider (IdP) to trust, a list of client IDs (also known as audiences) that // identify the application or applications that are allowed to authenticate // using the OIDC provider, and a list of thumbprints of the server certificate(s) // that the IdP uses. You get all of this information from the OIDC IdP that // you want to use for access to AWS. // // Because trust for the OIDC provider is ultimately derived from the IAM provider // that this action creates, it is a best practice to limit access to the CreateOpenIDConnectProvider // action to highly-privileged users. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation CreateOpenIDConnectProvider for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInput" // The request was rejected because an invalid or out-of-range value was supplied // for an input parameter. // // * ErrCodeEntityAlreadyExistsException "EntityAlreadyExists" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create a resource that already // exists. // // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/CreateOpenIDConnectProvider func (c *IAM) CreateOpenIDConnectProvider(input *CreateOpenIDConnectProviderInput) (*CreateOpenIDConnectProviderOutput, error) { req, out := c.CreateOpenIDConnectProviderRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // CreateOpenIDConnectProviderWithContext is the same as CreateOpenIDConnectProvider with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See CreateOpenIDConnectProvider for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) CreateOpenIDConnectProviderWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateOpenIDConnectProviderInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateOpenIDConnectProviderOutput, error) { req, out := c.CreateOpenIDConnectProviderRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opCreatePolicy = "CreatePolicy" // CreatePolicyRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the CreatePolicy operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See CreatePolicy for more information on using the CreatePolicy // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the CreatePolicyRequest method. // req, resp := client.CreatePolicyRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/CreatePolicy func (c *IAM) CreatePolicyRequest(input *CreatePolicyInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreatePolicyOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opCreatePolicy, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &CreatePolicyInput{} } output = &CreatePolicyOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // CreatePolicy API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Creates a new managed policy for your AWS account. // // This operation creates a policy version with a version identifier of v1 and // sets v1 as the policy's default version. For more information about policy // versions, see Versioning for Managed Policies (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-versions.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // For more information about managed policies in general, see Managed Policies // and Inline Policies (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation CreatePolicy for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInput" // The request was rejected because an invalid or out-of-range value was supplied // for an input parameter. // // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeEntityAlreadyExistsException "EntityAlreadyExists" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create a resource that already // exists. // // * ErrCodeMalformedPolicyDocumentException "MalformedPolicyDocument" // The request was rejected because the policy document was malformed. The error // message describes the specific error. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/CreatePolicy func (c *IAM) CreatePolicy(input *CreatePolicyInput) (*CreatePolicyOutput, error) { req, out := c.CreatePolicyRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // CreatePolicyWithContext is the same as CreatePolicy with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See CreatePolicy for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) CreatePolicyWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreatePolicyInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreatePolicyOutput, error) { req, out := c.CreatePolicyRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opCreatePolicyVersion = "CreatePolicyVersion" // CreatePolicyVersionRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the CreatePolicyVersion operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See CreatePolicyVersion for more information on using the CreatePolicyVersion // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the CreatePolicyVersionRequest method. // req, resp := client.CreatePolicyVersionRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/CreatePolicyVersion func (c *IAM) CreatePolicyVersionRequest(input *CreatePolicyVersionInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreatePolicyVersionOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opCreatePolicyVersion, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &CreatePolicyVersionInput{} } output = &CreatePolicyVersionOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // CreatePolicyVersion API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Creates a new version of the specified managed policy. To update a managed // policy, you create a new policy version. A managed policy can have up to // five versions. If the policy has five versions, you must delete an existing // version using DeletePolicyVersion before you create a new version. // // Optionally, you can set the new version as the policy's default version. // The default version is the version that is in effect for the IAM users, groups, // and roles to which the policy is attached. // // For more information about managed policy versions, see Versioning for Managed // Policies (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-versions.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation CreatePolicyVersion for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeMalformedPolicyDocumentException "MalformedPolicyDocument" // The request was rejected because the policy document was malformed. The error // message describes the specific error. // // * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInput" // The request was rejected because an invalid or out-of-range value was supplied // for an input parameter. // // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/CreatePolicyVersion func (c *IAM) CreatePolicyVersion(input *CreatePolicyVersionInput) (*CreatePolicyVersionOutput, error) { req, out := c.CreatePolicyVersionRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // CreatePolicyVersionWithContext is the same as CreatePolicyVersion with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See CreatePolicyVersion for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) CreatePolicyVersionWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreatePolicyVersionInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreatePolicyVersionOutput, error) { req, out := c.CreatePolicyVersionRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opCreateRole = "CreateRole" // CreateRoleRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the CreateRole operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See CreateRole for more information on using the CreateRole // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the CreateRoleRequest method. // req, resp := client.CreateRoleRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/CreateRole func (c *IAM) CreateRoleRequest(input *CreateRoleInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateRoleOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opCreateRole, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &CreateRoleInput{} } output = &CreateRoleOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // CreateRole API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Creates a new role for your AWS account. For more information about roles, // go to Working with Roles (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/WorkingWithRoles.html). // For information about limitations on role names and the number of roles you // can create, go to Limitations on IAM Entities (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/LimitationsOnEntities.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation CreateRole for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInput" // The request was rejected because an invalid or out-of-range value was supplied // for an input parameter. // // * ErrCodeEntityAlreadyExistsException "EntityAlreadyExists" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create a resource that already // exists. // // * ErrCodeMalformedPolicyDocumentException "MalformedPolicyDocument" // The request was rejected because the policy document was malformed. The error // message describes the specific error. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/CreateRole func (c *IAM) CreateRole(input *CreateRoleInput) (*CreateRoleOutput, error) { req, out := c.CreateRoleRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // CreateRoleWithContext is the same as CreateRole with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See CreateRole for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) CreateRoleWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateRoleInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateRoleOutput, error) { req, out := c.CreateRoleRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opCreateSAMLProvider = "CreateSAMLProvider" // CreateSAMLProviderRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the CreateSAMLProvider operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See CreateSAMLProvider for more information on using the CreateSAMLProvider // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the CreateSAMLProviderRequest method. // req, resp := client.CreateSAMLProviderRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/CreateSAMLProvider func (c *IAM) CreateSAMLProviderRequest(input *CreateSAMLProviderInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateSAMLProviderOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opCreateSAMLProvider, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &CreateSAMLProviderInput{} } output = &CreateSAMLProviderOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // CreateSAMLProvider API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Creates an IAM resource that describes an identity provider (IdP) that supports // SAML 2.0. // // The SAML provider resource that you create with this operation can be used // as a principal in an IAM role's trust policy to enable federated users who // sign-in using the SAML IdP to assume the role. You can create an IAM role // that supports Web-based single sign-on (SSO) to the AWS Management Console // or one that supports API access to AWS. // // When you create the SAML provider resource, you upload an a SAML metadata // document that you get from your IdP and that includes the issuer's name, // expiration information, and keys that can be used to validate the SAML authentication // response (assertions) that the IdP sends. You must generate the metadata // document using the identity management software that is used as your organization's // IdP. // // This operation requires Signature Version 4 (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/signature-version-4.html). // // For more information, see Enabling SAML 2.0 Federated Users to Access the // AWS Management Console (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/id_roles_providers_enable-console-saml.html) // and About SAML 2.0-based Federation (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/id_roles_providers_saml.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation CreateSAMLProvider for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInput" // The request was rejected because an invalid or out-of-range value was supplied // for an input parameter. // // * ErrCodeEntityAlreadyExistsException "EntityAlreadyExists" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create a resource that already // exists. // // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/CreateSAMLProvider func (c *IAM) CreateSAMLProvider(input *CreateSAMLProviderInput) (*CreateSAMLProviderOutput, error) { req, out := c.CreateSAMLProviderRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // CreateSAMLProviderWithContext is the same as CreateSAMLProvider with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See CreateSAMLProvider for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) CreateSAMLProviderWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateSAMLProviderInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateSAMLProviderOutput, error) { req, out := c.CreateSAMLProviderRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opCreateServiceLinkedRole = "CreateServiceLinkedRole" // CreateServiceLinkedRoleRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the CreateServiceLinkedRole operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See CreateServiceLinkedRole for more information on using the CreateServiceLinkedRole // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the CreateServiceLinkedRoleRequest method. // req, resp := client.CreateServiceLinkedRoleRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/CreateServiceLinkedRole func (c *IAM) CreateServiceLinkedRoleRequest(input *CreateServiceLinkedRoleInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateServiceLinkedRoleOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opCreateServiceLinkedRole, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &CreateServiceLinkedRoleInput{} } output = &CreateServiceLinkedRoleOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // CreateServiceLinkedRole API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Creates an IAM role that is linked to a specific AWS service. The service // controls the attached policies and when the role can be deleted. This helps // ensure that the service is not broken by an unexpectedly changed or deleted // role, which could put your AWS resources into an unknown state. Allowing // the service to control the role helps improve service stability and proper // cleanup when a service and its role are no longer needed. // // The name of the role is autogenerated by combining the string that you specify // for the AWSServiceName parameter with the string that you specify for the // CustomSuffix parameter. The resulting name must be unique in your account // or the request fails. // // To attach a policy to this service-linked role, you must make the request // using the AWS service that depends on this role. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation CreateServiceLinkedRole for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInput" // The request was rejected because an invalid or out-of-range value was supplied // for an input parameter. // // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/CreateServiceLinkedRole func (c *IAM) CreateServiceLinkedRole(input *CreateServiceLinkedRoleInput) (*CreateServiceLinkedRoleOutput, error) { req, out := c.CreateServiceLinkedRoleRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // CreateServiceLinkedRoleWithContext is the same as CreateServiceLinkedRole with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See CreateServiceLinkedRole for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) CreateServiceLinkedRoleWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateServiceLinkedRoleInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateServiceLinkedRoleOutput, error) { req, out := c.CreateServiceLinkedRoleRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opCreateServiceSpecificCredential = "CreateServiceSpecificCredential" // CreateServiceSpecificCredentialRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the CreateServiceSpecificCredential operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See CreateServiceSpecificCredential for more information on using the CreateServiceSpecificCredential // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the CreateServiceSpecificCredentialRequest method. // req, resp := client.CreateServiceSpecificCredentialRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/CreateServiceSpecificCredential func (c *IAM) CreateServiceSpecificCredentialRequest(input *CreateServiceSpecificCredentialInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateServiceSpecificCredentialOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opCreateServiceSpecificCredential, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &CreateServiceSpecificCredentialInput{} } output = &CreateServiceSpecificCredentialOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // CreateServiceSpecificCredential API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Generates a set of credentials consisting of a user name and password that // can be used to access the service specified in the request. These credentials // are generated by IAM, and can be used only for the specified service. // // You can have a maximum of two sets of service-specific credentials for each // supported service per user. // // The only supported service at this time is AWS CodeCommit. // // You can reset the password to a new service-generated value by calling ResetServiceSpecificCredential. // // For more information about service-specific credentials, see Using IAM with // AWS CodeCommit: Git Credentials, SSH Keys, and AWS Access Keys (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/id_credentials_ssh-keys.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation CreateServiceSpecificCredential for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeServiceNotSupportedException "NotSupportedService" // The specified service does not support service-specific credentials. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/CreateServiceSpecificCredential func (c *IAM) CreateServiceSpecificCredential(input *CreateServiceSpecificCredentialInput) (*CreateServiceSpecificCredentialOutput, error) { req, out := c.CreateServiceSpecificCredentialRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // CreateServiceSpecificCredentialWithContext is the same as CreateServiceSpecificCredential with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See CreateServiceSpecificCredential for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) CreateServiceSpecificCredentialWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateServiceSpecificCredentialInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateServiceSpecificCredentialOutput, error) { req, out := c.CreateServiceSpecificCredentialRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opCreateUser = "CreateUser" // CreateUserRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the CreateUser operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See CreateUser for more information on using the CreateUser // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the CreateUserRequest method. // req, resp := client.CreateUserRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/CreateUser func (c *IAM) CreateUserRequest(input *CreateUserInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateUserOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opCreateUser, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &CreateUserInput{} } output = &CreateUserOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // CreateUser API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Creates a new IAM user for your AWS account. // // For information about limitations on the number of IAM users you can create, // see Limitations on IAM Entities (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/LimitationsOnEntities.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation CreateUser for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeEntityAlreadyExistsException "EntityAlreadyExists" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create a resource that already // exists. // // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/CreateUser func (c *IAM) CreateUser(input *CreateUserInput) (*CreateUserOutput, error) { req, out := c.CreateUserRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // CreateUserWithContext is the same as CreateUser with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See CreateUser for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) CreateUserWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateUserInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateUserOutput, error) { req, out := c.CreateUserRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opCreateVirtualMFADevice = "CreateVirtualMFADevice" // CreateVirtualMFADeviceRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the CreateVirtualMFADevice operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See CreateVirtualMFADevice for more information on using the CreateVirtualMFADevice // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the CreateVirtualMFADeviceRequest method. // req, resp := client.CreateVirtualMFADeviceRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/CreateVirtualMFADevice func (c *IAM) CreateVirtualMFADeviceRequest(input *CreateVirtualMFADeviceInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateVirtualMFADeviceOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opCreateVirtualMFADevice, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &CreateVirtualMFADeviceInput{} } output = &CreateVirtualMFADeviceOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // CreateVirtualMFADevice API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Creates a new virtual MFA device for the AWS account. After creating the // virtual MFA, use EnableMFADevice to attach the MFA device to an IAM user. // For more information about creating and working with virtual MFA devices, // go to Using a Virtual MFA Device (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/Using_VirtualMFA.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // For information about limits on the number of MFA devices you can create, // see Limitations on Entities (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/LimitationsOnEntities.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // The seed information contained in the QR code and the Base32 string should // be treated like any other secret access information, such as your AWS access // keys or your passwords. After you provision your virtual device, you should // ensure that the information is destroyed following secure procedures. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation CreateVirtualMFADevice for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeEntityAlreadyExistsException "EntityAlreadyExists" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create a resource that already // exists. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/CreateVirtualMFADevice func (c *IAM) CreateVirtualMFADevice(input *CreateVirtualMFADeviceInput) (*CreateVirtualMFADeviceOutput, error) { req, out := c.CreateVirtualMFADeviceRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // CreateVirtualMFADeviceWithContext is the same as CreateVirtualMFADevice with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See CreateVirtualMFADevice for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) CreateVirtualMFADeviceWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateVirtualMFADeviceInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateVirtualMFADeviceOutput, error) { req, out := c.CreateVirtualMFADeviceRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opDeactivateMFADevice = "DeactivateMFADevice" // DeactivateMFADeviceRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DeactivateMFADevice operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DeactivateMFADevice for more information on using the DeactivateMFADevice // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DeactivateMFADeviceRequest method. // req, resp := client.DeactivateMFADeviceRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/DeactivateMFADevice func (c *IAM) DeactivateMFADeviceRequest(input *DeactivateMFADeviceInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeactivateMFADeviceOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDeactivateMFADevice, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &DeactivateMFADeviceInput{} } output = &DeactivateMFADeviceOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Remove(query.UnmarshalHandler) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBackNamed(protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // DeactivateMFADevice API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Deactivates the specified MFA device and removes it from association with // the user name for which it was originally enabled. // // For more information about creating and working with virtual MFA devices, // go to Using a Virtual MFA Device (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/Using_VirtualMFA.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation DeactivateMFADevice for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeEntityTemporarilyUnmodifiableException "EntityTemporarilyUnmodifiable" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that is temporarily // unmodifiable, such as a user name that was deleted and then recreated. The // error indicates that the request is likely to succeed if you try again after // waiting several minutes. The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/DeactivateMFADevice func (c *IAM) DeactivateMFADevice(input *DeactivateMFADeviceInput) (*DeactivateMFADeviceOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeactivateMFADeviceRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DeactivateMFADeviceWithContext is the same as DeactivateMFADevice with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DeactivateMFADevice for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) DeactivateMFADeviceWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeactivateMFADeviceInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeactivateMFADeviceOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeactivateMFADeviceRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opDeleteAccessKey = "DeleteAccessKey" // DeleteAccessKeyRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DeleteAccessKey operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DeleteAccessKey for more information on using the DeleteAccessKey // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DeleteAccessKeyRequest method. // req, resp := client.DeleteAccessKeyRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/DeleteAccessKey func (c *IAM) DeleteAccessKeyRequest(input *DeleteAccessKeyInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteAccessKeyOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDeleteAccessKey, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &DeleteAccessKeyInput{} } output = &DeleteAccessKeyOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Remove(query.UnmarshalHandler) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBackNamed(protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // DeleteAccessKey API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Deletes the access key pair associated with the specified IAM user. // // If you do not specify a user name, IAM determines the user name implicitly // based on the AWS access key ID signing the request. Because this action works // for access keys under the AWS account, you can use this action to manage // root credentials even if the AWS account has no associated users. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation DeleteAccessKey for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/DeleteAccessKey func (c *IAM) DeleteAccessKey(input *DeleteAccessKeyInput) (*DeleteAccessKeyOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteAccessKeyRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DeleteAccessKeyWithContext is the same as DeleteAccessKey with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DeleteAccessKey for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) DeleteAccessKeyWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteAccessKeyInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteAccessKeyOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteAccessKeyRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opDeleteAccountAlias = "DeleteAccountAlias" // DeleteAccountAliasRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DeleteAccountAlias operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DeleteAccountAlias for more information on using the DeleteAccountAlias // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DeleteAccountAliasRequest method. // req, resp := client.DeleteAccountAliasRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/DeleteAccountAlias func (c *IAM) DeleteAccountAliasRequest(input *DeleteAccountAliasInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteAccountAliasOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDeleteAccountAlias, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &DeleteAccountAliasInput{} } output = &DeleteAccountAliasOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Remove(query.UnmarshalHandler) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBackNamed(protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // DeleteAccountAlias API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Deletes the specified AWS account alias. For information about using an AWS // account alias, see Using an Alias for Your AWS Account ID (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/AccountAlias.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation DeleteAccountAlias for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/DeleteAccountAlias func (c *IAM) DeleteAccountAlias(input *DeleteAccountAliasInput) (*DeleteAccountAliasOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteAccountAliasRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DeleteAccountAliasWithContext is the same as DeleteAccountAlias with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DeleteAccountAlias for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) DeleteAccountAliasWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteAccountAliasInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteAccountAliasOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteAccountAliasRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opDeleteAccountPasswordPolicy = "DeleteAccountPasswordPolicy" // DeleteAccountPasswordPolicyRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DeleteAccountPasswordPolicy operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DeleteAccountPasswordPolicy for more information on using the DeleteAccountPasswordPolicy // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DeleteAccountPasswordPolicyRequest method. // req, resp := client.DeleteAccountPasswordPolicyRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/DeleteAccountPasswordPolicy func (c *IAM) DeleteAccountPasswordPolicyRequest(input *DeleteAccountPasswordPolicyInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteAccountPasswordPolicyOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDeleteAccountPasswordPolicy, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &DeleteAccountPasswordPolicyInput{} } output = &DeleteAccountPasswordPolicyOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Remove(query.UnmarshalHandler) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBackNamed(protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // DeleteAccountPasswordPolicy API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Deletes the password policy for the AWS account. There are no parameters. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation DeleteAccountPasswordPolicy for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/DeleteAccountPasswordPolicy func (c *IAM) DeleteAccountPasswordPolicy(input *DeleteAccountPasswordPolicyInput) (*DeleteAccountPasswordPolicyOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteAccountPasswordPolicyRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DeleteAccountPasswordPolicyWithContext is the same as DeleteAccountPasswordPolicy with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DeleteAccountPasswordPolicy for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) DeleteAccountPasswordPolicyWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteAccountPasswordPolicyInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteAccountPasswordPolicyOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteAccountPasswordPolicyRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opDeleteGroup = "DeleteGroup" // DeleteGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DeleteGroup operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DeleteGroup for more information on using the DeleteGroup // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DeleteGroupRequest method. // req, resp := client.DeleteGroupRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/DeleteGroup func (c *IAM) DeleteGroupRequest(input *DeleteGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteGroupOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDeleteGroup, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &DeleteGroupInput{} } output = &DeleteGroupOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Remove(query.UnmarshalHandler) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBackNamed(protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // DeleteGroup API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Deletes the specified IAM group. The group must not contain any users or // have any attached policies. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation DeleteGroup for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeDeleteConflictException "DeleteConflict" // The request was rejected because it attempted to delete a resource that has // attached subordinate entities. The error message describes these entities. // // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/DeleteGroup func (c *IAM) DeleteGroup(input *DeleteGroupInput) (*DeleteGroupOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteGroupRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DeleteGroupWithContext is the same as DeleteGroup with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DeleteGroup for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) DeleteGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteGroupOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteGroupRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opDeleteGroupPolicy = "DeleteGroupPolicy" // DeleteGroupPolicyRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DeleteGroupPolicy operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DeleteGroupPolicy for more information on using the DeleteGroupPolicy // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DeleteGroupPolicyRequest method. // req, resp := client.DeleteGroupPolicyRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/DeleteGroupPolicy func (c *IAM) DeleteGroupPolicyRequest(input *DeleteGroupPolicyInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteGroupPolicyOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDeleteGroupPolicy, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &DeleteGroupPolicyInput{} } output = &DeleteGroupPolicyOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Remove(query.UnmarshalHandler) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBackNamed(protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // DeleteGroupPolicy API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Deletes the specified inline policy that is embedded in the specified IAM // group. // // A group can also have managed policies attached to it. To detach a managed // policy from a group, use DetachGroupPolicy. For more information about policies, // refer to Managed Policies and Inline Policies (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation DeleteGroupPolicy for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/DeleteGroupPolicy func (c *IAM) DeleteGroupPolicy(input *DeleteGroupPolicyInput) (*DeleteGroupPolicyOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteGroupPolicyRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DeleteGroupPolicyWithContext is the same as DeleteGroupPolicy with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DeleteGroupPolicy for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) DeleteGroupPolicyWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteGroupPolicyInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteGroupPolicyOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteGroupPolicyRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opDeleteInstanceProfile = "DeleteInstanceProfile" // DeleteInstanceProfileRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DeleteInstanceProfile operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DeleteInstanceProfile for more information on using the DeleteInstanceProfile // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DeleteInstanceProfileRequest method. // req, resp := client.DeleteInstanceProfileRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/DeleteInstanceProfile func (c *IAM) DeleteInstanceProfileRequest(input *DeleteInstanceProfileInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteInstanceProfileOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDeleteInstanceProfile, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &DeleteInstanceProfileInput{} } output = &DeleteInstanceProfileOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Remove(query.UnmarshalHandler) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBackNamed(protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // DeleteInstanceProfile API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Deletes the specified instance profile. The instance profile must not have // an associated role. // // Make sure you do not have any Amazon EC2 instances running with the instance // profile you are about to delete. Deleting a role or instance profile that // is associated with a running instance will break any applications running // on the instance. // // For more information about instance profiles, go to About Instance Profiles // (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/AboutInstanceProfiles.html). // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation DeleteInstanceProfile for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeDeleteConflictException "DeleteConflict" // The request was rejected because it attempted to delete a resource that has // attached subordinate entities. The error message describes these entities. // // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/DeleteInstanceProfile func (c *IAM) DeleteInstanceProfile(input *DeleteInstanceProfileInput) (*DeleteInstanceProfileOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteInstanceProfileRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DeleteInstanceProfileWithContext is the same as DeleteInstanceProfile with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DeleteInstanceProfile for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) DeleteInstanceProfileWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteInstanceProfileInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteInstanceProfileOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteInstanceProfileRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opDeleteLoginProfile = "DeleteLoginProfile" // DeleteLoginProfileRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DeleteLoginProfile operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DeleteLoginProfile for more information on using the DeleteLoginProfile // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DeleteLoginProfileRequest method. // req, resp := client.DeleteLoginProfileRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/DeleteLoginProfile func (c *IAM) DeleteLoginProfileRequest(input *DeleteLoginProfileInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteLoginProfileOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDeleteLoginProfile, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &DeleteLoginProfileInput{} } output = &DeleteLoginProfileOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Remove(query.UnmarshalHandler) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBackNamed(protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // DeleteLoginProfile API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Deletes the password for the specified IAM user, which terminates the user's // ability to access AWS services through the AWS Management Console. // // Deleting a user's password does not prevent a user from accessing AWS through // the command line interface or the API. To prevent all user access you must // also either make any access keys inactive or delete them. For more information // about making keys inactive or deleting them, see UpdateAccessKey and DeleteAccessKey. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation DeleteLoginProfile for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeEntityTemporarilyUnmodifiableException "EntityTemporarilyUnmodifiable" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that is temporarily // unmodifiable, such as a user name that was deleted and then recreated. The // error indicates that the request is likely to succeed if you try again after // waiting several minutes. The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/DeleteLoginProfile func (c *IAM) DeleteLoginProfile(input *DeleteLoginProfileInput) (*DeleteLoginProfileOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteLoginProfileRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DeleteLoginProfileWithContext is the same as DeleteLoginProfile with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DeleteLoginProfile for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) DeleteLoginProfileWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteLoginProfileInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteLoginProfileOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteLoginProfileRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opDeleteOpenIDConnectProvider = "DeleteOpenIDConnectProvider" // DeleteOpenIDConnectProviderRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DeleteOpenIDConnectProvider operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DeleteOpenIDConnectProvider for more information on using the DeleteOpenIDConnectProvider // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DeleteOpenIDConnectProviderRequest method. // req, resp := client.DeleteOpenIDConnectProviderRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/DeleteOpenIDConnectProvider func (c *IAM) DeleteOpenIDConnectProviderRequest(input *DeleteOpenIDConnectProviderInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteOpenIDConnectProviderOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDeleteOpenIDConnectProvider, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &DeleteOpenIDConnectProviderInput{} } output = &DeleteOpenIDConnectProviderOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Remove(query.UnmarshalHandler) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBackNamed(protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // DeleteOpenIDConnectProvider API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Deletes an OpenID Connect identity provider (IdP) resource object in IAM. // // Deleting an IAM OIDC provider resource does not update any roles that reference // the provider as a principal in their trust policies. Any attempt to assume // a role that references a deleted provider fails. // // This action is idempotent; it does not fail or return an error if you call // the action for a provider that does not exist. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation DeleteOpenIDConnectProvider for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInput" // The request was rejected because an invalid or out-of-range value was supplied // for an input parameter. // // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/DeleteOpenIDConnectProvider func (c *IAM) DeleteOpenIDConnectProvider(input *DeleteOpenIDConnectProviderInput) (*DeleteOpenIDConnectProviderOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteOpenIDConnectProviderRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DeleteOpenIDConnectProviderWithContext is the same as DeleteOpenIDConnectProvider with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DeleteOpenIDConnectProvider for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) DeleteOpenIDConnectProviderWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteOpenIDConnectProviderInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteOpenIDConnectProviderOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteOpenIDConnectProviderRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opDeletePolicy = "DeletePolicy" // DeletePolicyRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DeletePolicy operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DeletePolicy for more information on using the DeletePolicy // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DeletePolicyRequest method. // req, resp := client.DeletePolicyRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/DeletePolicy func (c *IAM) DeletePolicyRequest(input *DeletePolicyInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeletePolicyOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDeletePolicy, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &DeletePolicyInput{} } output = &DeletePolicyOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Remove(query.UnmarshalHandler) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBackNamed(protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // DeletePolicy API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Deletes the specified managed policy. // // Before you can delete a managed policy, you must first detach the policy // from all users, groups, and roles that it is attached to, and you must delete // all of the policy's versions. The following steps describe the process for // deleting a managed policy: // // * Detach the policy from all users, groups, and roles that the policy // is attached to, using the DetachUserPolicy, DetachGroupPolicy, or DetachRolePolicy // APIs. To list all the users, groups, and roles that a policy is attached // to, use ListEntitiesForPolicy. // // * Delete all versions of the policy using DeletePolicyVersion. To list // the policy's versions, use ListPolicyVersions. You cannot use DeletePolicyVersion // to delete the version that is marked as the default version. You delete // the policy's default version in the next step of the process. // // * Delete the policy (this automatically deletes the policy's default version) // using this API. // // For information about managed policies, see Managed Policies and Inline Policies // (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation DeletePolicy for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInput" // The request was rejected because an invalid or out-of-range value was supplied // for an input parameter. // // * ErrCodeDeleteConflictException "DeleteConflict" // The request was rejected because it attempted to delete a resource that has // attached subordinate entities. The error message describes these entities. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/DeletePolicy func (c *IAM) DeletePolicy(input *DeletePolicyInput) (*DeletePolicyOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeletePolicyRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DeletePolicyWithContext is the same as DeletePolicy with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DeletePolicy for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) DeletePolicyWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeletePolicyInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeletePolicyOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeletePolicyRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opDeletePolicyVersion = "DeletePolicyVersion" // DeletePolicyVersionRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DeletePolicyVersion operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DeletePolicyVersion for more information on using the DeletePolicyVersion // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DeletePolicyVersionRequest method. // req, resp := client.DeletePolicyVersionRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/DeletePolicyVersion func (c *IAM) DeletePolicyVersionRequest(input *DeletePolicyVersionInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeletePolicyVersionOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDeletePolicyVersion, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &DeletePolicyVersionInput{} } output = &DeletePolicyVersionOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Remove(query.UnmarshalHandler) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBackNamed(protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // DeletePolicyVersion API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Deletes the specified version from the specified managed policy. // // You cannot delete the default version from a policy using this API. To delete // the default version from a policy, use DeletePolicy. To find out which version // of a policy is marked as the default version, use ListPolicyVersions. // // For information about versions for managed policies, see Versioning for Managed // Policies (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-versions.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation DeletePolicyVersion for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInput" // The request was rejected because an invalid or out-of-range value was supplied // for an input parameter. // // * ErrCodeDeleteConflictException "DeleteConflict" // The request was rejected because it attempted to delete a resource that has // attached subordinate entities. The error message describes these entities. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/DeletePolicyVersion func (c *IAM) DeletePolicyVersion(input *DeletePolicyVersionInput) (*DeletePolicyVersionOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeletePolicyVersionRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DeletePolicyVersionWithContext is the same as DeletePolicyVersion with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DeletePolicyVersion for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) DeletePolicyVersionWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeletePolicyVersionInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeletePolicyVersionOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeletePolicyVersionRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opDeleteRole = "DeleteRole" // DeleteRoleRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DeleteRole operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DeleteRole for more information on using the DeleteRole // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DeleteRoleRequest method. // req, resp := client.DeleteRoleRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/DeleteRole func (c *IAM) DeleteRoleRequest(input *DeleteRoleInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteRoleOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDeleteRole, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &DeleteRoleInput{} } output = &DeleteRoleOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Remove(query.UnmarshalHandler) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBackNamed(protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // DeleteRole API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Deletes the specified role. The role must not have any policies attached. // For more information about roles, go to Working with Roles (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/WorkingWithRoles.html). // // Make sure you do not have any Amazon EC2 instances running with the role // you are about to delete. Deleting a role or instance profile that is associated // with a running instance will break any applications running on the instance. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation DeleteRole for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeDeleteConflictException "DeleteConflict" // The request was rejected because it attempted to delete a resource that has // attached subordinate entities. The error message describes these entities. // // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeUnmodifiableEntityException "UnmodifiableEntity" // The request was rejected because only the service that depends on the service-linked // role can modify or delete the role on your behalf. The error message includes // the name of the service that depends on this service-linked role. You must // request the change through that service. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/DeleteRole func (c *IAM) DeleteRole(input *DeleteRoleInput) (*DeleteRoleOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteRoleRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DeleteRoleWithContext is the same as DeleteRole with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DeleteRole for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) DeleteRoleWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteRoleInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteRoleOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteRoleRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opDeleteRolePolicy = "DeleteRolePolicy" // DeleteRolePolicyRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DeleteRolePolicy operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DeleteRolePolicy for more information on using the DeleteRolePolicy // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DeleteRolePolicyRequest method. // req, resp := client.DeleteRolePolicyRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/DeleteRolePolicy func (c *IAM) DeleteRolePolicyRequest(input *DeleteRolePolicyInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteRolePolicyOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDeleteRolePolicy, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &DeleteRolePolicyInput{} } output = &DeleteRolePolicyOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Remove(query.UnmarshalHandler) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBackNamed(protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // DeleteRolePolicy API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Deletes the specified inline policy that is embedded in the specified IAM // role. // // A role can also have managed policies attached to it. To detach a managed // policy from a role, use DetachRolePolicy. For more information about policies, // refer to Managed Policies and Inline Policies (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation DeleteRolePolicy for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeUnmodifiableEntityException "UnmodifiableEntity" // The request was rejected because only the service that depends on the service-linked // role can modify or delete the role on your behalf. The error message includes // the name of the service that depends on this service-linked role. You must // request the change through that service. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/DeleteRolePolicy func (c *IAM) DeleteRolePolicy(input *DeleteRolePolicyInput) (*DeleteRolePolicyOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteRolePolicyRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DeleteRolePolicyWithContext is the same as DeleteRolePolicy with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DeleteRolePolicy for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) DeleteRolePolicyWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteRolePolicyInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteRolePolicyOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteRolePolicyRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opDeleteSAMLProvider = "DeleteSAMLProvider" // DeleteSAMLProviderRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DeleteSAMLProvider operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DeleteSAMLProvider for more information on using the DeleteSAMLProvider // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DeleteSAMLProviderRequest method. // req, resp := client.DeleteSAMLProviderRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/DeleteSAMLProvider func (c *IAM) DeleteSAMLProviderRequest(input *DeleteSAMLProviderInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteSAMLProviderOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDeleteSAMLProvider, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &DeleteSAMLProviderInput{} } output = &DeleteSAMLProviderOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Remove(query.UnmarshalHandler) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBackNamed(protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // DeleteSAMLProvider API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Deletes a SAML provider resource in IAM. // // Deleting the provider resource from IAM does not update any roles that reference // the SAML provider resource's ARN as a principal in their trust policies. // Any attempt to assume a role that references a non-existent provider resource // ARN fails. // // This operation requires Signature Version 4 (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/signature-version-4.html). // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation DeleteSAMLProvider for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInput" // The request was rejected because an invalid or out-of-range value was supplied // for an input parameter. // // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/DeleteSAMLProvider func (c *IAM) DeleteSAMLProvider(input *DeleteSAMLProviderInput) (*DeleteSAMLProviderOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteSAMLProviderRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DeleteSAMLProviderWithContext is the same as DeleteSAMLProvider with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DeleteSAMLProvider for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) DeleteSAMLProviderWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteSAMLProviderInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteSAMLProviderOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteSAMLProviderRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opDeleteSSHPublicKey = "DeleteSSHPublicKey" // DeleteSSHPublicKeyRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DeleteSSHPublicKey operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DeleteSSHPublicKey for more information on using the DeleteSSHPublicKey // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DeleteSSHPublicKeyRequest method. // req, resp := client.DeleteSSHPublicKeyRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/DeleteSSHPublicKey func (c *IAM) DeleteSSHPublicKeyRequest(input *DeleteSSHPublicKeyInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteSSHPublicKeyOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDeleteSSHPublicKey, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &DeleteSSHPublicKeyInput{} } output = &DeleteSSHPublicKeyOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Remove(query.UnmarshalHandler) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBackNamed(protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // DeleteSSHPublicKey API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Deletes the specified SSH public key. // // The SSH public key deleted by this action is used only for authenticating // the associated IAM user to an AWS CodeCommit repository. For more information // about using SSH keys to authenticate to an AWS CodeCommit repository, see // Set up AWS CodeCommit for SSH Connections (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/codecommit/latest/userguide/setting-up-credentials-ssh.html) // in the AWS CodeCommit User Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation DeleteSSHPublicKey for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/DeleteSSHPublicKey func (c *IAM) DeleteSSHPublicKey(input *DeleteSSHPublicKeyInput) (*DeleteSSHPublicKeyOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteSSHPublicKeyRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DeleteSSHPublicKeyWithContext is the same as DeleteSSHPublicKey with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DeleteSSHPublicKey for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) DeleteSSHPublicKeyWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteSSHPublicKeyInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteSSHPublicKeyOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteSSHPublicKeyRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opDeleteServerCertificate = "DeleteServerCertificate" // DeleteServerCertificateRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DeleteServerCertificate operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DeleteServerCertificate for more information on using the DeleteServerCertificate // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DeleteServerCertificateRequest method. // req, resp := client.DeleteServerCertificateRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/DeleteServerCertificate func (c *IAM) DeleteServerCertificateRequest(input *DeleteServerCertificateInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteServerCertificateOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDeleteServerCertificate, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &DeleteServerCertificateInput{} } output = &DeleteServerCertificateOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Remove(query.UnmarshalHandler) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBackNamed(protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // DeleteServerCertificate API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Deletes the specified server certificate. // // For more information about working with server certificates, including a // list of AWS services that can use the server certificates that you manage // with IAM, go to Working with Server Certificates (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/id_credentials_server-certs.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // If you are using a server certificate with Elastic Load Balancing, deleting // the certificate could have implications for your application. If Elastic // Load Balancing doesn't detect the deletion of bound certificates, it may // continue to use the certificates. This could cause Elastic Load Balancing // to stop accepting traffic. We recommend that you remove the reference to // the certificate from Elastic Load Balancing before using this command to // delete the certificate. For more information, go to DeleteLoadBalancerListeners // (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/ElasticLoadBalancing/latest/APIReference/API_DeleteLoadBalancerListeners.html) // in the Elastic Load Balancing API Reference. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation DeleteServerCertificate for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeDeleteConflictException "DeleteConflict" // The request was rejected because it attempted to delete a resource that has // attached subordinate entities. The error message describes these entities. // // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/DeleteServerCertificate func (c *IAM) DeleteServerCertificate(input *DeleteServerCertificateInput) (*DeleteServerCertificateOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteServerCertificateRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DeleteServerCertificateWithContext is the same as DeleteServerCertificate with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DeleteServerCertificate for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) DeleteServerCertificateWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteServerCertificateInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteServerCertificateOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteServerCertificateRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opDeleteServiceLinkedRole = "DeleteServiceLinkedRole" // DeleteServiceLinkedRoleRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DeleteServiceLinkedRole operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DeleteServiceLinkedRole for more information on using the DeleteServiceLinkedRole // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DeleteServiceLinkedRoleRequest method. // req, resp := client.DeleteServiceLinkedRoleRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/DeleteServiceLinkedRole func (c *IAM) DeleteServiceLinkedRoleRequest(input *DeleteServiceLinkedRoleInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteServiceLinkedRoleOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDeleteServiceLinkedRole, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &DeleteServiceLinkedRoleInput{} } output = &DeleteServiceLinkedRoleOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // DeleteServiceLinkedRole API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Submits a service-linked role deletion request and returns a DeletionTaskId, // which you can use to check the status of the deletion. Before you call this // operation, confirm that the role has no active sessions and that any resources // used by the role in the linked service are deleted. If you call this operation // more than once for the same service-linked role and an earlier deletion task // is not complete, then the DeletionTaskId of the earlier request is returned. // // If you submit a deletion request for a service-linked role whose linked service // is still accessing a resource, then the deletion task fails. If it fails, // the GetServiceLinkedRoleDeletionStatus API operation returns the reason for // the failure, including the resources that must be deleted. To delete the // service-linked role, you must first remove those resources from the linked // service and then submit the deletion request again. Resources are specific // to the service that is linked to the role. For more information about removing // resources from a service, see the AWS documentation (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/) // for your service. // // For more information about service-linked roles, see Roles Terms and Concepts: // AWS Service-Linked Role (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/id_roles_terms-and-concepts.html#iam-term-service-linked-role) // in the IAM User Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation DeleteServiceLinkedRole for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/DeleteServiceLinkedRole func (c *IAM) DeleteServiceLinkedRole(input *DeleteServiceLinkedRoleInput) (*DeleteServiceLinkedRoleOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteServiceLinkedRoleRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DeleteServiceLinkedRoleWithContext is the same as DeleteServiceLinkedRole with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DeleteServiceLinkedRole for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) DeleteServiceLinkedRoleWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteServiceLinkedRoleInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteServiceLinkedRoleOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteServiceLinkedRoleRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opDeleteServiceSpecificCredential = "DeleteServiceSpecificCredential" // DeleteServiceSpecificCredentialRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DeleteServiceSpecificCredential operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DeleteServiceSpecificCredential for more information on using the DeleteServiceSpecificCredential // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DeleteServiceSpecificCredentialRequest method. // req, resp := client.DeleteServiceSpecificCredentialRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/DeleteServiceSpecificCredential func (c *IAM) DeleteServiceSpecificCredentialRequest(input *DeleteServiceSpecificCredentialInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteServiceSpecificCredentialOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDeleteServiceSpecificCredential, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &DeleteServiceSpecificCredentialInput{} } output = &DeleteServiceSpecificCredentialOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Remove(query.UnmarshalHandler) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBackNamed(protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // DeleteServiceSpecificCredential API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Deletes the specified service-specific credential. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation DeleteServiceSpecificCredential for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/DeleteServiceSpecificCredential func (c *IAM) DeleteServiceSpecificCredential(input *DeleteServiceSpecificCredentialInput) (*DeleteServiceSpecificCredentialOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteServiceSpecificCredentialRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DeleteServiceSpecificCredentialWithContext is the same as DeleteServiceSpecificCredential with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DeleteServiceSpecificCredential for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) DeleteServiceSpecificCredentialWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteServiceSpecificCredentialInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteServiceSpecificCredentialOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteServiceSpecificCredentialRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opDeleteSigningCertificate = "DeleteSigningCertificate" // DeleteSigningCertificateRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DeleteSigningCertificate operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DeleteSigningCertificate for more information on using the DeleteSigningCertificate // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DeleteSigningCertificateRequest method. // req, resp := client.DeleteSigningCertificateRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/DeleteSigningCertificate func (c *IAM) DeleteSigningCertificateRequest(input *DeleteSigningCertificateInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteSigningCertificateOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDeleteSigningCertificate, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &DeleteSigningCertificateInput{} } output = &DeleteSigningCertificateOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Remove(query.UnmarshalHandler) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBackNamed(protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // DeleteSigningCertificate API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Deletes a signing certificate associated with the specified IAM user. // // If you do not specify a user name, IAM determines the user name implicitly // based on the AWS access key ID signing the request. Because this action works // for access keys under the AWS account, you can use this action to manage // root credentials even if the AWS account has no associated IAM users. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation DeleteSigningCertificate for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/DeleteSigningCertificate func (c *IAM) DeleteSigningCertificate(input *DeleteSigningCertificateInput) (*DeleteSigningCertificateOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteSigningCertificateRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DeleteSigningCertificateWithContext is the same as DeleteSigningCertificate with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DeleteSigningCertificate for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) DeleteSigningCertificateWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteSigningCertificateInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteSigningCertificateOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteSigningCertificateRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opDeleteUser = "DeleteUser" // DeleteUserRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DeleteUser operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DeleteUser for more information on using the DeleteUser // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DeleteUserRequest method. // req, resp := client.DeleteUserRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/DeleteUser func (c *IAM) DeleteUserRequest(input *DeleteUserInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteUserOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDeleteUser, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &DeleteUserInput{} } output = &DeleteUserOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Remove(query.UnmarshalHandler) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBackNamed(protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // DeleteUser API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Deletes the specified IAM user. The user must not belong to any groups or // have any access keys, signing certificates, or attached policies. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation DeleteUser for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeDeleteConflictException "DeleteConflict" // The request was rejected because it attempted to delete a resource that has // attached subordinate entities. The error message describes these entities. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/DeleteUser func (c *IAM) DeleteUser(input *DeleteUserInput) (*DeleteUserOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteUserRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DeleteUserWithContext is the same as DeleteUser with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DeleteUser for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) DeleteUserWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteUserInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteUserOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteUserRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opDeleteUserPolicy = "DeleteUserPolicy" // DeleteUserPolicyRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DeleteUserPolicy operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DeleteUserPolicy for more information on using the DeleteUserPolicy // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DeleteUserPolicyRequest method. // req, resp := client.DeleteUserPolicyRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/DeleteUserPolicy func (c *IAM) DeleteUserPolicyRequest(input *DeleteUserPolicyInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteUserPolicyOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDeleteUserPolicy, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &DeleteUserPolicyInput{} } output = &DeleteUserPolicyOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Remove(query.UnmarshalHandler) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBackNamed(protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // DeleteUserPolicy API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Deletes the specified inline policy that is embedded in the specified IAM // user. // // A user can also have managed policies attached to it. To detach a managed // policy from a user, use DetachUserPolicy. For more information about policies, // refer to Managed Policies and Inline Policies (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation DeleteUserPolicy for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/DeleteUserPolicy func (c *IAM) DeleteUserPolicy(input *DeleteUserPolicyInput) (*DeleteUserPolicyOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteUserPolicyRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DeleteUserPolicyWithContext is the same as DeleteUserPolicy with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DeleteUserPolicy for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) DeleteUserPolicyWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteUserPolicyInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteUserPolicyOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteUserPolicyRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opDeleteVirtualMFADevice = "DeleteVirtualMFADevice" // DeleteVirtualMFADeviceRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DeleteVirtualMFADevice operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DeleteVirtualMFADevice for more information on using the DeleteVirtualMFADevice // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DeleteVirtualMFADeviceRequest method. // req, resp := client.DeleteVirtualMFADeviceRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/DeleteVirtualMFADevice func (c *IAM) DeleteVirtualMFADeviceRequest(input *DeleteVirtualMFADeviceInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteVirtualMFADeviceOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDeleteVirtualMFADevice, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &DeleteVirtualMFADeviceInput{} } output = &DeleteVirtualMFADeviceOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Remove(query.UnmarshalHandler) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBackNamed(protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // DeleteVirtualMFADevice API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Deletes a virtual MFA device. // // You must deactivate a user's virtual MFA device before you can delete it. // For information about deactivating MFA devices, see DeactivateMFADevice. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation DeleteVirtualMFADevice for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeDeleteConflictException "DeleteConflict" // The request was rejected because it attempted to delete a resource that has // attached subordinate entities. The error message describes these entities. // // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/DeleteVirtualMFADevice func (c *IAM) DeleteVirtualMFADevice(input *DeleteVirtualMFADeviceInput) (*DeleteVirtualMFADeviceOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteVirtualMFADeviceRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DeleteVirtualMFADeviceWithContext is the same as DeleteVirtualMFADevice with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DeleteVirtualMFADevice for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) DeleteVirtualMFADeviceWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteVirtualMFADeviceInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteVirtualMFADeviceOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteVirtualMFADeviceRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opDetachGroupPolicy = "DetachGroupPolicy" // DetachGroupPolicyRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DetachGroupPolicy operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DetachGroupPolicy for more information on using the DetachGroupPolicy // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DetachGroupPolicyRequest method. // req, resp := client.DetachGroupPolicyRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/DetachGroupPolicy func (c *IAM) DetachGroupPolicyRequest(input *DetachGroupPolicyInput) (req *request.Request, output *DetachGroupPolicyOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDetachGroupPolicy, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &DetachGroupPolicyInput{} } output = &DetachGroupPolicyOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Remove(query.UnmarshalHandler) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBackNamed(protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // DetachGroupPolicy API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Removes the specified managed policy from the specified IAM group. // // A group can also have inline policies embedded with it. To delete an inline // policy, use the DeleteGroupPolicy API. For information about policies, see // Managed Policies and Inline Policies (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation DetachGroupPolicy for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInput" // The request was rejected because an invalid or out-of-range value was supplied // for an input parameter. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/DetachGroupPolicy func (c *IAM) DetachGroupPolicy(input *DetachGroupPolicyInput) (*DetachGroupPolicyOutput, error) { req, out := c.DetachGroupPolicyRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DetachGroupPolicyWithContext is the same as DetachGroupPolicy with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DetachGroupPolicy for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) DetachGroupPolicyWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DetachGroupPolicyInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DetachGroupPolicyOutput, error) { req, out := c.DetachGroupPolicyRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opDetachRolePolicy = "DetachRolePolicy" // DetachRolePolicyRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DetachRolePolicy operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DetachRolePolicy for more information on using the DetachRolePolicy // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DetachRolePolicyRequest method. // req, resp := client.DetachRolePolicyRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/DetachRolePolicy func (c *IAM) DetachRolePolicyRequest(input *DetachRolePolicyInput) (req *request.Request, output *DetachRolePolicyOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDetachRolePolicy, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &DetachRolePolicyInput{} } output = &DetachRolePolicyOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Remove(query.UnmarshalHandler) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBackNamed(protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // DetachRolePolicy API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Removes the specified managed policy from the specified role. // // A role can also have inline policies embedded with it. To delete an inline // policy, use the DeleteRolePolicy API. For information about policies, see // Managed Policies and Inline Policies (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation DetachRolePolicy for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInput" // The request was rejected because an invalid or out-of-range value was supplied // for an input parameter. // // * ErrCodeUnmodifiableEntityException "UnmodifiableEntity" // The request was rejected because only the service that depends on the service-linked // role can modify or delete the role on your behalf. The error message includes // the name of the service that depends on this service-linked role. You must // request the change through that service. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/DetachRolePolicy func (c *IAM) DetachRolePolicy(input *DetachRolePolicyInput) (*DetachRolePolicyOutput, error) { req, out := c.DetachRolePolicyRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DetachRolePolicyWithContext is the same as DetachRolePolicy with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DetachRolePolicy for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) DetachRolePolicyWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DetachRolePolicyInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DetachRolePolicyOutput, error) { req, out := c.DetachRolePolicyRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opDetachUserPolicy = "DetachUserPolicy" // DetachUserPolicyRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DetachUserPolicy operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DetachUserPolicy for more information on using the DetachUserPolicy // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DetachUserPolicyRequest method. // req, resp := client.DetachUserPolicyRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/DetachUserPolicy func (c *IAM) DetachUserPolicyRequest(input *DetachUserPolicyInput) (req *request.Request, output *DetachUserPolicyOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDetachUserPolicy, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &DetachUserPolicyInput{} } output = &DetachUserPolicyOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Remove(query.UnmarshalHandler) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBackNamed(protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // DetachUserPolicy API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Removes the specified managed policy from the specified user. // // A user can also have inline policies embedded with it. To delete an inline // policy, use the DeleteUserPolicy API. For information about policies, see // Managed Policies and Inline Policies (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation DetachUserPolicy for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInput" // The request was rejected because an invalid or out-of-range value was supplied // for an input parameter. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/DetachUserPolicy func (c *IAM) DetachUserPolicy(input *DetachUserPolicyInput) (*DetachUserPolicyOutput, error) { req, out := c.DetachUserPolicyRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DetachUserPolicyWithContext is the same as DetachUserPolicy with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DetachUserPolicy for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) DetachUserPolicyWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DetachUserPolicyInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DetachUserPolicyOutput, error) { req, out := c.DetachUserPolicyRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opEnableMFADevice = "EnableMFADevice" // EnableMFADeviceRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the EnableMFADevice operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See EnableMFADevice for more information on using the EnableMFADevice // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the EnableMFADeviceRequest method. // req, resp := client.EnableMFADeviceRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/EnableMFADevice func (c *IAM) EnableMFADeviceRequest(input *EnableMFADeviceInput) (req *request.Request, output *EnableMFADeviceOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opEnableMFADevice, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &EnableMFADeviceInput{} } output = &EnableMFADeviceOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Remove(query.UnmarshalHandler) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBackNamed(protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // EnableMFADevice API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Enables the specified MFA device and associates it with the specified IAM // user. When enabled, the MFA device is required for every subsequent login // by the IAM user associated with the device. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation EnableMFADevice for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeEntityAlreadyExistsException "EntityAlreadyExists" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create a resource that already // exists. // // * ErrCodeEntityTemporarilyUnmodifiableException "EntityTemporarilyUnmodifiable" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that is temporarily // unmodifiable, such as a user name that was deleted and then recreated. The // error indicates that the request is likely to succeed if you try again after // waiting several minutes. The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeInvalidAuthenticationCodeException "InvalidAuthenticationCode" // The request was rejected because the authentication code was not recognized. // The error message describes the specific error. // // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/EnableMFADevice func (c *IAM) EnableMFADevice(input *EnableMFADeviceInput) (*EnableMFADeviceOutput, error) { req, out := c.EnableMFADeviceRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // EnableMFADeviceWithContext is the same as EnableMFADevice with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See EnableMFADevice for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) EnableMFADeviceWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *EnableMFADeviceInput, opts ...request.Option) (*EnableMFADeviceOutput, error) { req, out := c.EnableMFADeviceRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opGenerateCredentialReport = "GenerateCredentialReport" // GenerateCredentialReportRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the GenerateCredentialReport operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See GenerateCredentialReport for more information on using the GenerateCredentialReport // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the GenerateCredentialReportRequest method. // req, resp := client.GenerateCredentialReportRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/GenerateCredentialReport func (c *IAM) GenerateCredentialReportRequest(input *GenerateCredentialReportInput) (req *request.Request, output *GenerateCredentialReportOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opGenerateCredentialReport, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &GenerateCredentialReportInput{} } output = &GenerateCredentialReportOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // GenerateCredentialReport API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Generates a credential report for the AWS account. For more information about // the credential report, see Getting Credential Reports (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/credential-reports.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation GenerateCredentialReport for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/GenerateCredentialReport func (c *IAM) GenerateCredentialReport(input *GenerateCredentialReportInput) (*GenerateCredentialReportOutput, error) { req, out := c.GenerateCredentialReportRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // GenerateCredentialReportWithContext is the same as GenerateCredentialReport with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See GenerateCredentialReport for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) GenerateCredentialReportWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GenerateCredentialReportInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GenerateCredentialReportOutput, error) { req, out := c.GenerateCredentialReportRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opGetAccessKeyLastUsed = "GetAccessKeyLastUsed" // GetAccessKeyLastUsedRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the GetAccessKeyLastUsed operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See GetAccessKeyLastUsed for more information on using the GetAccessKeyLastUsed // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the GetAccessKeyLastUsedRequest method. // req, resp := client.GetAccessKeyLastUsedRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/GetAccessKeyLastUsed func (c *IAM) GetAccessKeyLastUsedRequest(input *GetAccessKeyLastUsedInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetAccessKeyLastUsedOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opGetAccessKeyLastUsed, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &GetAccessKeyLastUsedInput{} } output = &GetAccessKeyLastUsedOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // GetAccessKeyLastUsed API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Retrieves information about when the specified access key was last used. // The information includes the date and time of last use, along with the AWS // service and region that were specified in the last request made with that // key. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation GetAccessKeyLastUsed for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/GetAccessKeyLastUsed func (c *IAM) GetAccessKeyLastUsed(input *GetAccessKeyLastUsedInput) (*GetAccessKeyLastUsedOutput, error) { req, out := c.GetAccessKeyLastUsedRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // GetAccessKeyLastUsedWithContext is the same as GetAccessKeyLastUsed with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See GetAccessKeyLastUsed for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) GetAccessKeyLastUsedWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetAccessKeyLastUsedInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetAccessKeyLastUsedOutput, error) { req, out := c.GetAccessKeyLastUsedRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opGetAccountAuthorizationDetails = "GetAccountAuthorizationDetails" // GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the GetAccountAuthorizationDetails operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See GetAccountAuthorizationDetails for more information on using the GetAccountAuthorizationDetails // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsRequest method. // req, resp := client.GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/GetAccountAuthorizationDetails func (c *IAM) GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsRequest(input *GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opGetAccountAuthorizationDetails, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", Paginator: &request.Paginator{ InputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, LimitToken: "MaxItems", TruncationToken: "IsTruncated", }, } if input == nil { input = &GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsInput{} } output = &GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // GetAccountAuthorizationDetails API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Retrieves information about all IAM users, groups, roles, and policies in // your AWS account, including their relationships to one another. Use this // API to obtain a snapshot of the configuration of IAM permissions (users, // groups, roles, and policies) in your account. // // You can optionally filter the results using the Filter parameter. You can // paginate the results using the MaxItems and Marker parameters. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation GetAccountAuthorizationDetails for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/GetAccountAuthorizationDetails func (c *IAM) GetAccountAuthorizationDetails(input *GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsInput) (*GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsOutput, error) { req, out := c.GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsWithContext is the same as GetAccountAuthorizationDetails with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See GetAccountAuthorizationDetails for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsOutput, error) { req, out := c.GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } // GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsPages iterates over the pages of a GetAccountAuthorizationDetails operation, // calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop // iterating, return false from the fn function. // // See GetAccountAuthorizationDetails method for more information on how to use this operation. // // Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service. // // // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a GetAccountAuthorizationDetails operation. // pageNum := 0 // err := client.GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsPages(params, // func(page *GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsOutput, lastPage bool) bool { // pageNum++ // fmt.Println(page) // return pageNum <= 3 // }) // func (c *IAM) GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsPages(input *GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsInput, fn func(*GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsOutput, bool) bool) error { return c.GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn) } // GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsPagesWithContext same as GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsPages except // it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsInput, fn func(*GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error { p := request.Pagination{ NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) { var inCpy *GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsInput if input != nil { tmp := *input inCpy = &tmp } req, _ := c.GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsRequest(inCpy) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return req, nil }, } cont := true for p.Next() && cont { cont = fn(p.Page().(*GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsOutput), !p.HasNextPage()) } return p.Err() } const opGetAccountPasswordPolicy = "GetAccountPasswordPolicy" // GetAccountPasswordPolicyRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the GetAccountPasswordPolicy operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See GetAccountPasswordPolicy for more information on using the GetAccountPasswordPolicy // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the GetAccountPasswordPolicyRequest method. // req, resp := client.GetAccountPasswordPolicyRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/GetAccountPasswordPolicy func (c *IAM) GetAccountPasswordPolicyRequest(input *GetAccountPasswordPolicyInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetAccountPasswordPolicyOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opGetAccountPasswordPolicy, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &GetAccountPasswordPolicyInput{} } output = &GetAccountPasswordPolicyOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // GetAccountPasswordPolicy API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Retrieves the password policy for the AWS account. For more information about // using a password policy, go to Managing an IAM Password Policy (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/Using_ManagingPasswordPolicies.html). // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation GetAccountPasswordPolicy for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/GetAccountPasswordPolicy func (c *IAM) GetAccountPasswordPolicy(input *GetAccountPasswordPolicyInput) (*GetAccountPasswordPolicyOutput, error) { req, out := c.GetAccountPasswordPolicyRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // GetAccountPasswordPolicyWithContext is the same as GetAccountPasswordPolicy with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See GetAccountPasswordPolicy for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) GetAccountPasswordPolicyWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetAccountPasswordPolicyInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetAccountPasswordPolicyOutput, error) { req, out := c.GetAccountPasswordPolicyRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opGetAccountSummary = "GetAccountSummary" // GetAccountSummaryRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the GetAccountSummary operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See GetAccountSummary for more information on using the GetAccountSummary // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the GetAccountSummaryRequest method. // req, resp := client.GetAccountSummaryRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/GetAccountSummary func (c *IAM) GetAccountSummaryRequest(input *GetAccountSummaryInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetAccountSummaryOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opGetAccountSummary, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &GetAccountSummaryInput{} } output = &GetAccountSummaryOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // GetAccountSummary API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Retrieves information about IAM entity usage and IAM quotas in the AWS account. // // For information about limitations on IAM entities, see Limitations on IAM // Entities (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/LimitationsOnEntities.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation GetAccountSummary for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/GetAccountSummary func (c *IAM) GetAccountSummary(input *GetAccountSummaryInput) (*GetAccountSummaryOutput, error) { req, out := c.GetAccountSummaryRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // GetAccountSummaryWithContext is the same as GetAccountSummary with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See GetAccountSummary for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) GetAccountSummaryWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetAccountSummaryInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetAccountSummaryOutput, error) { req, out := c.GetAccountSummaryRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opGetContextKeysForCustomPolicy = "GetContextKeysForCustomPolicy" // GetContextKeysForCustomPolicyRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the GetContextKeysForCustomPolicy operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See GetContextKeysForCustomPolicy for more information on using the GetContextKeysForCustomPolicy // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the GetContextKeysForCustomPolicyRequest method. // req, resp := client.GetContextKeysForCustomPolicyRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/GetContextKeysForCustomPolicy func (c *IAM) GetContextKeysForCustomPolicyRequest(input *GetContextKeysForCustomPolicyInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetContextKeysForPolicyResponse) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opGetContextKeysForCustomPolicy, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &GetContextKeysForCustomPolicyInput{} } output = &GetContextKeysForPolicyResponse{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // GetContextKeysForCustomPolicy API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Gets a list of all of the context keys referenced in the input policies. // The policies are supplied as a list of one or more strings. To get the context // keys from policies associated with an IAM user, group, or role, use GetContextKeysForPrincipalPolicy. // // Context keys are variables maintained by AWS and its services that provide // details about the context of an API query request, and can be evaluated by // testing against a value specified in an IAM policy. Use GetContextKeysForCustomPolicy // to understand what key names and values you must supply when you call SimulateCustomPolicy. // Note that all parameters are shown in unencoded form here for clarity, but // must be URL encoded to be included as a part of a real HTML request. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation GetContextKeysForCustomPolicy for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInput" // The request was rejected because an invalid or out-of-range value was supplied // for an input parameter. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/GetContextKeysForCustomPolicy func (c *IAM) GetContextKeysForCustomPolicy(input *GetContextKeysForCustomPolicyInput) (*GetContextKeysForPolicyResponse, error) { req, out := c.GetContextKeysForCustomPolicyRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // GetContextKeysForCustomPolicyWithContext is the same as GetContextKeysForCustomPolicy with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See GetContextKeysForCustomPolicy for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) GetContextKeysForCustomPolicyWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetContextKeysForCustomPolicyInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetContextKeysForPolicyResponse, error) { req, out := c.GetContextKeysForCustomPolicyRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opGetContextKeysForPrincipalPolicy = "GetContextKeysForPrincipalPolicy" // GetContextKeysForPrincipalPolicyRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the GetContextKeysForPrincipalPolicy operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See GetContextKeysForPrincipalPolicy for more information on using the GetContextKeysForPrincipalPolicy // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the GetContextKeysForPrincipalPolicyRequest method. // req, resp := client.GetContextKeysForPrincipalPolicyRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/GetContextKeysForPrincipalPolicy func (c *IAM) GetContextKeysForPrincipalPolicyRequest(input *GetContextKeysForPrincipalPolicyInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetContextKeysForPolicyResponse) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opGetContextKeysForPrincipalPolicy, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &GetContextKeysForPrincipalPolicyInput{} } output = &GetContextKeysForPolicyResponse{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // GetContextKeysForPrincipalPolicy API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Gets a list of all of the context keys referenced in all of the IAM policies // attached to the specified IAM entity. The entity can be an IAM user, group, // or role. If you specify a user, then the request also includes all of the // policies attached to groups that the user is a member of. // // You can optionally include a list of one or more additional policies, specified // as strings. If you want to include only a list of policies by string, use // GetContextKeysForCustomPolicy instead. // // Note: This API discloses information about the permissions granted to other // users. If you do not want users to see other user's permissions, then consider // allowing them to use GetContextKeysForCustomPolicy instead. // // Context keys are variables maintained by AWS and its services that provide // details about the context of an API query request, and can be evaluated by // testing against a value in an IAM policy. Use GetContextKeysForPrincipalPolicy // to understand what key names and values you must supply when you call SimulatePrincipalPolicy. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation GetContextKeysForPrincipalPolicy for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInput" // The request was rejected because an invalid or out-of-range value was supplied // for an input parameter. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/GetContextKeysForPrincipalPolicy func (c *IAM) GetContextKeysForPrincipalPolicy(input *GetContextKeysForPrincipalPolicyInput) (*GetContextKeysForPolicyResponse, error) { req, out := c.GetContextKeysForPrincipalPolicyRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // GetContextKeysForPrincipalPolicyWithContext is the same as GetContextKeysForPrincipalPolicy with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See GetContextKeysForPrincipalPolicy for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) GetContextKeysForPrincipalPolicyWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetContextKeysForPrincipalPolicyInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetContextKeysForPolicyResponse, error) { req, out := c.GetContextKeysForPrincipalPolicyRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opGetCredentialReport = "GetCredentialReport" // GetCredentialReportRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the GetCredentialReport operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See GetCredentialReport for more information on using the GetCredentialReport // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the GetCredentialReportRequest method. // req, resp := client.GetCredentialReportRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/GetCredentialReport func (c *IAM) GetCredentialReportRequest(input *GetCredentialReportInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetCredentialReportOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opGetCredentialReport, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &GetCredentialReportInput{} } output = &GetCredentialReportOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // GetCredentialReport API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Retrieves a credential report for the AWS account. For more information about // the credential report, see Getting Credential Reports (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/credential-reports.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation GetCredentialReport for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeCredentialReportNotPresentException "ReportNotPresent" // The request was rejected because the credential report does not exist. To // generate a credential report, use GenerateCredentialReport. // // * ErrCodeCredentialReportExpiredException "ReportExpired" // The request was rejected because the most recent credential report has expired. // To generate a new credential report, use GenerateCredentialReport. For more // information about credential report expiration, see Getting Credential Reports // (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/credential-reports.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // * ErrCodeCredentialReportNotReadyException "ReportInProgress" // The request was rejected because the credential report is still being generated. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/GetCredentialReport func (c *IAM) GetCredentialReport(input *GetCredentialReportInput) (*GetCredentialReportOutput, error) { req, out := c.GetCredentialReportRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // GetCredentialReportWithContext is the same as GetCredentialReport with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See GetCredentialReport for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) GetCredentialReportWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetCredentialReportInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetCredentialReportOutput, error) { req, out := c.GetCredentialReportRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opGetGroup = "GetGroup" // GetGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the GetGroup operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See GetGroup for more information on using the GetGroup // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the GetGroupRequest method. // req, resp := client.GetGroupRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/GetGroup func (c *IAM) GetGroupRequest(input *GetGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetGroupOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opGetGroup, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", Paginator: &request.Paginator{ InputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, LimitToken: "MaxItems", TruncationToken: "IsTruncated", }, } if input == nil { input = &GetGroupInput{} } output = &GetGroupOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // GetGroup API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Returns a list of IAM users that are in the specified IAM group. You can // paginate the results using the MaxItems and Marker parameters. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation GetGroup for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/GetGroup func (c *IAM) GetGroup(input *GetGroupInput) (*GetGroupOutput, error) { req, out := c.GetGroupRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // GetGroupWithContext is the same as GetGroup with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See GetGroup for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) GetGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetGroupOutput, error) { req, out := c.GetGroupRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } // GetGroupPages iterates over the pages of a GetGroup operation, // calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop // iterating, return false from the fn function. // // See GetGroup method for more information on how to use this operation. // // Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service. // // // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a GetGroup operation. // pageNum := 0 // err := client.GetGroupPages(params, // func(page *GetGroupOutput, lastPage bool) bool { // pageNum++ // fmt.Println(page) // return pageNum <= 3 // }) // func (c *IAM) GetGroupPages(input *GetGroupInput, fn func(*GetGroupOutput, bool) bool) error { return c.GetGroupPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn) } // GetGroupPagesWithContext same as GetGroupPages except // it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) GetGroupPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetGroupInput, fn func(*GetGroupOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error { p := request.Pagination{ NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) { var inCpy *GetGroupInput if input != nil { tmp := *input inCpy = &tmp } req, _ := c.GetGroupRequest(inCpy) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return req, nil }, } cont := true for p.Next() && cont { cont = fn(p.Page().(*GetGroupOutput), !p.HasNextPage()) } return p.Err() } const opGetGroupPolicy = "GetGroupPolicy" // GetGroupPolicyRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the GetGroupPolicy operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See GetGroupPolicy for more information on using the GetGroupPolicy // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the GetGroupPolicyRequest method. // req, resp := client.GetGroupPolicyRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/GetGroupPolicy func (c *IAM) GetGroupPolicyRequest(input *GetGroupPolicyInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetGroupPolicyOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opGetGroupPolicy, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &GetGroupPolicyInput{} } output = &GetGroupPolicyOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // GetGroupPolicy API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Retrieves the specified inline policy document that is embedded in the specified // IAM group. // // Policies returned by this API are URL-encoded compliant with RFC 3986 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3986). // You can use a URL decoding method to convert the policy back to plain JSON // text. For example, if you use Java, you can use the decode method of the // java.net.URLDecoder utility class in the Java SDK. Other languages and SDKs // provide similar functionality. // // An IAM group can also have managed policies attached to it. To retrieve a // managed policy document that is attached to a group, use GetPolicy to determine // the policy's default version, then use GetPolicyVersion to retrieve the policy // document. // // For more information about policies, see Managed Policies and Inline Policies // (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation GetGroupPolicy for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/GetGroupPolicy func (c *IAM) GetGroupPolicy(input *GetGroupPolicyInput) (*GetGroupPolicyOutput, error) { req, out := c.GetGroupPolicyRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // GetGroupPolicyWithContext is the same as GetGroupPolicy with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See GetGroupPolicy for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) GetGroupPolicyWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetGroupPolicyInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetGroupPolicyOutput, error) { req, out := c.GetGroupPolicyRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opGetInstanceProfile = "GetInstanceProfile" // GetInstanceProfileRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the GetInstanceProfile operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See GetInstanceProfile for more information on using the GetInstanceProfile // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the GetInstanceProfileRequest method. // req, resp := client.GetInstanceProfileRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/GetInstanceProfile func (c *IAM) GetInstanceProfileRequest(input *GetInstanceProfileInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetInstanceProfileOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opGetInstanceProfile, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &GetInstanceProfileInput{} } output = &GetInstanceProfileOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // GetInstanceProfile API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Retrieves information about the specified instance profile, including the // instance profile's path, GUID, ARN, and role. For more information about // instance profiles, see About Instance Profiles (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/AboutInstanceProfiles.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation GetInstanceProfile for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/GetInstanceProfile func (c *IAM) GetInstanceProfile(input *GetInstanceProfileInput) (*GetInstanceProfileOutput, error) { req, out := c.GetInstanceProfileRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // GetInstanceProfileWithContext is the same as GetInstanceProfile with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See GetInstanceProfile for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) GetInstanceProfileWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetInstanceProfileInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetInstanceProfileOutput, error) { req, out := c.GetInstanceProfileRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opGetLoginProfile = "GetLoginProfile" // GetLoginProfileRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the GetLoginProfile operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See GetLoginProfile for more information on using the GetLoginProfile // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the GetLoginProfileRequest method. // req, resp := client.GetLoginProfileRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/GetLoginProfile func (c *IAM) GetLoginProfileRequest(input *GetLoginProfileInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetLoginProfileOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opGetLoginProfile, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &GetLoginProfileInput{} } output = &GetLoginProfileOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // GetLoginProfile API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Retrieves the user name and password-creation date for the specified IAM // user. If the user has not been assigned a password, the action returns a // 404 (NoSuchEntity) error. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation GetLoginProfile for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/GetLoginProfile func (c *IAM) GetLoginProfile(input *GetLoginProfileInput) (*GetLoginProfileOutput, error) { req, out := c.GetLoginProfileRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // GetLoginProfileWithContext is the same as GetLoginProfile with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See GetLoginProfile for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) GetLoginProfileWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetLoginProfileInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetLoginProfileOutput, error) { req, out := c.GetLoginProfileRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opGetOpenIDConnectProvider = "GetOpenIDConnectProvider" // GetOpenIDConnectProviderRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the GetOpenIDConnectProvider operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See GetOpenIDConnectProvider for more information on using the GetOpenIDConnectProvider // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the GetOpenIDConnectProviderRequest method. // req, resp := client.GetOpenIDConnectProviderRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/GetOpenIDConnectProvider func (c *IAM) GetOpenIDConnectProviderRequest(input *GetOpenIDConnectProviderInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetOpenIDConnectProviderOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opGetOpenIDConnectProvider, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &GetOpenIDConnectProviderInput{} } output = &GetOpenIDConnectProviderOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // GetOpenIDConnectProvider API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Returns information about the specified OpenID Connect (OIDC) provider resource // object in IAM. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation GetOpenIDConnectProvider for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInput" // The request was rejected because an invalid or out-of-range value was supplied // for an input parameter. // // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/GetOpenIDConnectProvider func (c *IAM) GetOpenIDConnectProvider(input *GetOpenIDConnectProviderInput) (*GetOpenIDConnectProviderOutput, error) { req, out := c.GetOpenIDConnectProviderRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // GetOpenIDConnectProviderWithContext is the same as GetOpenIDConnectProvider with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See GetOpenIDConnectProvider for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) GetOpenIDConnectProviderWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetOpenIDConnectProviderInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetOpenIDConnectProviderOutput, error) { req, out := c.GetOpenIDConnectProviderRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opGetPolicy = "GetPolicy" // GetPolicyRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the GetPolicy operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See GetPolicy for more information on using the GetPolicy // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the GetPolicyRequest method. // req, resp := client.GetPolicyRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/GetPolicy func (c *IAM) GetPolicyRequest(input *GetPolicyInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetPolicyOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opGetPolicy, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &GetPolicyInput{} } output = &GetPolicyOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // GetPolicy API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Retrieves information about the specified managed policy, including the policy's // default version and the total number of IAM users, groups, and roles to which // the policy is attached. To retrieve the list of the specific users, groups, // and roles that the policy is attached to, use the ListEntitiesForPolicy API. // This API returns metadata about the policy. To retrieve the actual policy // document for a specific version of the policy, use GetPolicyVersion. // // This API retrieves information about managed policies. To retrieve information // about an inline policy that is embedded with an IAM user, group, or role, // use the GetUserPolicy, GetGroupPolicy, or GetRolePolicy API. // // For more information about policies, see Managed Policies and Inline Policies // (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation GetPolicy for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInput" // The request was rejected because an invalid or out-of-range value was supplied // for an input parameter. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/GetPolicy func (c *IAM) GetPolicy(input *GetPolicyInput) (*GetPolicyOutput, error) { req, out := c.GetPolicyRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // GetPolicyWithContext is the same as GetPolicy with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See GetPolicy for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) GetPolicyWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetPolicyInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetPolicyOutput, error) { req, out := c.GetPolicyRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opGetPolicyVersion = "GetPolicyVersion" // GetPolicyVersionRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the GetPolicyVersion operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See GetPolicyVersion for more information on using the GetPolicyVersion // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the GetPolicyVersionRequest method. // req, resp := client.GetPolicyVersionRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/GetPolicyVersion func (c *IAM) GetPolicyVersionRequest(input *GetPolicyVersionInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetPolicyVersionOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opGetPolicyVersion, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &GetPolicyVersionInput{} } output = &GetPolicyVersionOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // GetPolicyVersion API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Retrieves information about the specified version of the specified managed // policy, including the policy document. // // Policies returned by this API are URL-encoded compliant with RFC 3986 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3986). // You can use a URL decoding method to convert the policy back to plain JSON // text. For example, if you use Java, you can use the decode method of the // java.net.URLDecoder utility class in the Java SDK. Other languages and SDKs // provide similar functionality. // // To list the available versions for a policy, use ListPolicyVersions. // // This API retrieves information about managed policies. To retrieve information // about an inline policy that is embedded in a user, group, or role, use the // GetUserPolicy, GetGroupPolicy, or GetRolePolicy API. // // For more information about the types of policies, see Managed Policies and // Inline Policies (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // For more information about managed policy versions, see Versioning for Managed // Policies (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-versions.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation GetPolicyVersion for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInput" // The request was rejected because an invalid or out-of-range value was supplied // for an input parameter. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/GetPolicyVersion func (c *IAM) GetPolicyVersion(input *GetPolicyVersionInput) (*GetPolicyVersionOutput, error) { req, out := c.GetPolicyVersionRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // GetPolicyVersionWithContext is the same as GetPolicyVersion with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See GetPolicyVersion for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) GetPolicyVersionWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetPolicyVersionInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetPolicyVersionOutput, error) { req, out := c.GetPolicyVersionRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opGetRole = "GetRole" // GetRoleRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the GetRole operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See GetRole for more information on using the GetRole // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the GetRoleRequest method. // req, resp := client.GetRoleRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/GetRole func (c *IAM) GetRoleRequest(input *GetRoleInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetRoleOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opGetRole, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &GetRoleInput{} } output = &GetRoleOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // GetRole API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Retrieves information about the specified role, including the role's path, // GUID, ARN, and the role's trust policy that grants permission to assume the // role. For more information about roles, see Working with Roles (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/WorkingWithRoles.html). // // Policies returned by this API are URL-encoded compliant with RFC 3986 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3986). // You can use a URL decoding method to convert the policy back to plain JSON // text. For example, if you use Java, you can use the decode method of the // java.net.URLDecoder utility class in the Java SDK. Other languages and SDKs // provide similar functionality. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation GetRole for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/GetRole func (c *IAM) GetRole(input *GetRoleInput) (*GetRoleOutput, error) { req, out := c.GetRoleRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // GetRoleWithContext is the same as GetRole with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See GetRole for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) GetRoleWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetRoleInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetRoleOutput, error) { req, out := c.GetRoleRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opGetRolePolicy = "GetRolePolicy" // GetRolePolicyRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the GetRolePolicy operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See GetRolePolicy for more information on using the GetRolePolicy // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the GetRolePolicyRequest method. // req, resp := client.GetRolePolicyRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/GetRolePolicy func (c *IAM) GetRolePolicyRequest(input *GetRolePolicyInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetRolePolicyOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opGetRolePolicy, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &GetRolePolicyInput{} } output = &GetRolePolicyOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // GetRolePolicy API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Retrieves the specified inline policy document that is embedded with the // specified IAM role. // // Policies returned by this API are URL-encoded compliant with RFC 3986 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3986). // You can use a URL decoding method to convert the policy back to plain JSON // text. For example, if you use Java, you can use the decode method of the // java.net.URLDecoder utility class in the Java SDK. Other languages and SDKs // provide similar functionality. // // An IAM role can also have managed policies attached to it. To retrieve a // managed policy document that is attached to a role, use GetPolicy to determine // the policy's default version, then use GetPolicyVersion to retrieve the policy // document. // // For more information about policies, see Managed Policies and Inline Policies // (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // For more information about roles, see Using Roles to Delegate Permissions // and Federate Identities (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/roles-toplevel.html). // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation GetRolePolicy for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/GetRolePolicy func (c *IAM) GetRolePolicy(input *GetRolePolicyInput) (*GetRolePolicyOutput, error) { req, out := c.GetRolePolicyRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // GetRolePolicyWithContext is the same as GetRolePolicy with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See GetRolePolicy for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) GetRolePolicyWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetRolePolicyInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetRolePolicyOutput, error) { req, out := c.GetRolePolicyRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opGetSAMLProvider = "GetSAMLProvider" // GetSAMLProviderRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the GetSAMLProvider operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See GetSAMLProvider for more information on using the GetSAMLProvider // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the GetSAMLProviderRequest method. // req, resp := client.GetSAMLProviderRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/GetSAMLProvider func (c *IAM) GetSAMLProviderRequest(input *GetSAMLProviderInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetSAMLProviderOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opGetSAMLProvider, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &GetSAMLProviderInput{} } output = &GetSAMLProviderOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // GetSAMLProvider API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Returns the SAML provider metadocument that was uploaded when the IAM SAML // provider resource object was created or updated. // // This operation requires Signature Version 4 (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/signature-version-4.html). // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation GetSAMLProvider for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInput" // The request was rejected because an invalid or out-of-range value was supplied // for an input parameter. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/GetSAMLProvider func (c *IAM) GetSAMLProvider(input *GetSAMLProviderInput) (*GetSAMLProviderOutput, error) { req, out := c.GetSAMLProviderRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // GetSAMLProviderWithContext is the same as GetSAMLProvider with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See GetSAMLProvider for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) GetSAMLProviderWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetSAMLProviderInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetSAMLProviderOutput, error) { req, out := c.GetSAMLProviderRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opGetSSHPublicKey = "GetSSHPublicKey" // GetSSHPublicKeyRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the GetSSHPublicKey operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See GetSSHPublicKey for more information on using the GetSSHPublicKey // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the GetSSHPublicKeyRequest method. // req, resp := client.GetSSHPublicKeyRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/GetSSHPublicKey func (c *IAM) GetSSHPublicKeyRequest(input *GetSSHPublicKeyInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetSSHPublicKeyOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opGetSSHPublicKey, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &GetSSHPublicKeyInput{} } output = &GetSSHPublicKeyOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // GetSSHPublicKey API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Retrieves the specified SSH public key, including metadata about the key. // // The SSH public key retrieved by this action is used only for authenticating // the associated IAM user to an AWS CodeCommit repository. For more information // about using SSH keys to authenticate to an AWS CodeCommit repository, see // Set up AWS CodeCommit for SSH Connections (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/codecommit/latest/userguide/setting-up-credentials-ssh.html) // in the AWS CodeCommit User Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation GetSSHPublicKey for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeUnrecognizedPublicKeyEncodingException "UnrecognizedPublicKeyEncoding" // The request was rejected because the public key encoding format is unsupported // or unrecognized. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/GetSSHPublicKey func (c *IAM) GetSSHPublicKey(input *GetSSHPublicKeyInput) (*GetSSHPublicKeyOutput, error) { req, out := c.GetSSHPublicKeyRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // GetSSHPublicKeyWithContext is the same as GetSSHPublicKey with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See GetSSHPublicKey for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) GetSSHPublicKeyWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetSSHPublicKeyInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetSSHPublicKeyOutput, error) { req, out := c.GetSSHPublicKeyRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opGetServerCertificate = "GetServerCertificate" // GetServerCertificateRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the GetServerCertificate operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See GetServerCertificate for more information on using the GetServerCertificate // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the GetServerCertificateRequest method. // req, resp := client.GetServerCertificateRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/GetServerCertificate func (c *IAM) GetServerCertificateRequest(input *GetServerCertificateInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetServerCertificateOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opGetServerCertificate, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &GetServerCertificateInput{} } output = &GetServerCertificateOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // GetServerCertificate API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Retrieves information about the specified server certificate stored in IAM. // // For more information about working with server certificates, including a // list of AWS services that can use the server certificates that you manage // with IAM, go to Working with Server Certificates (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/id_credentials_server-certs.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation GetServerCertificate for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/GetServerCertificate func (c *IAM) GetServerCertificate(input *GetServerCertificateInput) (*GetServerCertificateOutput, error) { req, out := c.GetServerCertificateRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // GetServerCertificateWithContext is the same as GetServerCertificate with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See GetServerCertificate for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) GetServerCertificateWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetServerCertificateInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetServerCertificateOutput, error) { req, out := c.GetServerCertificateRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opGetServiceLinkedRoleDeletionStatus = "GetServiceLinkedRoleDeletionStatus" // GetServiceLinkedRoleDeletionStatusRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the GetServiceLinkedRoleDeletionStatus operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See GetServiceLinkedRoleDeletionStatus for more information on using the GetServiceLinkedRoleDeletionStatus // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the GetServiceLinkedRoleDeletionStatusRequest method. // req, resp := client.GetServiceLinkedRoleDeletionStatusRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/GetServiceLinkedRoleDeletionStatus func (c *IAM) GetServiceLinkedRoleDeletionStatusRequest(input *GetServiceLinkedRoleDeletionStatusInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetServiceLinkedRoleDeletionStatusOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opGetServiceLinkedRoleDeletionStatus, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &GetServiceLinkedRoleDeletionStatusInput{} } output = &GetServiceLinkedRoleDeletionStatusOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // GetServiceLinkedRoleDeletionStatus API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Retrieves the status of your service-linked role deletion. After you use // the DeleteServiceLinkedRole API operation to submit a service-linked role // for deletion, you can use the DeletionTaskId parameter in GetServiceLinkedRoleDeletionStatus // to check the status of the deletion. If the deletion fails, this operation // returns the reason that it failed. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation GetServiceLinkedRoleDeletionStatus for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInput" // The request was rejected because an invalid or out-of-range value was supplied // for an input parameter. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/GetServiceLinkedRoleDeletionStatus func (c *IAM) GetServiceLinkedRoleDeletionStatus(input *GetServiceLinkedRoleDeletionStatusInput) (*GetServiceLinkedRoleDeletionStatusOutput, error) { req, out := c.GetServiceLinkedRoleDeletionStatusRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // GetServiceLinkedRoleDeletionStatusWithContext is the same as GetServiceLinkedRoleDeletionStatus with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See GetServiceLinkedRoleDeletionStatus for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) GetServiceLinkedRoleDeletionStatusWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetServiceLinkedRoleDeletionStatusInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetServiceLinkedRoleDeletionStatusOutput, error) { req, out := c.GetServiceLinkedRoleDeletionStatusRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opGetUser = "GetUser" // GetUserRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the GetUser operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See GetUser for more information on using the GetUser // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the GetUserRequest method. // req, resp := client.GetUserRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/GetUser func (c *IAM) GetUserRequest(input *GetUserInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetUserOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opGetUser, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &GetUserInput{} } output = &GetUserOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // GetUser API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Retrieves information about the specified IAM user, including the user's // creation date, path, unique ID, and ARN. // // If you do not specify a user name, IAM determines the user name implicitly // based on the AWS access key ID used to sign the request to this API. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation GetUser for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/GetUser func (c *IAM) GetUser(input *GetUserInput) (*GetUserOutput, error) { req, out := c.GetUserRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // GetUserWithContext is the same as GetUser with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See GetUser for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) GetUserWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetUserInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetUserOutput, error) { req, out := c.GetUserRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opGetUserPolicy = "GetUserPolicy" // GetUserPolicyRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the GetUserPolicy operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See GetUserPolicy for more information on using the GetUserPolicy // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the GetUserPolicyRequest method. // req, resp := client.GetUserPolicyRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/GetUserPolicy func (c *IAM) GetUserPolicyRequest(input *GetUserPolicyInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetUserPolicyOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opGetUserPolicy, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &GetUserPolicyInput{} } output = &GetUserPolicyOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // GetUserPolicy API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Retrieves the specified inline policy document that is embedded in the specified // IAM user. // // Policies returned by this API are URL-encoded compliant with RFC 3986 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3986). // You can use a URL decoding method to convert the policy back to plain JSON // text. For example, if you use Java, you can use the decode method of the // java.net.URLDecoder utility class in the Java SDK. Other languages and SDKs // provide similar functionality. // // An IAM user can also have managed policies attached to it. To retrieve a // managed policy document that is attached to a user, use GetPolicy to determine // the policy's default version, then use GetPolicyVersion to retrieve the policy // document. // // For more information about policies, see Managed Policies and Inline Policies // (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation GetUserPolicy for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/GetUserPolicy func (c *IAM) GetUserPolicy(input *GetUserPolicyInput) (*GetUserPolicyOutput, error) { req, out := c.GetUserPolicyRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // GetUserPolicyWithContext is the same as GetUserPolicy with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See GetUserPolicy for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) GetUserPolicyWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetUserPolicyInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetUserPolicyOutput, error) { req, out := c.GetUserPolicyRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opListAccessKeys = "ListAccessKeys" // ListAccessKeysRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the ListAccessKeys operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See ListAccessKeys for more information on using the ListAccessKeys // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the ListAccessKeysRequest method. // req, resp := client.ListAccessKeysRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/ListAccessKeys func (c *IAM) ListAccessKeysRequest(input *ListAccessKeysInput) (req *request.Request, output *ListAccessKeysOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opListAccessKeys, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", Paginator: &request.Paginator{ InputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, LimitToken: "MaxItems", TruncationToken: "IsTruncated", }, } if input == nil { input = &ListAccessKeysInput{} } output = &ListAccessKeysOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // ListAccessKeys API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Returns information about the access key IDs associated with the specified // IAM user. If there are none, the action returns an empty list. // // Although each user is limited to a small number of keys, you can still paginate // the results using the MaxItems and Marker parameters. // // If the UserName field is not specified, the UserName is determined implicitly // based on the AWS access key ID used to sign the request. Because this action // works for access keys under the AWS account, you can use this action to manage // root credentials even if the AWS account has no associated users. // // To ensure the security of your AWS account, the secret access key is accessible // only during key and user creation. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation ListAccessKeys for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/ListAccessKeys func (c *IAM) ListAccessKeys(input *ListAccessKeysInput) (*ListAccessKeysOutput, error) { req, out := c.ListAccessKeysRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // ListAccessKeysWithContext is the same as ListAccessKeys with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See ListAccessKeys for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) ListAccessKeysWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListAccessKeysInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ListAccessKeysOutput, error) { req, out := c.ListAccessKeysRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } // ListAccessKeysPages iterates over the pages of a ListAccessKeys operation, // calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop // iterating, return false from the fn function. // // See ListAccessKeys method for more information on how to use this operation. // // Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service. // // // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a ListAccessKeys operation. // pageNum := 0 // err := client.ListAccessKeysPages(params, // func(page *ListAccessKeysOutput, lastPage bool) bool { // pageNum++ // fmt.Println(page) // return pageNum <= 3 // }) // func (c *IAM) ListAccessKeysPages(input *ListAccessKeysInput, fn func(*ListAccessKeysOutput, bool) bool) error { return c.ListAccessKeysPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn) } // ListAccessKeysPagesWithContext same as ListAccessKeysPages except // it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) ListAccessKeysPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListAccessKeysInput, fn func(*ListAccessKeysOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error { p := request.Pagination{ NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) { var inCpy *ListAccessKeysInput if input != nil { tmp := *input inCpy = &tmp } req, _ := c.ListAccessKeysRequest(inCpy) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return req, nil }, } cont := true for p.Next() && cont { cont = fn(p.Page().(*ListAccessKeysOutput), !p.HasNextPage()) } return p.Err() } const opListAccountAliases = "ListAccountAliases" // ListAccountAliasesRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the ListAccountAliases operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See ListAccountAliases for more information on using the ListAccountAliases // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the ListAccountAliasesRequest method. // req, resp := client.ListAccountAliasesRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/ListAccountAliases func (c *IAM) ListAccountAliasesRequest(input *ListAccountAliasesInput) (req *request.Request, output *ListAccountAliasesOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opListAccountAliases, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", Paginator: &request.Paginator{ InputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, LimitToken: "MaxItems", TruncationToken: "IsTruncated", }, } if input == nil { input = &ListAccountAliasesInput{} } output = &ListAccountAliasesOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // ListAccountAliases API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Lists the account alias associated with the AWS account (Note: you can have // only one). For information about using an AWS account alias, see Using an // Alias for Your AWS Account ID (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/AccountAlias.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation ListAccountAliases for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/ListAccountAliases func (c *IAM) ListAccountAliases(input *ListAccountAliasesInput) (*ListAccountAliasesOutput, error) { req, out := c.ListAccountAliasesRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // ListAccountAliasesWithContext is the same as ListAccountAliases with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See ListAccountAliases for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) ListAccountAliasesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListAccountAliasesInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ListAccountAliasesOutput, error) { req, out := c.ListAccountAliasesRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } // ListAccountAliasesPages iterates over the pages of a ListAccountAliases operation, // calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop // iterating, return false from the fn function. // // See ListAccountAliases method for more information on how to use this operation. // // Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service. // // // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a ListAccountAliases operation. // pageNum := 0 // err := client.ListAccountAliasesPages(params, // func(page *ListAccountAliasesOutput, lastPage bool) bool { // pageNum++ // fmt.Println(page) // return pageNum <= 3 // }) // func (c *IAM) ListAccountAliasesPages(input *ListAccountAliasesInput, fn func(*ListAccountAliasesOutput, bool) bool) error { return c.ListAccountAliasesPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn) } // ListAccountAliasesPagesWithContext same as ListAccountAliasesPages except // it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) ListAccountAliasesPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListAccountAliasesInput, fn func(*ListAccountAliasesOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error { p := request.Pagination{ NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) { var inCpy *ListAccountAliasesInput if input != nil { tmp := *input inCpy = &tmp } req, _ := c.ListAccountAliasesRequest(inCpy) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return req, nil }, } cont := true for p.Next() && cont { cont = fn(p.Page().(*ListAccountAliasesOutput), !p.HasNextPage()) } return p.Err() } const opListAttachedGroupPolicies = "ListAttachedGroupPolicies" // ListAttachedGroupPoliciesRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the ListAttachedGroupPolicies operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See ListAttachedGroupPolicies for more information on using the ListAttachedGroupPolicies // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the ListAttachedGroupPoliciesRequest method. // req, resp := client.ListAttachedGroupPoliciesRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/ListAttachedGroupPolicies func (c *IAM) ListAttachedGroupPoliciesRequest(input *ListAttachedGroupPoliciesInput) (req *request.Request, output *ListAttachedGroupPoliciesOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opListAttachedGroupPolicies, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", Paginator: &request.Paginator{ InputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, LimitToken: "MaxItems", TruncationToken: "IsTruncated", }, } if input == nil { input = &ListAttachedGroupPoliciesInput{} } output = &ListAttachedGroupPoliciesOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // ListAttachedGroupPolicies API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Lists all managed policies that are attached to the specified IAM group. // // An IAM group can also have inline policies embedded with it. To list the // inline policies for a group, use the ListGroupPolicies API. For information // about policies, see Managed Policies and Inline Policies (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // You can paginate the results using the MaxItems and Marker parameters. You // can use the PathPrefix parameter to limit the list of policies to only those // matching the specified path prefix. If there are no policies attached to // the specified group (or none that match the specified path prefix), the action // returns an empty list. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation ListAttachedGroupPolicies for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInput" // The request was rejected because an invalid or out-of-range value was supplied // for an input parameter. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/ListAttachedGroupPolicies func (c *IAM) ListAttachedGroupPolicies(input *ListAttachedGroupPoliciesInput) (*ListAttachedGroupPoliciesOutput, error) { req, out := c.ListAttachedGroupPoliciesRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // ListAttachedGroupPoliciesWithContext is the same as ListAttachedGroupPolicies with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See ListAttachedGroupPolicies for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) ListAttachedGroupPoliciesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListAttachedGroupPoliciesInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ListAttachedGroupPoliciesOutput, error) { req, out := c.ListAttachedGroupPoliciesRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } // ListAttachedGroupPoliciesPages iterates over the pages of a ListAttachedGroupPolicies operation, // calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop // iterating, return false from the fn function. // // See ListAttachedGroupPolicies method for more information on how to use this operation. // // Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service. // // // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a ListAttachedGroupPolicies operation. // pageNum := 0 // err := client.ListAttachedGroupPoliciesPages(params, // func(page *ListAttachedGroupPoliciesOutput, lastPage bool) bool { // pageNum++ // fmt.Println(page) // return pageNum <= 3 // }) // func (c *IAM) ListAttachedGroupPoliciesPages(input *ListAttachedGroupPoliciesInput, fn func(*ListAttachedGroupPoliciesOutput, bool) bool) error { return c.ListAttachedGroupPoliciesPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn) } // ListAttachedGroupPoliciesPagesWithContext same as ListAttachedGroupPoliciesPages except // it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) ListAttachedGroupPoliciesPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListAttachedGroupPoliciesInput, fn func(*ListAttachedGroupPoliciesOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error { p := request.Pagination{ NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) { var inCpy *ListAttachedGroupPoliciesInput if input != nil { tmp := *input inCpy = &tmp } req, _ := c.ListAttachedGroupPoliciesRequest(inCpy) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return req, nil }, } cont := true for p.Next() && cont { cont = fn(p.Page().(*ListAttachedGroupPoliciesOutput), !p.HasNextPage()) } return p.Err() } const opListAttachedRolePolicies = "ListAttachedRolePolicies" // ListAttachedRolePoliciesRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the ListAttachedRolePolicies operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See ListAttachedRolePolicies for more information on using the ListAttachedRolePolicies // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the ListAttachedRolePoliciesRequest method. // req, resp := client.ListAttachedRolePoliciesRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/ListAttachedRolePolicies func (c *IAM) ListAttachedRolePoliciesRequest(input *ListAttachedRolePoliciesInput) (req *request.Request, output *ListAttachedRolePoliciesOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opListAttachedRolePolicies, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", Paginator: &request.Paginator{ InputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, LimitToken: "MaxItems", TruncationToken: "IsTruncated", }, } if input == nil { input = &ListAttachedRolePoliciesInput{} } output = &ListAttachedRolePoliciesOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // ListAttachedRolePolicies API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Lists all managed policies that are attached to the specified IAM role. // // An IAM role can also have inline policies embedded with it. To list the inline // policies for a role, use the ListRolePolicies API. For information about // policies, see Managed Policies and Inline Policies (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // You can paginate the results using the MaxItems and Marker parameters. You // can use the PathPrefix parameter to limit the list of policies to only those // matching the specified path prefix. If there are no policies attached to // the specified role (or none that match the specified path prefix), the action // returns an empty list. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation ListAttachedRolePolicies for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInput" // The request was rejected because an invalid or out-of-range value was supplied // for an input parameter. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/ListAttachedRolePolicies func (c *IAM) ListAttachedRolePolicies(input *ListAttachedRolePoliciesInput) (*ListAttachedRolePoliciesOutput, error) { req, out := c.ListAttachedRolePoliciesRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // ListAttachedRolePoliciesWithContext is the same as ListAttachedRolePolicies with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See ListAttachedRolePolicies for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) ListAttachedRolePoliciesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListAttachedRolePoliciesInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ListAttachedRolePoliciesOutput, error) { req, out := c.ListAttachedRolePoliciesRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } // ListAttachedRolePoliciesPages iterates over the pages of a ListAttachedRolePolicies operation, // calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop // iterating, return false from the fn function. // // See ListAttachedRolePolicies method for more information on how to use this operation. // // Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service. // // // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a ListAttachedRolePolicies operation. // pageNum := 0 // err := client.ListAttachedRolePoliciesPages(params, // func(page *ListAttachedRolePoliciesOutput, lastPage bool) bool { // pageNum++ // fmt.Println(page) // return pageNum <= 3 // }) // func (c *IAM) ListAttachedRolePoliciesPages(input *ListAttachedRolePoliciesInput, fn func(*ListAttachedRolePoliciesOutput, bool) bool) error { return c.ListAttachedRolePoliciesPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn) } // ListAttachedRolePoliciesPagesWithContext same as ListAttachedRolePoliciesPages except // it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) ListAttachedRolePoliciesPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListAttachedRolePoliciesInput, fn func(*ListAttachedRolePoliciesOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error { p := request.Pagination{ NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) { var inCpy *ListAttachedRolePoliciesInput if input != nil { tmp := *input inCpy = &tmp } req, _ := c.ListAttachedRolePoliciesRequest(inCpy) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return req, nil }, } cont := true for p.Next() && cont { cont = fn(p.Page().(*ListAttachedRolePoliciesOutput), !p.HasNextPage()) } return p.Err() } const opListAttachedUserPolicies = "ListAttachedUserPolicies" // ListAttachedUserPoliciesRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the ListAttachedUserPolicies operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See ListAttachedUserPolicies for more information on using the ListAttachedUserPolicies // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the ListAttachedUserPoliciesRequest method. // req, resp := client.ListAttachedUserPoliciesRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/ListAttachedUserPolicies func (c *IAM) ListAttachedUserPoliciesRequest(input *ListAttachedUserPoliciesInput) (req *request.Request, output *ListAttachedUserPoliciesOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opListAttachedUserPolicies, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", Paginator: &request.Paginator{ InputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, LimitToken: "MaxItems", TruncationToken: "IsTruncated", }, } if input == nil { input = &ListAttachedUserPoliciesInput{} } output = &ListAttachedUserPoliciesOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // ListAttachedUserPolicies API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Lists all managed policies that are attached to the specified IAM user. // // An IAM user can also have inline policies embedded with it. To list the inline // policies for a user, use the ListUserPolicies API. For information about // policies, see Managed Policies and Inline Policies (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // You can paginate the results using the MaxItems and Marker parameters. You // can use the PathPrefix parameter to limit the list of policies to only those // matching the specified path prefix. If there are no policies attached to // the specified group (or none that match the specified path prefix), the action // returns an empty list. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation ListAttachedUserPolicies for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInput" // The request was rejected because an invalid or out-of-range value was supplied // for an input parameter. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/ListAttachedUserPolicies func (c *IAM) ListAttachedUserPolicies(input *ListAttachedUserPoliciesInput) (*ListAttachedUserPoliciesOutput, error) { req, out := c.ListAttachedUserPoliciesRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // ListAttachedUserPoliciesWithContext is the same as ListAttachedUserPolicies with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See ListAttachedUserPolicies for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) ListAttachedUserPoliciesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListAttachedUserPoliciesInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ListAttachedUserPoliciesOutput, error) { req, out := c.ListAttachedUserPoliciesRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } // ListAttachedUserPoliciesPages iterates over the pages of a ListAttachedUserPolicies operation, // calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop // iterating, return false from the fn function. // // See ListAttachedUserPolicies method for more information on how to use this operation. // // Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service. // // // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a ListAttachedUserPolicies operation. // pageNum := 0 // err := client.ListAttachedUserPoliciesPages(params, // func(page *ListAttachedUserPoliciesOutput, lastPage bool) bool { // pageNum++ // fmt.Println(page) // return pageNum <= 3 // }) // func (c *IAM) ListAttachedUserPoliciesPages(input *ListAttachedUserPoliciesInput, fn func(*ListAttachedUserPoliciesOutput, bool) bool) error { return c.ListAttachedUserPoliciesPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn) } // ListAttachedUserPoliciesPagesWithContext same as ListAttachedUserPoliciesPages except // it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) ListAttachedUserPoliciesPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListAttachedUserPoliciesInput, fn func(*ListAttachedUserPoliciesOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error { p := request.Pagination{ NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) { var inCpy *ListAttachedUserPoliciesInput if input != nil { tmp := *input inCpy = &tmp } req, _ := c.ListAttachedUserPoliciesRequest(inCpy) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return req, nil }, } cont := true for p.Next() && cont { cont = fn(p.Page().(*ListAttachedUserPoliciesOutput), !p.HasNextPage()) } return p.Err() } const opListEntitiesForPolicy = "ListEntitiesForPolicy" // ListEntitiesForPolicyRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the ListEntitiesForPolicy operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See ListEntitiesForPolicy for more information on using the ListEntitiesForPolicy // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the ListEntitiesForPolicyRequest method. // req, resp := client.ListEntitiesForPolicyRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/ListEntitiesForPolicy func (c *IAM) ListEntitiesForPolicyRequest(input *ListEntitiesForPolicyInput) (req *request.Request, output *ListEntitiesForPolicyOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opListEntitiesForPolicy, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", Paginator: &request.Paginator{ InputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, LimitToken: "MaxItems", TruncationToken: "IsTruncated", }, } if input == nil { input = &ListEntitiesForPolicyInput{} } output = &ListEntitiesForPolicyOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // ListEntitiesForPolicy API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Lists all IAM users, groups, and roles that the specified managed policy // is attached to. // // You can use the optional EntityFilter parameter to limit the results to a // particular type of entity (users, groups, or roles). For example, to list // only the roles that are attached to the specified policy, set EntityFilter // to Role. // // You can paginate the results using the MaxItems and Marker parameters. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation ListEntitiesForPolicy for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInput" // The request was rejected because an invalid or out-of-range value was supplied // for an input parameter. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/ListEntitiesForPolicy func (c *IAM) ListEntitiesForPolicy(input *ListEntitiesForPolicyInput) (*ListEntitiesForPolicyOutput, error) { req, out := c.ListEntitiesForPolicyRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // ListEntitiesForPolicyWithContext is the same as ListEntitiesForPolicy with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See ListEntitiesForPolicy for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) ListEntitiesForPolicyWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListEntitiesForPolicyInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ListEntitiesForPolicyOutput, error) { req, out := c.ListEntitiesForPolicyRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } // ListEntitiesForPolicyPages iterates over the pages of a ListEntitiesForPolicy operation, // calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop // iterating, return false from the fn function. // // See ListEntitiesForPolicy method for more information on how to use this operation. // // Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service. // // // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a ListEntitiesForPolicy operation. // pageNum := 0 // err := client.ListEntitiesForPolicyPages(params, // func(page *ListEntitiesForPolicyOutput, lastPage bool) bool { // pageNum++ // fmt.Println(page) // return pageNum <= 3 // }) // func (c *IAM) ListEntitiesForPolicyPages(input *ListEntitiesForPolicyInput, fn func(*ListEntitiesForPolicyOutput, bool) bool) error { return c.ListEntitiesForPolicyPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn) } // ListEntitiesForPolicyPagesWithContext same as ListEntitiesForPolicyPages except // it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) ListEntitiesForPolicyPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListEntitiesForPolicyInput, fn func(*ListEntitiesForPolicyOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error { p := request.Pagination{ NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) { var inCpy *ListEntitiesForPolicyInput if input != nil { tmp := *input inCpy = &tmp } req, _ := c.ListEntitiesForPolicyRequest(inCpy) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return req, nil }, } cont := true for p.Next() && cont { cont = fn(p.Page().(*ListEntitiesForPolicyOutput), !p.HasNextPage()) } return p.Err() } const opListGroupPolicies = "ListGroupPolicies" // ListGroupPoliciesRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the ListGroupPolicies operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See ListGroupPolicies for more information on using the ListGroupPolicies // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the ListGroupPoliciesRequest method. // req, resp := client.ListGroupPoliciesRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/ListGroupPolicies func (c *IAM) ListGroupPoliciesRequest(input *ListGroupPoliciesInput) (req *request.Request, output *ListGroupPoliciesOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opListGroupPolicies, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", Paginator: &request.Paginator{ InputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, LimitToken: "MaxItems", TruncationToken: "IsTruncated", }, } if input == nil { input = &ListGroupPoliciesInput{} } output = &ListGroupPoliciesOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // ListGroupPolicies API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Lists the names of the inline policies that are embedded in the specified // IAM group. // // An IAM group can also have managed policies attached to it. To list the managed // policies that are attached to a group, use ListAttachedGroupPolicies. For // more information about policies, see Managed Policies and Inline Policies // (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // You can paginate the results using the MaxItems and Marker parameters. If // there are no inline policies embedded with the specified group, the action // returns an empty list. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation ListGroupPolicies for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/ListGroupPolicies func (c *IAM) ListGroupPolicies(input *ListGroupPoliciesInput) (*ListGroupPoliciesOutput, error) { req, out := c.ListGroupPoliciesRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // ListGroupPoliciesWithContext is the same as ListGroupPolicies with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See ListGroupPolicies for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) ListGroupPoliciesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListGroupPoliciesInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ListGroupPoliciesOutput, error) { req, out := c.ListGroupPoliciesRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } // ListGroupPoliciesPages iterates over the pages of a ListGroupPolicies operation, // calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop // iterating, return false from the fn function. // // See ListGroupPolicies method for more information on how to use this operation. // // Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service. // // // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a ListGroupPolicies operation. // pageNum := 0 // err := client.ListGroupPoliciesPages(params, // func(page *ListGroupPoliciesOutput, lastPage bool) bool { // pageNum++ // fmt.Println(page) // return pageNum <= 3 // }) // func (c *IAM) ListGroupPoliciesPages(input *ListGroupPoliciesInput, fn func(*ListGroupPoliciesOutput, bool) bool) error { return c.ListGroupPoliciesPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn) } // ListGroupPoliciesPagesWithContext same as ListGroupPoliciesPages except // it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) ListGroupPoliciesPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListGroupPoliciesInput, fn func(*ListGroupPoliciesOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error { p := request.Pagination{ NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) { var inCpy *ListGroupPoliciesInput if input != nil { tmp := *input inCpy = &tmp } req, _ := c.ListGroupPoliciesRequest(inCpy) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return req, nil }, } cont := true for p.Next() && cont { cont = fn(p.Page().(*ListGroupPoliciesOutput), !p.HasNextPage()) } return p.Err() } const opListGroups = "ListGroups" // ListGroupsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the ListGroups operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See ListGroups for more information on using the ListGroups // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the ListGroupsRequest method. // req, resp := client.ListGroupsRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/ListGroups func (c *IAM) ListGroupsRequest(input *ListGroupsInput) (req *request.Request, output *ListGroupsOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opListGroups, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", Paginator: &request.Paginator{ InputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, LimitToken: "MaxItems", TruncationToken: "IsTruncated", }, } if input == nil { input = &ListGroupsInput{} } output = &ListGroupsOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // ListGroups API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Lists the IAM groups that have the specified path prefix. // // You can paginate the results using the MaxItems and Marker parameters. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation ListGroups for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/ListGroups func (c *IAM) ListGroups(input *ListGroupsInput) (*ListGroupsOutput, error) { req, out := c.ListGroupsRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // ListGroupsWithContext is the same as ListGroups with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See ListGroups for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) ListGroupsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListGroupsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ListGroupsOutput, error) { req, out := c.ListGroupsRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } // ListGroupsPages iterates over the pages of a ListGroups operation, // calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop // iterating, return false from the fn function. // // See ListGroups method for more information on how to use this operation. // // Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service. // // // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a ListGroups operation. // pageNum := 0 // err := client.ListGroupsPages(params, // func(page *ListGroupsOutput, lastPage bool) bool { // pageNum++ // fmt.Println(page) // return pageNum <= 3 // }) // func (c *IAM) ListGroupsPages(input *ListGroupsInput, fn func(*ListGroupsOutput, bool) bool) error { return c.ListGroupsPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn) } // ListGroupsPagesWithContext same as ListGroupsPages except // it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) ListGroupsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListGroupsInput, fn func(*ListGroupsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error { p := request.Pagination{ NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) { var inCpy *ListGroupsInput if input != nil { tmp := *input inCpy = &tmp } req, _ := c.ListGroupsRequest(inCpy) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return req, nil }, } cont := true for p.Next() && cont { cont = fn(p.Page().(*ListGroupsOutput), !p.HasNextPage()) } return p.Err() } const opListGroupsForUser = "ListGroupsForUser" // ListGroupsForUserRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the ListGroupsForUser operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See ListGroupsForUser for more information on using the ListGroupsForUser // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the ListGroupsForUserRequest method. // req, resp := client.ListGroupsForUserRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/ListGroupsForUser func (c *IAM) ListGroupsForUserRequest(input *ListGroupsForUserInput) (req *request.Request, output *ListGroupsForUserOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opListGroupsForUser, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", Paginator: &request.Paginator{ InputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, LimitToken: "MaxItems", TruncationToken: "IsTruncated", }, } if input == nil { input = &ListGroupsForUserInput{} } output = &ListGroupsForUserOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // ListGroupsForUser API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Lists the IAM groups that the specified IAM user belongs to. // // You can paginate the results using the MaxItems and Marker parameters. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation ListGroupsForUser for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/ListGroupsForUser func (c *IAM) ListGroupsForUser(input *ListGroupsForUserInput) (*ListGroupsForUserOutput, error) { req, out := c.ListGroupsForUserRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // ListGroupsForUserWithContext is the same as ListGroupsForUser with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See ListGroupsForUser for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) ListGroupsForUserWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListGroupsForUserInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ListGroupsForUserOutput, error) { req, out := c.ListGroupsForUserRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } // ListGroupsForUserPages iterates over the pages of a ListGroupsForUser operation, // calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop // iterating, return false from the fn function. // // See ListGroupsForUser method for more information on how to use this operation. // // Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service. // // // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a ListGroupsForUser operation. // pageNum := 0 // err := client.ListGroupsForUserPages(params, // func(page *ListGroupsForUserOutput, lastPage bool) bool { // pageNum++ // fmt.Println(page) // return pageNum <= 3 // }) // func (c *IAM) ListGroupsForUserPages(input *ListGroupsForUserInput, fn func(*ListGroupsForUserOutput, bool) bool) error { return c.ListGroupsForUserPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn) } // ListGroupsForUserPagesWithContext same as ListGroupsForUserPages except // it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) ListGroupsForUserPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListGroupsForUserInput, fn func(*ListGroupsForUserOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error { p := request.Pagination{ NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) { var inCpy *ListGroupsForUserInput if input != nil { tmp := *input inCpy = &tmp } req, _ := c.ListGroupsForUserRequest(inCpy) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return req, nil }, } cont := true for p.Next() && cont { cont = fn(p.Page().(*ListGroupsForUserOutput), !p.HasNextPage()) } return p.Err() } const opListInstanceProfiles = "ListInstanceProfiles" // ListInstanceProfilesRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the ListInstanceProfiles operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See ListInstanceProfiles for more information on using the ListInstanceProfiles // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the ListInstanceProfilesRequest method. // req, resp := client.ListInstanceProfilesRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/ListInstanceProfiles func (c *IAM) ListInstanceProfilesRequest(input *ListInstanceProfilesInput) (req *request.Request, output *ListInstanceProfilesOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opListInstanceProfiles, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", Paginator: &request.Paginator{ InputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, LimitToken: "MaxItems", TruncationToken: "IsTruncated", }, } if input == nil { input = &ListInstanceProfilesInput{} } output = &ListInstanceProfilesOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // ListInstanceProfiles API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Lists the instance profiles that have the specified path prefix. If there // are none, the action returns an empty list. For more information about instance // profiles, go to About Instance Profiles (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/AboutInstanceProfiles.html). // // You can paginate the results using the MaxItems and Marker parameters. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation ListInstanceProfiles for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/ListInstanceProfiles func (c *IAM) ListInstanceProfiles(input *ListInstanceProfilesInput) (*ListInstanceProfilesOutput, error) { req, out := c.ListInstanceProfilesRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // ListInstanceProfilesWithContext is the same as ListInstanceProfiles with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See ListInstanceProfiles for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) ListInstanceProfilesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListInstanceProfilesInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ListInstanceProfilesOutput, error) { req, out := c.ListInstanceProfilesRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } // ListInstanceProfilesPages iterates over the pages of a ListInstanceProfiles operation, // calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop // iterating, return false from the fn function. // // See ListInstanceProfiles method for more information on how to use this operation. // // Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service. // // // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a ListInstanceProfiles operation. // pageNum := 0 // err := client.ListInstanceProfilesPages(params, // func(page *ListInstanceProfilesOutput, lastPage bool) bool { // pageNum++ // fmt.Println(page) // return pageNum <= 3 // }) // func (c *IAM) ListInstanceProfilesPages(input *ListInstanceProfilesInput, fn func(*ListInstanceProfilesOutput, bool) bool) error { return c.ListInstanceProfilesPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn) } // ListInstanceProfilesPagesWithContext same as ListInstanceProfilesPages except // it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) ListInstanceProfilesPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListInstanceProfilesInput, fn func(*ListInstanceProfilesOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error { p := request.Pagination{ NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) { var inCpy *ListInstanceProfilesInput if input != nil { tmp := *input inCpy = &tmp } req, _ := c.ListInstanceProfilesRequest(inCpy) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return req, nil }, } cont := true for p.Next() && cont { cont = fn(p.Page().(*ListInstanceProfilesOutput), !p.HasNextPage()) } return p.Err() } const opListInstanceProfilesForRole = "ListInstanceProfilesForRole" // ListInstanceProfilesForRoleRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the ListInstanceProfilesForRole operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See ListInstanceProfilesForRole for more information on using the ListInstanceProfilesForRole // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the ListInstanceProfilesForRoleRequest method. // req, resp := client.ListInstanceProfilesForRoleRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/ListInstanceProfilesForRole func (c *IAM) ListInstanceProfilesForRoleRequest(input *ListInstanceProfilesForRoleInput) (req *request.Request, output *ListInstanceProfilesForRoleOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opListInstanceProfilesForRole, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", Paginator: &request.Paginator{ InputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, LimitToken: "MaxItems", TruncationToken: "IsTruncated", }, } if input == nil { input = &ListInstanceProfilesForRoleInput{} } output = &ListInstanceProfilesForRoleOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // ListInstanceProfilesForRole API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Lists the instance profiles that have the specified associated IAM role. // If there are none, the action returns an empty list. For more information // about instance profiles, go to About Instance Profiles (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/AboutInstanceProfiles.html). // // You can paginate the results using the MaxItems and Marker parameters. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation ListInstanceProfilesForRole for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/ListInstanceProfilesForRole func (c *IAM) ListInstanceProfilesForRole(input *ListInstanceProfilesForRoleInput) (*ListInstanceProfilesForRoleOutput, error) { req, out := c.ListInstanceProfilesForRoleRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // ListInstanceProfilesForRoleWithContext is the same as ListInstanceProfilesForRole with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See ListInstanceProfilesForRole for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) ListInstanceProfilesForRoleWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListInstanceProfilesForRoleInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ListInstanceProfilesForRoleOutput, error) { req, out := c.ListInstanceProfilesForRoleRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } // ListInstanceProfilesForRolePages iterates over the pages of a ListInstanceProfilesForRole operation, // calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop // iterating, return false from the fn function. // // See ListInstanceProfilesForRole method for more information on how to use this operation. // // Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service. // // // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a ListInstanceProfilesForRole operation. // pageNum := 0 // err := client.ListInstanceProfilesForRolePages(params, // func(page *ListInstanceProfilesForRoleOutput, lastPage bool) bool { // pageNum++ // fmt.Println(page) // return pageNum <= 3 // }) // func (c *IAM) ListInstanceProfilesForRolePages(input *ListInstanceProfilesForRoleInput, fn func(*ListInstanceProfilesForRoleOutput, bool) bool) error { return c.ListInstanceProfilesForRolePagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn) } // ListInstanceProfilesForRolePagesWithContext same as ListInstanceProfilesForRolePages except // it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) ListInstanceProfilesForRolePagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListInstanceProfilesForRoleInput, fn func(*ListInstanceProfilesForRoleOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error { p := request.Pagination{ NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) { var inCpy *ListInstanceProfilesForRoleInput if input != nil { tmp := *input inCpy = &tmp } req, _ := c.ListInstanceProfilesForRoleRequest(inCpy) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return req, nil }, } cont := true for p.Next() && cont { cont = fn(p.Page().(*ListInstanceProfilesForRoleOutput), !p.HasNextPage()) } return p.Err() } const opListMFADevices = "ListMFADevices" // ListMFADevicesRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the ListMFADevices operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See ListMFADevices for more information on using the ListMFADevices // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the ListMFADevicesRequest method. // req, resp := client.ListMFADevicesRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/ListMFADevices func (c *IAM) ListMFADevicesRequest(input *ListMFADevicesInput) (req *request.Request, output *ListMFADevicesOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opListMFADevices, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", Paginator: &request.Paginator{ InputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, LimitToken: "MaxItems", TruncationToken: "IsTruncated", }, } if input == nil { input = &ListMFADevicesInput{} } output = &ListMFADevicesOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // ListMFADevices API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Lists the MFA devices for an IAM user. If the request includes a IAM user // name, then this action lists all the MFA devices associated with the specified // user. If you do not specify a user name, IAM determines the user name implicitly // based on the AWS access key ID signing the request for this API. // // You can paginate the results using the MaxItems and Marker parameters. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation ListMFADevices for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/ListMFADevices func (c *IAM) ListMFADevices(input *ListMFADevicesInput) (*ListMFADevicesOutput, error) { req, out := c.ListMFADevicesRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // ListMFADevicesWithContext is the same as ListMFADevices with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See ListMFADevices for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) ListMFADevicesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListMFADevicesInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ListMFADevicesOutput, error) { req, out := c.ListMFADevicesRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } // ListMFADevicesPages iterates over the pages of a ListMFADevices operation, // calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop // iterating, return false from the fn function. // // See ListMFADevices method for more information on how to use this operation. // // Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service. // // // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a ListMFADevices operation. // pageNum := 0 // err := client.ListMFADevicesPages(params, // func(page *ListMFADevicesOutput, lastPage bool) bool { // pageNum++ // fmt.Println(page) // return pageNum <= 3 // }) // func (c *IAM) ListMFADevicesPages(input *ListMFADevicesInput, fn func(*ListMFADevicesOutput, bool) bool) error { return c.ListMFADevicesPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn) } // ListMFADevicesPagesWithContext same as ListMFADevicesPages except // it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) ListMFADevicesPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListMFADevicesInput, fn func(*ListMFADevicesOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error { p := request.Pagination{ NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) { var inCpy *ListMFADevicesInput if input != nil { tmp := *input inCpy = &tmp } req, _ := c.ListMFADevicesRequest(inCpy) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return req, nil }, } cont := true for p.Next() && cont { cont = fn(p.Page().(*ListMFADevicesOutput), !p.HasNextPage()) } return p.Err() } const opListOpenIDConnectProviders = "ListOpenIDConnectProviders" // ListOpenIDConnectProvidersRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the ListOpenIDConnectProviders operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See ListOpenIDConnectProviders for more information on using the ListOpenIDConnectProviders // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the ListOpenIDConnectProvidersRequest method. // req, resp := client.ListOpenIDConnectProvidersRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/ListOpenIDConnectProviders func (c *IAM) ListOpenIDConnectProvidersRequest(input *ListOpenIDConnectProvidersInput) (req *request.Request, output *ListOpenIDConnectProvidersOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opListOpenIDConnectProviders, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &ListOpenIDConnectProvidersInput{} } output = &ListOpenIDConnectProvidersOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // ListOpenIDConnectProviders API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Lists information about the IAM OpenID Connect (OIDC) provider resource objects // defined in the AWS account. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation ListOpenIDConnectProviders for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/ListOpenIDConnectProviders func (c *IAM) ListOpenIDConnectProviders(input *ListOpenIDConnectProvidersInput) (*ListOpenIDConnectProvidersOutput, error) { req, out := c.ListOpenIDConnectProvidersRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // ListOpenIDConnectProvidersWithContext is the same as ListOpenIDConnectProviders with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See ListOpenIDConnectProviders for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) ListOpenIDConnectProvidersWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListOpenIDConnectProvidersInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ListOpenIDConnectProvidersOutput, error) { req, out := c.ListOpenIDConnectProvidersRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opListPolicies = "ListPolicies" // ListPoliciesRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the ListPolicies operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See ListPolicies for more information on using the ListPolicies // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the ListPoliciesRequest method. // req, resp := client.ListPoliciesRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/ListPolicies func (c *IAM) ListPoliciesRequest(input *ListPoliciesInput) (req *request.Request, output *ListPoliciesOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opListPolicies, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", Paginator: &request.Paginator{ InputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, LimitToken: "MaxItems", TruncationToken: "IsTruncated", }, } if input == nil { input = &ListPoliciesInput{} } output = &ListPoliciesOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // ListPolicies API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Lists all the managed policies that are available in your AWS account, including // your own customer-defined managed policies and all AWS managed policies. // // You can filter the list of policies that is returned using the optional OnlyAttached, // Scope, and PathPrefix parameters. For example, to list only the customer // managed policies in your AWS account, set Scope to Local. To list only AWS // managed policies, set Scope to AWS. // // You can paginate the results using the MaxItems and Marker parameters. // // For more information about managed policies, see Managed Policies and Inline // Policies (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation ListPolicies for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/ListPolicies func (c *IAM) ListPolicies(input *ListPoliciesInput) (*ListPoliciesOutput, error) { req, out := c.ListPoliciesRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // ListPoliciesWithContext is the same as ListPolicies with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See ListPolicies for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) ListPoliciesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListPoliciesInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ListPoliciesOutput, error) { req, out := c.ListPoliciesRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } // ListPoliciesPages iterates over the pages of a ListPolicies operation, // calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop // iterating, return false from the fn function. // // See ListPolicies method for more information on how to use this operation. // // Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service. // // // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a ListPolicies operation. // pageNum := 0 // err := client.ListPoliciesPages(params, // func(page *ListPoliciesOutput, lastPage bool) bool { // pageNum++ // fmt.Println(page) // return pageNum <= 3 // }) // func (c *IAM) ListPoliciesPages(input *ListPoliciesInput, fn func(*ListPoliciesOutput, bool) bool) error { return c.ListPoliciesPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn) } // ListPoliciesPagesWithContext same as ListPoliciesPages except // it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) ListPoliciesPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListPoliciesInput, fn func(*ListPoliciesOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error { p := request.Pagination{ NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) { var inCpy *ListPoliciesInput if input != nil { tmp := *input inCpy = &tmp } req, _ := c.ListPoliciesRequest(inCpy) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return req, nil }, } cont := true for p.Next() && cont { cont = fn(p.Page().(*ListPoliciesOutput), !p.HasNextPage()) } return p.Err() } const opListPolicyVersions = "ListPolicyVersions" // ListPolicyVersionsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the ListPolicyVersions operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See ListPolicyVersions for more information on using the ListPolicyVersions // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the ListPolicyVersionsRequest method. // req, resp := client.ListPolicyVersionsRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/ListPolicyVersions func (c *IAM) ListPolicyVersionsRequest(input *ListPolicyVersionsInput) (req *request.Request, output *ListPolicyVersionsOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opListPolicyVersions, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", Paginator: &request.Paginator{ InputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, LimitToken: "MaxItems", TruncationToken: "IsTruncated", }, } if input == nil { input = &ListPolicyVersionsInput{} } output = &ListPolicyVersionsOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // ListPolicyVersions API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Lists information about the versions of the specified managed policy, including // the version that is currently set as the policy's default version. // // For more information about managed policies, see Managed Policies and Inline // Policies (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation ListPolicyVersions for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInput" // The request was rejected because an invalid or out-of-range value was supplied // for an input parameter. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/ListPolicyVersions func (c *IAM) ListPolicyVersions(input *ListPolicyVersionsInput) (*ListPolicyVersionsOutput, error) { req, out := c.ListPolicyVersionsRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // ListPolicyVersionsWithContext is the same as ListPolicyVersions with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See ListPolicyVersions for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) ListPolicyVersionsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListPolicyVersionsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ListPolicyVersionsOutput, error) { req, out := c.ListPolicyVersionsRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } // ListPolicyVersionsPages iterates over the pages of a ListPolicyVersions operation, // calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop // iterating, return false from the fn function. // // See ListPolicyVersions method for more information on how to use this operation. // // Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service. // // // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a ListPolicyVersions operation. // pageNum := 0 // err := client.ListPolicyVersionsPages(params, // func(page *ListPolicyVersionsOutput, lastPage bool) bool { // pageNum++ // fmt.Println(page) // return pageNum <= 3 // }) // func (c *IAM) ListPolicyVersionsPages(input *ListPolicyVersionsInput, fn func(*ListPolicyVersionsOutput, bool) bool) error { return c.ListPolicyVersionsPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn) } // ListPolicyVersionsPagesWithContext same as ListPolicyVersionsPages except // it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) ListPolicyVersionsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListPolicyVersionsInput, fn func(*ListPolicyVersionsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error { p := request.Pagination{ NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) { var inCpy *ListPolicyVersionsInput if input != nil { tmp := *input inCpy = &tmp } req, _ := c.ListPolicyVersionsRequest(inCpy) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return req, nil }, } cont := true for p.Next() && cont { cont = fn(p.Page().(*ListPolicyVersionsOutput), !p.HasNextPage()) } return p.Err() } const opListRolePolicies = "ListRolePolicies" // ListRolePoliciesRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the ListRolePolicies operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See ListRolePolicies for more information on using the ListRolePolicies // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the ListRolePoliciesRequest method. // req, resp := client.ListRolePoliciesRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/ListRolePolicies func (c *IAM) ListRolePoliciesRequest(input *ListRolePoliciesInput) (req *request.Request, output *ListRolePoliciesOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opListRolePolicies, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", Paginator: &request.Paginator{ InputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, LimitToken: "MaxItems", TruncationToken: "IsTruncated", }, } if input == nil { input = &ListRolePoliciesInput{} } output = &ListRolePoliciesOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // ListRolePolicies API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Lists the names of the inline policies that are embedded in the specified // IAM role. // // An IAM role can also have managed policies attached to it. To list the managed // policies that are attached to a role, use ListAttachedRolePolicies. For more // information about policies, see Managed Policies and Inline Policies (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // You can paginate the results using the MaxItems and Marker parameters. If // there are no inline policies embedded with the specified role, the action // returns an empty list. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation ListRolePolicies for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/ListRolePolicies func (c *IAM) ListRolePolicies(input *ListRolePoliciesInput) (*ListRolePoliciesOutput, error) { req, out := c.ListRolePoliciesRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // ListRolePoliciesWithContext is the same as ListRolePolicies with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See ListRolePolicies for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) ListRolePoliciesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListRolePoliciesInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ListRolePoliciesOutput, error) { req, out := c.ListRolePoliciesRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } // ListRolePoliciesPages iterates over the pages of a ListRolePolicies operation, // calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop // iterating, return false from the fn function. // // See ListRolePolicies method for more information on how to use this operation. // // Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service. // // // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a ListRolePolicies operation. // pageNum := 0 // err := client.ListRolePoliciesPages(params, // func(page *ListRolePoliciesOutput, lastPage bool) bool { // pageNum++ // fmt.Println(page) // return pageNum <= 3 // }) // func (c *IAM) ListRolePoliciesPages(input *ListRolePoliciesInput, fn func(*ListRolePoliciesOutput, bool) bool) error { return c.ListRolePoliciesPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn) } // ListRolePoliciesPagesWithContext same as ListRolePoliciesPages except // it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) ListRolePoliciesPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListRolePoliciesInput, fn func(*ListRolePoliciesOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error { p := request.Pagination{ NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) { var inCpy *ListRolePoliciesInput if input != nil { tmp := *input inCpy = &tmp } req, _ := c.ListRolePoliciesRequest(inCpy) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return req, nil }, } cont := true for p.Next() && cont { cont = fn(p.Page().(*ListRolePoliciesOutput), !p.HasNextPage()) } return p.Err() } const opListRoles = "ListRoles" // ListRolesRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the ListRoles operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See ListRoles for more information on using the ListRoles // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the ListRolesRequest method. // req, resp := client.ListRolesRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/ListRoles func (c *IAM) ListRolesRequest(input *ListRolesInput) (req *request.Request, output *ListRolesOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opListRoles, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", Paginator: &request.Paginator{ InputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, LimitToken: "MaxItems", TruncationToken: "IsTruncated", }, } if input == nil { input = &ListRolesInput{} } output = &ListRolesOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // ListRoles API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Lists the IAM roles that have the specified path prefix. If there are none, // the action returns an empty list. For more information about roles, go to // Working with Roles (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/WorkingWithRoles.html). // // You can paginate the results using the MaxItems and Marker parameters. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation ListRoles for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/ListRoles func (c *IAM) ListRoles(input *ListRolesInput) (*ListRolesOutput, error) { req, out := c.ListRolesRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // ListRolesWithContext is the same as ListRoles with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See ListRoles for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) ListRolesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListRolesInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ListRolesOutput, error) { req, out := c.ListRolesRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } // ListRolesPages iterates over the pages of a ListRoles operation, // calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop // iterating, return false from the fn function. // // See ListRoles method for more information on how to use this operation. // // Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service. // // // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a ListRoles operation. // pageNum := 0 // err := client.ListRolesPages(params, // func(page *ListRolesOutput, lastPage bool) bool { // pageNum++ // fmt.Println(page) // return pageNum <= 3 // }) // func (c *IAM) ListRolesPages(input *ListRolesInput, fn func(*ListRolesOutput, bool) bool) error { return c.ListRolesPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn) } // ListRolesPagesWithContext same as ListRolesPages except // it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) ListRolesPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListRolesInput, fn func(*ListRolesOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error { p := request.Pagination{ NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) { var inCpy *ListRolesInput if input != nil { tmp := *input inCpy = &tmp } req, _ := c.ListRolesRequest(inCpy) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return req, nil }, } cont := true for p.Next() && cont { cont = fn(p.Page().(*ListRolesOutput), !p.HasNextPage()) } return p.Err() } const opListSAMLProviders = "ListSAMLProviders" // ListSAMLProvidersRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the ListSAMLProviders operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See ListSAMLProviders for more information on using the ListSAMLProviders // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the ListSAMLProvidersRequest method. // req, resp := client.ListSAMLProvidersRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/ListSAMLProviders func (c *IAM) ListSAMLProvidersRequest(input *ListSAMLProvidersInput) (req *request.Request, output *ListSAMLProvidersOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opListSAMLProviders, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &ListSAMLProvidersInput{} } output = &ListSAMLProvidersOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // ListSAMLProviders API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Lists the SAML provider resource objects defined in IAM in the account. // // This operation requires Signature Version 4 (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/signature-version-4.html). // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation ListSAMLProviders for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/ListSAMLProviders func (c *IAM) ListSAMLProviders(input *ListSAMLProvidersInput) (*ListSAMLProvidersOutput, error) { req, out := c.ListSAMLProvidersRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // ListSAMLProvidersWithContext is the same as ListSAMLProviders with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See ListSAMLProviders for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) ListSAMLProvidersWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListSAMLProvidersInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ListSAMLProvidersOutput, error) { req, out := c.ListSAMLProvidersRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opListSSHPublicKeys = "ListSSHPublicKeys" // ListSSHPublicKeysRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the ListSSHPublicKeys operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See ListSSHPublicKeys for more information on using the ListSSHPublicKeys // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the ListSSHPublicKeysRequest method. // req, resp := client.ListSSHPublicKeysRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/ListSSHPublicKeys func (c *IAM) ListSSHPublicKeysRequest(input *ListSSHPublicKeysInput) (req *request.Request, output *ListSSHPublicKeysOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opListSSHPublicKeys, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", Paginator: &request.Paginator{ InputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, LimitToken: "MaxItems", TruncationToken: "IsTruncated", }, } if input == nil { input = &ListSSHPublicKeysInput{} } output = &ListSSHPublicKeysOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // ListSSHPublicKeys API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Returns information about the SSH public keys associated with the specified // IAM user. If there are none, the action returns an empty list. // // The SSH public keys returned by this action are used only for authenticating // the IAM user to an AWS CodeCommit repository. For more information about // using SSH keys to authenticate to an AWS CodeCommit repository, see Set up // AWS CodeCommit for SSH Connections (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/codecommit/latest/userguide/setting-up-credentials-ssh.html) // in the AWS CodeCommit User Guide. // // Although each user is limited to a small number of keys, you can still paginate // the results using the MaxItems and Marker parameters. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation ListSSHPublicKeys for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/ListSSHPublicKeys func (c *IAM) ListSSHPublicKeys(input *ListSSHPublicKeysInput) (*ListSSHPublicKeysOutput, error) { req, out := c.ListSSHPublicKeysRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // ListSSHPublicKeysWithContext is the same as ListSSHPublicKeys with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See ListSSHPublicKeys for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) ListSSHPublicKeysWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListSSHPublicKeysInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ListSSHPublicKeysOutput, error) { req, out := c.ListSSHPublicKeysRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } // ListSSHPublicKeysPages iterates over the pages of a ListSSHPublicKeys operation, // calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop // iterating, return false from the fn function. // // See ListSSHPublicKeys method for more information on how to use this operation. // // Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service. // // // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a ListSSHPublicKeys operation. // pageNum := 0 // err := client.ListSSHPublicKeysPages(params, // func(page *ListSSHPublicKeysOutput, lastPage bool) bool { // pageNum++ // fmt.Println(page) // return pageNum <= 3 // }) // func (c *IAM) ListSSHPublicKeysPages(input *ListSSHPublicKeysInput, fn func(*ListSSHPublicKeysOutput, bool) bool) error { return c.ListSSHPublicKeysPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn) } // ListSSHPublicKeysPagesWithContext same as ListSSHPublicKeysPages except // it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) ListSSHPublicKeysPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListSSHPublicKeysInput, fn func(*ListSSHPublicKeysOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error { p := request.Pagination{ NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) { var inCpy *ListSSHPublicKeysInput if input != nil { tmp := *input inCpy = &tmp } req, _ := c.ListSSHPublicKeysRequest(inCpy) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return req, nil }, } cont := true for p.Next() && cont { cont = fn(p.Page().(*ListSSHPublicKeysOutput), !p.HasNextPage()) } return p.Err() } const opListServerCertificates = "ListServerCertificates" // ListServerCertificatesRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the ListServerCertificates operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See ListServerCertificates for more information on using the ListServerCertificates // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the ListServerCertificatesRequest method. // req, resp := client.ListServerCertificatesRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/ListServerCertificates func (c *IAM) ListServerCertificatesRequest(input *ListServerCertificatesInput) (req *request.Request, output *ListServerCertificatesOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opListServerCertificates, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", Paginator: &request.Paginator{ InputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, LimitToken: "MaxItems", TruncationToken: "IsTruncated", }, } if input == nil { input = &ListServerCertificatesInput{} } output = &ListServerCertificatesOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // ListServerCertificates API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Lists the server certificates stored in IAM that have the specified path // prefix. If none exist, the action returns an empty list. // // You can paginate the results using the MaxItems and Marker parameters. // // For more information about working with server certificates, including a // list of AWS services that can use the server certificates that you manage // with IAM, go to Working with Server Certificates (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/id_credentials_server-certs.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation ListServerCertificates for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/ListServerCertificates func (c *IAM) ListServerCertificates(input *ListServerCertificatesInput) (*ListServerCertificatesOutput, error) { req, out := c.ListServerCertificatesRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // ListServerCertificatesWithContext is the same as ListServerCertificates with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See ListServerCertificates for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) ListServerCertificatesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListServerCertificatesInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ListServerCertificatesOutput, error) { req, out := c.ListServerCertificatesRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } // ListServerCertificatesPages iterates over the pages of a ListServerCertificates operation, // calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop // iterating, return false from the fn function. // // See ListServerCertificates method for more information on how to use this operation. // // Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service. // // // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a ListServerCertificates operation. // pageNum := 0 // err := client.ListServerCertificatesPages(params, // func(page *ListServerCertificatesOutput, lastPage bool) bool { // pageNum++ // fmt.Println(page) // return pageNum <= 3 // }) // func (c *IAM) ListServerCertificatesPages(input *ListServerCertificatesInput, fn func(*ListServerCertificatesOutput, bool) bool) error { return c.ListServerCertificatesPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn) } // ListServerCertificatesPagesWithContext same as ListServerCertificatesPages except // it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) ListServerCertificatesPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListServerCertificatesInput, fn func(*ListServerCertificatesOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error { p := request.Pagination{ NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) { var inCpy *ListServerCertificatesInput if input != nil { tmp := *input inCpy = &tmp } req, _ := c.ListServerCertificatesRequest(inCpy) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return req, nil }, } cont := true for p.Next() && cont { cont = fn(p.Page().(*ListServerCertificatesOutput), !p.HasNextPage()) } return p.Err() } const opListServiceSpecificCredentials = "ListServiceSpecificCredentials" // ListServiceSpecificCredentialsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the ListServiceSpecificCredentials operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See ListServiceSpecificCredentials for more information on using the ListServiceSpecificCredentials // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the ListServiceSpecificCredentialsRequest method. // req, resp := client.ListServiceSpecificCredentialsRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/ListServiceSpecificCredentials func (c *IAM) ListServiceSpecificCredentialsRequest(input *ListServiceSpecificCredentialsInput) (req *request.Request, output *ListServiceSpecificCredentialsOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opListServiceSpecificCredentials, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &ListServiceSpecificCredentialsInput{} } output = &ListServiceSpecificCredentialsOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // ListServiceSpecificCredentials API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Returns information about the service-specific credentials associated with // the specified IAM user. If there are none, the action returns an empty list. // The service-specific credentials returned by this action are used only for // authenticating the IAM user to a specific service. For more information about // using service-specific credentials to authenticate to an AWS service, see // Set Up service-specific credentials (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/codecommit/latest/userguide/setting-up-gc.html) // in the AWS CodeCommit User Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation ListServiceSpecificCredentials for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeServiceNotSupportedException "NotSupportedService" // The specified service does not support service-specific credentials. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/ListServiceSpecificCredentials func (c *IAM) ListServiceSpecificCredentials(input *ListServiceSpecificCredentialsInput) (*ListServiceSpecificCredentialsOutput, error) { req, out := c.ListServiceSpecificCredentialsRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // ListServiceSpecificCredentialsWithContext is the same as ListServiceSpecificCredentials with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See ListServiceSpecificCredentials for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) ListServiceSpecificCredentialsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListServiceSpecificCredentialsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ListServiceSpecificCredentialsOutput, error) { req, out := c.ListServiceSpecificCredentialsRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opListSigningCertificates = "ListSigningCertificates" // ListSigningCertificatesRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the ListSigningCertificates operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See ListSigningCertificates for more information on using the ListSigningCertificates // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the ListSigningCertificatesRequest method. // req, resp := client.ListSigningCertificatesRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/ListSigningCertificates func (c *IAM) ListSigningCertificatesRequest(input *ListSigningCertificatesInput) (req *request.Request, output *ListSigningCertificatesOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opListSigningCertificates, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", Paginator: &request.Paginator{ InputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, LimitToken: "MaxItems", TruncationToken: "IsTruncated", }, } if input == nil { input = &ListSigningCertificatesInput{} } output = &ListSigningCertificatesOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // ListSigningCertificates API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Returns information about the signing certificates associated with the specified // IAM user. If there are none, the action returns an empty list. // // Although each user is limited to a small number of signing certificates, // you can still paginate the results using the MaxItems and Marker parameters. // // If the UserName field is not specified, the user name is determined implicitly // based on the AWS access key ID used to sign the request for this API. Because // this action works for access keys under the AWS account, you can use this // action to manage root credentials even if the AWS account has no associated // users. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation ListSigningCertificates for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/ListSigningCertificates func (c *IAM) ListSigningCertificates(input *ListSigningCertificatesInput) (*ListSigningCertificatesOutput, error) { req, out := c.ListSigningCertificatesRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // ListSigningCertificatesWithContext is the same as ListSigningCertificates with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See ListSigningCertificates for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) ListSigningCertificatesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListSigningCertificatesInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ListSigningCertificatesOutput, error) { req, out := c.ListSigningCertificatesRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } // ListSigningCertificatesPages iterates over the pages of a ListSigningCertificates operation, // calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop // iterating, return false from the fn function. // // See ListSigningCertificates method for more information on how to use this operation. // // Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service. // // // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a ListSigningCertificates operation. // pageNum := 0 // err := client.ListSigningCertificatesPages(params, // func(page *ListSigningCertificatesOutput, lastPage bool) bool { // pageNum++ // fmt.Println(page) // return pageNum <= 3 // }) // func (c *IAM) ListSigningCertificatesPages(input *ListSigningCertificatesInput, fn func(*ListSigningCertificatesOutput, bool) bool) error { return c.ListSigningCertificatesPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn) } // ListSigningCertificatesPagesWithContext same as ListSigningCertificatesPages except // it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) ListSigningCertificatesPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListSigningCertificatesInput, fn func(*ListSigningCertificatesOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error { p := request.Pagination{ NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) { var inCpy *ListSigningCertificatesInput if input != nil { tmp := *input inCpy = &tmp } req, _ := c.ListSigningCertificatesRequest(inCpy) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return req, nil }, } cont := true for p.Next() && cont { cont = fn(p.Page().(*ListSigningCertificatesOutput), !p.HasNextPage()) } return p.Err() } const opListUserPolicies = "ListUserPolicies" // ListUserPoliciesRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the ListUserPolicies operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See ListUserPolicies for more information on using the ListUserPolicies // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the ListUserPoliciesRequest method. // req, resp := client.ListUserPoliciesRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/ListUserPolicies func (c *IAM) ListUserPoliciesRequest(input *ListUserPoliciesInput) (req *request.Request, output *ListUserPoliciesOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opListUserPolicies, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", Paginator: &request.Paginator{ InputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, LimitToken: "MaxItems", TruncationToken: "IsTruncated", }, } if input == nil { input = &ListUserPoliciesInput{} } output = &ListUserPoliciesOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // ListUserPolicies API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Lists the names of the inline policies embedded in the specified IAM user. // // An IAM user can also have managed policies attached to it. To list the managed // policies that are attached to a user, use ListAttachedUserPolicies. For more // information about policies, see Managed Policies and Inline Policies (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // You can paginate the results using the MaxItems and Marker parameters. If // there are no inline policies embedded with the specified user, the action // returns an empty list. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation ListUserPolicies for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/ListUserPolicies func (c *IAM) ListUserPolicies(input *ListUserPoliciesInput) (*ListUserPoliciesOutput, error) { req, out := c.ListUserPoliciesRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // ListUserPoliciesWithContext is the same as ListUserPolicies with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See ListUserPolicies for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) ListUserPoliciesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListUserPoliciesInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ListUserPoliciesOutput, error) { req, out := c.ListUserPoliciesRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } // ListUserPoliciesPages iterates over the pages of a ListUserPolicies operation, // calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop // iterating, return false from the fn function. // // See ListUserPolicies method for more information on how to use this operation. // // Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service. // // // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a ListUserPolicies operation. // pageNum := 0 // err := client.ListUserPoliciesPages(params, // func(page *ListUserPoliciesOutput, lastPage bool) bool { // pageNum++ // fmt.Println(page) // return pageNum <= 3 // }) // func (c *IAM) ListUserPoliciesPages(input *ListUserPoliciesInput, fn func(*ListUserPoliciesOutput, bool) bool) error { return c.ListUserPoliciesPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn) } // ListUserPoliciesPagesWithContext same as ListUserPoliciesPages except // it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) ListUserPoliciesPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListUserPoliciesInput, fn func(*ListUserPoliciesOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error { p := request.Pagination{ NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) { var inCpy *ListUserPoliciesInput if input != nil { tmp := *input inCpy = &tmp } req, _ := c.ListUserPoliciesRequest(inCpy) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return req, nil }, } cont := true for p.Next() && cont { cont = fn(p.Page().(*ListUserPoliciesOutput), !p.HasNextPage()) } return p.Err() } const opListUsers = "ListUsers" // ListUsersRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the ListUsers operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See ListUsers for more information on using the ListUsers // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the ListUsersRequest method. // req, resp := client.ListUsersRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/ListUsers func (c *IAM) ListUsersRequest(input *ListUsersInput) (req *request.Request, output *ListUsersOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opListUsers, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", Paginator: &request.Paginator{ InputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, LimitToken: "MaxItems", TruncationToken: "IsTruncated", }, } if input == nil { input = &ListUsersInput{} } output = &ListUsersOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // ListUsers API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Lists the IAM users that have the specified path prefix. If no path prefix // is specified, the action returns all users in the AWS account. If there are // none, the action returns an empty list. // // You can paginate the results using the MaxItems and Marker parameters. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation ListUsers for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/ListUsers func (c *IAM) ListUsers(input *ListUsersInput) (*ListUsersOutput, error) { req, out := c.ListUsersRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // ListUsersWithContext is the same as ListUsers with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See ListUsers for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) ListUsersWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListUsersInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ListUsersOutput, error) { req, out := c.ListUsersRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } // ListUsersPages iterates over the pages of a ListUsers operation, // calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop // iterating, return false from the fn function. // // See ListUsers method for more information on how to use this operation. // // Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service. // // // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a ListUsers operation. // pageNum := 0 // err := client.ListUsersPages(params, // func(page *ListUsersOutput, lastPage bool) bool { // pageNum++ // fmt.Println(page) // return pageNum <= 3 // }) // func (c *IAM) ListUsersPages(input *ListUsersInput, fn func(*ListUsersOutput, bool) bool) error { return c.ListUsersPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn) } // ListUsersPagesWithContext same as ListUsersPages except // it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) ListUsersPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListUsersInput, fn func(*ListUsersOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error { p := request.Pagination{ NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) { var inCpy *ListUsersInput if input != nil { tmp := *input inCpy = &tmp } req, _ := c.ListUsersRequest(inCpy) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return req, nil }, } cont := true for p.Next() && cont { cont = fn(p.Page().(*ListUsersOutput), !p.HasNextPage()) } return p.Err() } const opListVirtualMFADevices = "ListVirtualMFADevices" // ListVirtualMFADevicesRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the ListVirtualMFADevices operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See ListVirtualMFADevices for more information on using the ListVirtualMFADevices // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the ListVirtualMFADevicesRequest method. // req, resp := client.ListVirtualMFADevicesRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/ListVirtualMFADevices func (c *IAM) ListVirtualMFADevicesRequest(input *ListVirtualMFADevicesInput) (req *request.Request, output *ListVirtualMFADevicesOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opListVirtualMFADevices, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", Paginator: &request.Paginator{ InputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, LimitToken: "MaxItems", TruncationToken: "IsTruncated", }, } if input == nil { input = &ListVirtualMFADevicesInput{} } output = &ListVirtualMFADevicesOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // ListVirtualMFADevices API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Lists the virtual MFA devices defined in the AWS account by assignment status. // If you do not specify an assignment status, the action returns a list of // all virtual MFA devices. Assignment status can be Assigned, Unassigned, or // Any. // // You can paginate the results using the MaxItems and Marker parameters. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation ListVirtualMFADevices for usage and error information. // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/ListVirtualMFADevices func (c *IAM) ListVirtualMFADevices(input *ListVirtualMFADevicesInput) (*ListVirtualMFADevicesOutput, error) { req, out := c.ListVirtualMFADevicesRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // ListVirtualMFADevicesWithContext is the same as ListVirtualMFADevices with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See ListVirtualMFADevices for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) ListVirtualMFADevicesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListVirtualMFADevicesInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ListVirtualMFADevicesOutput, error) { req, out := c.ListVirtualMFADevicesRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } // ListVirtualMFADevicesPages iterates over the pages of a ListVirtualMFADevices operation, // calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop // iterating, return false from the fn function. // // See ListVirtualMFADevices method for more information on how to use this operation. // // Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service. // // // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a ListVirtualMFADevices operation. // pageNum := 0 // err := client.ListVirtualMFADevicesPages(params, // func(page *ListVirtualMFADevicesOutput, lastPage bool) bool { // pageNum++ // fmt.Println(page) // return pageNum <= 3 // }) // func (c *IAM) ListVirtualMFADevicesPages(input *ListVirtualMFADevicesInput, fn func(*ListVirtualMFADevicesOutput, bool) bool) error { return c.ListVirtualMFADevicesPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn) } // ListVirtualMFADevicesPagesWithContext same as ListVirtualMFADevicesPages except // it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) ListVirtualMFADevicesPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListVirtualMFADevicesInput, fn func(*ListVirtualMFADevicesOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error { p := request.Pagination{ NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) { var inCpy *ListVirtualMFADevicesInput if input != nil { tmp := *input inCpy = &tmp } req, _ := c.ListVirtualMFADevicesRequest(inCpy) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return req, nil }, } cont := true for p.Next() && cont { cont = fn(p.Page().(*ListVirtualMFADevicesOutput), !p.HasNextPage()) } return p.Err() } const opPutGroupPolicy = "PutGroupPolicy" // PutGroupPolicyRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the PutGroupPolicy operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See PutGroupPolicy for more information on using the PutGroupPolicy // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the PutGroupPolicyRequest method. // req, resp := client.PutGroupPolicyRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/PutGroupPolicy func (c *IAM) PutGroupPolicyRequest(input *PutGroupPolicyInput) (req *request.Request, output *PutGroupPolicyOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opPutGroupPolicy, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &PutGroupPolicyInput{} } output = &PutGroupPolicyOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Remove(query.UnmarshalHandler) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBackNamed(protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // PutGroupPolicy API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Adds or updates an inline policy document that is embedded in the specified // IAM group. // // A user can also have managed policies attached to it. To attach a managed // policy to a group, use AttachGroupPolicy. To create a new managed policy, // use CreatePolicy. For information about policies, see Managed Policies and // Inline Policies (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // For information about limits on the number of inline policies that you can // embed in a group, see Limitations on IAM Entities (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/LimitationsOnEntities.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // Because policy documents can be large, you should use POST rather than GET // when calling PutGroupPolicy. For general information about using the Query // API with IAM, go to Making Query Requests (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/IAM_UsingQueryAPI.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation PutGroupPolicy for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeMalformedPolicyDocumentException "MalformedPolicyDocument" // The request was rejected because the policy document was malformed. The error // message describes the specific error. // // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/PutGroupPolicy func (c *IAM) PutGroupPolicy(input *PutGroupPolicyInput) (*PutGroupPolicyOutput, error) { req, out := c.PutGroupPolicyRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // PutGroupPolicyWithContext is the same as PutGroupPolicy with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See PutGroupPolicy for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) PutGroupPolicyWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *PutGroupPolicyInput, opts ...request.Option) (*PutGroupPolicyOutput, error) { req, out := c.PutGroupPolicyRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opPutRolePolicy = "PutRolePolicy" // PutRolePolicyRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the PutRolePolicy operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See PutRolePolicy for more information on using the PutRolePolicy // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the PutRolePolicyRequest method. // req, resp := client.PutRolePolicyRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/PutRolePolicy func (c *IAM) PutRolePolicyRequest(input *PutRolePolicyInput) (req *request.Request, output *PutRolePolicyOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opPutRolePolicy, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &PutRolePolicyInput{} } output = &PutRolePolicyOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Remove(query.UnmarshalHandler) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBackNamed(protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // PutRolePolicy API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Adds or updates an inline policy document that is embedded in the specified // IAM role. // // When you embed an inline policy in a role, the inline policy is used as part // of the role's access (permissions) policy. The role's trust policy is created // at the same time as the role, using CreateRole. You can update a role's trust // policy using UpdateAssumeRolePolicy. For more information about IAM roles, // go to Using Roles to Delegate Permissions and Federate Identities (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/roles-toplevel.html). // // A role can also have a managed policy attached to it. To attach a managed // policy to a role, use AttachRolePolicy. To create a new managed policy, use // CreatePolicy. For information about policies, see Managed Policies and Inline // Policies (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // For information about limits on the number of inline policies that you can // embed with a role, see Limitations on IAM Entities (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/LimitationsOnEntities.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // Because policy documents can be large, you should use POST rather than GET // when calling PutRolePolicy. For general information about using the Query // API with IAM, go to Making Query Requests (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/IAM_UsingQueryAPI.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation PutRolePolicy for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeMalformedPolicyDocumentException "MalformedPolicyDocument" // The request was rejected because the policy document was malformed. The error // message describes the specific error. // // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeUnmodifiableEntityException "UnmodifiableEntity" // The request was rejected because only the service that depends on the service-linked // role can modify or delete the role on your behalf. The error message includes // the name of the service that depends on this service-linked role. You must // request the change through that service. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/PutRolePolicy func (c *IAM) PutRolePolicy(input *PutRolePolicyInput) (*PutRolePolicyOutput, error) { req, out := c.PutRolePolicyRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // PutRolePolicyWithContext is the same as PutRolePolicy with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See PutRolePolicy for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) PutRolePolicyWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *PutRolePolicyInput, opts ...request.Option) (*PutRolePolicyOutput, error) { req, out := c.PutRolePolicyRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opPutUserPolicy = "PutUserPolicy" // PutUserPolicyRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the PutUserPolicy operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See PutUserPolicy for more information on using the PutUserPolicy // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the PutUserPolicyRequest method. // req, resp := client.PutUserPolicyRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/PutUserPolicy func (c *IAM) PutUserPolicyRequest(input *PutUserPolicyInput) (req *request.Request, output *PutUserPolicyOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opPutUserPolicy, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &PutUserPolicyInput{} } output = &PutUserPolicyOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Remove(query.UnmarshalHandler) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBackNamed(protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // PutUserPolicy API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Adds or updates an inline policy document that is embedded in the specified // IAM user. // // An IAM user can also have a managed policy attached to it. To attach a managed // policy to a user, use AttachUserPolicy. To create a new managed policy, use // CreatePolicy. For information about policies, see Managed Policies and Inline // Policies (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // For information about limits on the number of inline policies that you can // embed in a user, see Limitations on IAM Entities (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/LimitationsOnEntities.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // Because policy documents can be large, you should use POST rather than GET // when calling PutUserPolicy. For general information about using the Query // API with IAM, go to Making Query Requests (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/IAM_UsingQueryAPI.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation PutUserPolicy for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeMalformedPolicyDocumentException "MalformedPolicyDocument" // The request was rejected because the policy document was malformed. The error // message describes the specific error. // // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/PutUserPolicy func (c *IAM) PutUserPolicy(input *PutUserPolicyInput) (*PutUserPolicyOutput, error) { req, out := c.PutUserPolicyRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // PutUserPolicyWithContext is the same as PutUserPolicy with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See PutUserPolicy for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) PutUserPolicyWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *PutUserPolicyInput, opts ...request.Option) (*PutUserPolicyOutput, error) { req, out := c.PutUserPolicyRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opRemoveClientIDFromOpenIDConnectProvider = "RemoveClientIDFromOpenIDConnectProvider" // RemoveClientIDFromOpenIDConnectProviderRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the RemoveClientIDFromOpenIDConnectProvider operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See RemoveClientIDFromOpenIDConnectProvider for more information on using the RemoveClientIDFromOpenIDConnectProvider // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the RemoveClientIDFromOpenIDConnectProviderRequest method. // req, resp := client.RemoveClientIDFromOpenIDConnectProviderRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/RemoveClientIDFromOpenIDConnectProvider func (c *IAM) RemoveClientIDFromOpenIDConnectProviderRequest(input *RemoveClientIDFromOpenIDConnectProviderInput) (req *request.Request, output *RemoveClientIDFromOpenIDConnectProviderOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opRemoveClientIDFromOpenIDConnectProvider, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &RemoveClientIDFromOpenIDConnectProviderInput{} } output = &RemoveClientIDFromOpenIDConnectProviderOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Remove(query.UnmarshalHandler) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBackNamed(protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // RemoveClientIDFromOpenIDConnectProvider API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Removes the specified client ID (also known as audience) from the list of // client IDs registered for the specified IAM OpenID Connect (OIDC) provider // resource object. // // This action is idempotent; it does not fail or return an error if you try // to remove a client ID that does not exist. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation RemoveClientIDFromOpenIDConnectProvider for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInput" // The request was rejected because an invalid or out-of-range value was supplied // for an input parameter. // // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/RemoveClientIDFromOpenIDConnectProvider func (c *IAM) RemoveClientIDFromOpenIDConnectProvider(input *RemoveClientIDFromOpenIDConnectProviderInput) (*RemoveClientIDFromOpenIDConnectProviderOutput, error) { req, out := c.RemoveClientIDFromOpenIDConnectProviderRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // RemoveClientIDFromOpenIDConnectProviderWithContext is the same as RemoveClientIDFromOpenIDConnectProvider with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See RemoveClientIDFromOpenIDConnectProvider for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) RemoveClientIDFromOpenIDConnectProviderWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *RemoveClientIDFromOpenIDConnectProviderInput, opts ...request.Option) (*RemoveClientIDFromOpenIDConnectProviderOutput, error) { req, out := c.RemoveClientIDFromOpenIDConnectProviderRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opRemoveRoleFromInstanceProfile = "RemoveRoleFromInstanceProfile" // RemoveRoleFromInstanceProfileRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the RemoveRoleFromInstanceProfile operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See RemoveRoleFromInstanceProfile for more information on using the RemoveRoleFromInstanceProfile // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the RemoveRoleFromInstanceProfileRequest method. // req, resp := client.RemoveRoleFromInstanceProfileRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/RemoveRoleFromInstanceProfile func (c *IAM) RemoveRoleFromInstanceProfileRequest(input *RemoveRoleFromInstanceProfileInput) (req *request.Request, output *RemoveRoleFromInstanceProfileOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opRemoveRoleFromInstanceProfile, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &RemoveRoleFromInstanceProfileInput{} } output = &RemoveRoleFromInstanceProfileOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Remove(query.UnmarshalHandler) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBackNamed(protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // RemoveRoleFromInstanceProfile API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Removes the specified IAM role from the specified EC2 instance profile. // // Make sure you do not have any Amazon EC2 instances running with the role // you are about to remove from the instance profile. Removing a role from an // instance profile that is associated with a running instance might break any // applications running on the instance. // // For more information about IAM roles, go to Working with Roles (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/WorkingWithRoles.html). // For more information about instance profiles, go to About Instance Profiles // (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/AboutInstanceProfiles.html). // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation RemoveRoleFromInstanceProfile for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeUnmodifiableEntityException "UnmodifiableEntity" // The request was rejected because only the service that depends on the service-linked // role can modify or delete the role on your behalf. The error message includes // the name of the service that depends on this service-linked role. You must // request the change through that service. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/RemoveRoleFromInstanceProfile func (c *IAM) RemoveRoleFromInstanceProfile(input *RemoveRoleFromInstanceProfileInput) (*RemoveRoleFromInstanceProfileOutput, error) { req, out := c.RemoveRoleFromInstanceProfileRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // RemoveRoleFromInstanceProfileWithContext is the same as RemoveRoleFromInstanceProfile with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See RemoveRoleFromInstanceProfile for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) RemoveRoleFromInstanceProfileWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *RemoveRoleFromInstanceProfileInput, opts ...request.Option) (*RemoveRoleFromInstanceProfileOutput, error) { req, out := c.RemoveRoleFromInstanceProfileRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opRemoveUserFromGroup = "RemoveUserFromGroup" // RemoveUserFromGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the RemoveUserFromGroup operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See RemoveUserFromGroup for more information on using the RemoveUserFromGroup // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the RemoveUserFromGroupRequest method. // req, resp := client.RemoveUserFromGroupRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/RemoveUserFromGroup func (c *IAM) RemoveUserFromGroupRequest(input *RemoveUserFromGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *RemoveUserFromGroupOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opRemoveUserFromGroup, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &RemoveUserFromGroupInput{} } output = &RemoveUserFromGroupOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Remove(query.UnmarshalHandler) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBackNamed(protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // RemoveUserFromGroup API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Removes the specified user from the specified group. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation RemoveUserFromGroup for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/RemoveUserFromGroup func (c *IAM) RemoveUserFromGroup(input *RemoveUserFromGroupInput) (*RemoveUserFromGroupOutput, error) { req, out := c.RemoveUserFromGroupRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // RemoveUserFromGroupWithContext is the same as RemoveUserFromGroup with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See RemoveUserFromGroup for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) RemoveUserFromGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *RemoveUserFromGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*RemoveUserFromGroupOutput, error) { req, out := c.RemoveUserFromGroupRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opResetServiceSpecificCredential = "ResetServiceSpecificCredential" // ResetServiceSpecificCredentialRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the ResetServiceSpecificCredential operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See ResetServiceSpecificCredential for more information on using the ResetServiceSpecificCredential // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the ResetServiceSpecificCredentialRequest method. // req, resp := client.ResetServiceSpecificCredentialRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/ResetServiceSpecificCredential func (c *IAM) ResetServiceSpecificCredentialRequest(input *ResetServiceSpecificCredentialInput) (req *request.Request, output *ResetServiceSpecificCredentialOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opResetServiceSpecificCredential, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &ResetServiceSpecificCredentialInput{} } output = &ResetServiceSpecificCredentialOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // ResetServiceSpecificCredential API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Resets the password for a service-specific credential. The new password is // AWS generated and cryptographically strong. It cannot be configured by the // user. Resetting the password immediately invalidates the previous password // associated with this user. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation ResetServiceSpecificCredential for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/ResetServiceSpecificCredential func (c *IAM) ResetServiceSpecificCredential(input *ResetServiceSpecificCredentialInput) (*ResetServiceSpecificCredentialOutput, error) { req, out := c.ResetServiceSpecificCredentialRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // ResetServiceSpecificCredentialWithContext is the same as ResetServiceSpecificCredential with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See ResetServiceSpecificCredential for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) ResetServiceSpecificCredentialWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ResetServiceSpecificCredentialInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ResetServiceSpecificCredentialOutput, error) { req, out := c.ResetServiceSpecificCredentialRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opResyncMFADevice = "ResyncMFADevice" // ResyncMFADeviceRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the ResyncMFADevice operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See ResyncMFADevice for more information on using the ResyncMFADevice // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the ResyncMFADeviceRequest method. // req, resp := client.ResyncMFADeviceRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/ResyncMFADevice func (c *IAM) ResyncMFADeviceRequest(input *ResyncMFADeviceInput) (req *request.Request, output *ResyncMFADeviceOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opResyncMFADevice, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &ResyncMFADeviceInput{} } output = &ResyncMFADeviceOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Remove(query.UnmarshalHandler) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBackNamed(protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // ResyncMFADevice API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Synchronizes the specified MFA device with its IAM resource object on the // AWS servers. // // For more information about creating and working with virtual MFA devices, // go to Using a Virtual MFA Device (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/Using_VirtualMFA.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation ResyncMFADevice for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeInvalidAuthenticationCodeException "InvalidAuthenticationCode" // The request was rejected because the authentication code was not recognized. // The error message describes the specific error. // // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/ResyncMFADevice func (c *IAM) ResyncMFADevice(input *ResyncMFADeviceInput) (*ResyncMFADeviceOutput, error) { req, out := c.ResyncMFADeviceRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // ResyncMFADeviceWithContext is the same as ResyncMFADevice with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See ResyncMFADevice for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) ResyncMFADeviceWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ResyncMFADeviceInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ResyncMFADeviceOutput, error) { req, out := c.ResyncMFADeviceRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opSetDefaultPolicyVersion = "SetDefaultPolicyVersion" // SetDefaultPolicyVersionRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the SetDefaultPolicyVersion operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See SetDefaultPolicyVersion for more information on using the SetDefaultPolicyVersion // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the SetDefaultPolicyVersionRequest method. // req, resp := client.SetDefaultPolicyVersionRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/SetDefaultPolicyVersion func (c *IAM) SetDefaultPolicyVersionRequest(input *SetDefaultPolicyVersionInput) (req *request.Request, output *SetDefaultPolicyVersionOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opSetDefaultPolicyVersion, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &SetDefaultPolicyVersionInput{} } output = &SetDefaultPolicyVersionOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Remove(query.UnmarshalHandler) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBackNamed(protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // SetDefaultPolicyVersion API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Sets the specified version of the specified policy as the policy's default // (operative) version. // // This action affects all users, groups, and roles that the policy is attached // to. To list the users, groups, and roles that the policy is attached to, // use the ListEntitiesForPolicy API. // // For information about managed policies, see Managed Policies and Inline Policies // (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation SetDefaultPolicyVersion for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInput" // The request was rejected because an invalid or out-of-range value was supplied // for an input parameter. // // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/SetDefaultPolicyVersion func (c *IAM) SetDefaultPolicyVersion(input *SetDefaultPolicyVersionInput) (*SetDefaultPolicyVersionOutput, error) { req, out := c.SetDefaultPolicyVersionRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // SetDefaultPolicyVersionWithContext is the same as SetDefaultPolicyVersion with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See SetDefaultPolicyVersion for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) SetDefaultPolicyVersionWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *SetDefaultPolicyVersionInput, opts ...request.Option) (*SetDefaultPolicyVersionOutput, error) { req, out := c.SetDefaultPolicyVersionRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opSimulateCustomPolicy = "SimulateCustomPolicy" // SimulateCustomPolicyRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the SimulateCustomPolicy operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See SimulateCustomPolicy for more information on using the SimulateCustomPolicy // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the SimulateCustomPolicyRequest method. // req, resp := client.SimulateCustomPolicyRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/SimulateCustomPolicy func (c *IAM) SimulateCustomPolicyRequest(input *SimulateCustomPolicyInput) (req *request.Request, output *SimulatePolicyResponse) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opSimulateCustomPolicy, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", Paginator: &request.Paginator{ InputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, LimitToken: "MaxItems", TruncationToken: "IsTruncated", }, } if input == nil { input = &SimulateCustomPolicyInput{} } output = &SimulatePolicyResponse{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // SimulateCustomPolicy API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Simulate how a set of IAM policies and optionally a resource-based policy // works with a list of API actions and AWS resources to determine the policies' // effective permissions. The policies are provided as strings. // // The simulation does not perform the API actions; it only checks the authorization // to determine if the simulated policies allow or deny the actions. // // If you want to simulate existing policies attached to an IAM user, group, // or role, use SimulatePrincipalPolicy instead. // // Context keys are variables maintained by AWS and its services that provide // details about the context of an API query request. You can use the Condition // element of an IAM policy to evaluate context keys. To get the list of context // keys that the policies require for correct simulation, use GetContextKeysForCustomPolicy. // // If the output is long, you can use MaxItems and Marker parameters to paginate // the results. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation SimulateCustomPolicy for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInput" // The request was rejected because an invalid or out-of-range value was supplied // for an input parameter. // // * ErrCodePolicyEvaluationException "PolicyEvaluation" // The request failed because a provided policy could not be successfully evaluated. // An additional detailed message indicates the source of the failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/SimulateCustomPolicy func (c *IAM) SimulateCustomPolicy(input *SimulateCustomPolicyInput) (*SimulatePolicyResponse, error) { req, out := c.SimulateCustomPolicyRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // SimulateCustomPolicyWithContext is the same as SimulateCustomPolicy with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See SimulateCustomPolicy for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) SimulateCustomPolicyWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *SimulateCustomPolicyInput, opts ...request.Option) (*SimulatePolicyResponse, error) { req, out := c.SimulateCustomPolicyRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } // SimulateCustomPolicyPages iterates over the pages of a SimulateCustomPolicy operation, // calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop // iterating, return false from the fn function. // // See SimulateCustomPolicy method for more information on how to use this operation. // // Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service. // // // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a SimulateCustomPolicy operation. // pageNum := 0 // err := client.SimulateCustomPolicyPages(params, // func(page *SimulatePolicyResponse, lastPage bool) bool { // pageNum++ // fmt.Println(page) // return pageNum <= 3 // }) // func (c *IAM) SimulateCustomPolicyPages(input *SimulateCustomPolicyInput, fn func(*SimulatePolicyResponse, bool) bool) error { return c.SimulateCustomPolicyPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn) } // SimulateCustomPolicyPagesWithContext same as SimulateCustomPolicyPages except // it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) SimulateCustomPolicyPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *SimulateCustomPolicyInput, fn func(*SimulatePolicyResponse, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error { p := request.Pagination{ NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) { var inCpy *SimulateCustomPolicyInput if input != nil { tmp := *input inCpy = &tmp } req, _ := c.SimulateCustomPolicyRequest(inCpy) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return req, nil }, } cont := true for p.Next() && cont { cont = fn(p.Page().(*SimulatePolicyResponse), !p.HasNextPage()) } return p.Err() } const opSimulatePrincipalPolicy = "SimulatePrincipalPolicy" // SimulatePrincipalPolicyRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the SimulatePrincipalPolicy operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See SimulatePrincipalPolicy for more information on using the SimulatePrincipalPolicy // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the SimulatePrincipalPolicyRequest method. // req, resp := client.SimulatePrincipalPolicyRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/SimulatePrincipalPolicy func (c *IAM) SimulatePrincipalPolicyRequest(input *SimulatePrincipalPolicyInput) (req *request.Request, output *SimulatePolicyResponse) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opSimulatePrincipalPolicy, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", Paginator: &request.Paginator{ InputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, LimitToken: "MaxItems", TruncationToken: "IsTruncated", }, } if input == nil { input = &SimulatePrincipalPolicyInput{} } output = &SimulatePolicyResponse{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // SimulatePrincipalPolicy API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Simulate how a set of IAM policies attached to an IAM entity works with a // list of API actions and AWS resources to determine the policies' effective // permissions. The entity can be an IAM user, group, or role. If you specify // a user, then the simulation also includes all of the policies that are attached // to groups that the user belongs to . // // You can optionally include a list of one or more additional policies specified // as strings to include in the simulation. If you want to simulate only policies // specified as strings, use SimulateCustomPolicy instead. // // You can also optionally include one resource-based policy to be evaluated // with each of the resources included in the simulation. // // The simulation does not perform the API actions, it only checks the authorization // to determine if the simulated policies allow or deny the actions. // // Note: This API discloses information about the permissions granted to other // users. If you do not want users to see other user's permissions, then consider // allowing them to use SimulateCustomPolicy instead. // // Context keys are variables maintained by AWS and its services that provide // details about the context of an API query request. You can use the Condition // element of an IAM policy to evaluate context keys. To get the list of context // keys that the policies require for correct simulation, use GetContextKeysForPrincipalPolicy. // // If the output is long, you can use the MaxItems and Marker parameters to // paginate the results. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation SimulatePrincipalPolicy for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInput" // The request was rejected because an invalid or out-of-range value was supplied // for an input parameter. // // * ErrCodePolicyEvaluationException "PolicyEvaluation" // The request failed because a provided policy could not be successfully evaluated. // An additional detailed message indicates the source of the failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/SimulatePrincipalPolicy func (c *IAM) SimulatePrincipalPolicy(input *SimulatePrincipalPolicyInput) (*SimulatePolicyResponse, error) { req, out := c.SimulatePrincipalPolicyRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // SimulatePrincipalPolicyWithContext is the same as SimulatePrincipalPolicy with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See SimulatePrincipalPolicy for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) SimulatePrincipalPolicyWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *SimulatePrincipalPolicyInput, opts ...request.Option) (*SimulatePolicyResponse, error) { req, out := c.SimulatePrincipalPolicyRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } // SimulatePrincipalPolicyPages iterates over the pages of a SimulatePrincipalPolicy operation, // calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop // iterating, return false from the fn function. // // See SimulatePrincipalPolicy method for more information on how to use this operation. // // Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service. // // // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a SimulatePrincipalPolicy operation. // pageNum := 0 // err := client.SimulatePrincipalPolicyPages(params, // func(page *SimulatePolicyResponse, lastPage bool) bool { // pageNum++ // fmt.Println(page) // return pageNum <= 3 // }) // func (c *IAM) SimulatePrincipalPolicyPages(input *SimulatePrincipalPolicyInput, fn func(*SimulatePolicyResponse, bool) bool) error { return c.SimulatePrincipalPolicyPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn) } // SimulatePrincipalPolicyPagesWithContext same as SimulatePrincipalPolicyPages except // it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) SimulatePrincipalPolicyPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *SimulatePrincipalPolicyInput, fn func(*SimulatePolicyResponse, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error { p := request.Pagination{ NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) { var inCpy *SimulatePrincipalPolicyInput if input != nil { tmp := *input inCpy = &tmp } req, _ := c.SimulatePrincipalPolicyRequest(inCpy) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return req, nil }, } cont := true for p.Next() && cont { cont = fn(p.Page().(*SimulatePolicyResponse), !p.HasNextPage()) } return p.Err() } const opUpdateAccessKey = "UpdateAccessKey" // UpdateAccessKeyRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the UpdateAccessKey operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See UpdateAccessKey for more information on using the UpdateAccessKey // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the UpdateAccessKeyRequest method. // req, resp := client.UpdateAccessKeyRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/UpdateAccessKey func (c *IAM) UpdateAccessKeyRequest(input *UpdateAccessKeyInput) (req *request.Request, output *UpdateAccessKeyOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opUpdateAccessKey, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &UpdateAccessKeyInput{} } output = &UpdateAccessKeyOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Remove(query.UnmarshalHandler) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBackNamed(protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // UpdateAccessKey API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Changes the status of the specified access key from Active to Inactive, or // vice versa. This action can be used to disable a user's key as part of a // key rotation work flow. // // If the UserName field is not specified, the UserName is determined implicitly // based on the AWS access key ID used to sign the request. Because this action // works for access keys under the AWS account, you can use this action to manage // root credentials even if the AWS account has no associated users. // // For information about rotating keys, see Managing Keys and Certificates (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/ManagingCredentials.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation UpdateAccessKey for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/UpdateAccessKey func (c *IAM) UpdateAccessKey(input *UpdateAccessKeyInput) (*UpdateAccessKeyOutput, error) { req, out := c.UpdateAccessKeyRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // UpdateAccessKeyWithContext is the same as UpdateAccessKey with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See UpdateAccessKey for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) UpdateAccessKeyWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *UpdateAccessKeyInput, opts ...request.Option) (*UpdateAccessKeyOutput, error) { req, out := c.UpdateAccessKeyRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opUpdateAccountPasswordPolicy = "UpdateAccountPasswordPolicy" // UpdateAccountPasswordPolicyRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the UpdateAccountPasswordPolicy operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See UpdateAccountPasswordPolicy for more information on using the UpdateAccountPasswordPolicy // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the UpdateAccountPasswordPolicyRequest method. // req, resp := client.UpdateAccountPasswordPolicyRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/UpdateAccountPasswordPolicy func (c *IAM) UpdateAccountPasswordPolicyRequest(input *UpdateAccountPasswordPolicyInput) (req *request.Request, output *UpdateAccountPasswordPolicyOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opUpdateAccountPasswordPolicy, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &UpdateAccountPasswordPolicyInput{} } output = &UpdateAccountPasswordPolicyOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Remove(query.UnmarshalHandler) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBackNamed(protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // UpdateAccountPasswordPolicy API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Updates the password policy settings for the AWS account. // // This action does not support partial updates. No parameters are required, // but if you do not specify a parameter, that parameter's value reverts to // its default value. See the Request Parameters section for each parameter's // default value. // // For more information about using a password policy, see Managing an IAM Password // Policy (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/Using_ManagingPasswordPolicies.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation UpdateAccountPasswordPolicy for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeMalformedPolicyDocumentException "MalformedPolicyDocument" // The request was rejected because the policy document was malformed. The error // message describes the specific error. // // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/UpdateAccountPasswordPolicy func (c *IAM) UpdateAccountPasswordPolicy(input *UpdateAccountPasswordPolicyInput) (*UpdateAccountPasswordPolicyOutput, error) { req, out := c.UpdateAccountPasswordPolicyRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // UpdateAccountPasswordPolicyWithContext is the same as UpdateAccountPasswordPolicy with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See UpdateAccountPasswordPolicy for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) UpdateAccountPasswordPolicyWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *UpdateAccountPasswordPolicyInput, opts ...request.Option) (*UpdateAccountPasswordPolicyOutput, error) { req, out := c.UpdateAccountPasswordPolicyRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opUpdateAssumeRolePolicy = "UpdateAssumeRolePolicy" // UpdateAssumeRolePolicyRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the UpdateAssumeRolePolicy operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See UpdateAssumeRolePolicy for more information on using the UpdateAssumeRolePolicy // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the UpdateAssumeRolePolicyRequest method. // req, resp := client.UpdateAssumeRolePolicyRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/UpdateAssumeRolePolicy func (c *IAM) UpdateAssumeRolePolicyRequest(input *UpdateAssumeRolePolicyInput) (req *request.Request, output *UpdateAssumeRolePolicyOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opUpdateAssumeRolePolicy, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &UpdateAssumeRolePolicyInput{} } output = &UpdateAssumeRolePolicyOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Remove(query.UnmarshalHandler) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBackNamed(protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // UpdateAssumeRolePolicy API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Updates the policy that grants an IAM entity permission to assume a role. // This is typically referred to as the "role trust policy". For more information // about roles, go to Using Roles to Delegate Permissions and Federate Identities // (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/roles-toplevel.html). // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation UpdateAssumeRolePolicy for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeMalformedPolicyDocumentException "MalformedPolicyDocument" // The request was rejected because the policy document was malformed. The error // message describes the specific error. // // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeUnmodifiableEntityException "UnmodifiableEntity" // The request was rejected because only the service that depends on the service-linked // role can modify or delete the role on your behalf. The error message includes // the name of the service that depends on this service-linked role. You must // request the change through that service. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/UpdateAssumeRolePolicy func (c *IAM) UpdateAssumeRolePolicy(input *UpdateAssumeRolePolicyInput) (*UpdateAssumeRolePolicyOutput, error) { req, out := c.UpdateAssumeRolePolicyRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // UpdateAssumeRolePolicyWithContext is the same as UpdateAssumeRolePolicy with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See UpdateAssumeRolePolicy for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) UpdateAssumeRolePolicyWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *UpdateAssumeRolePolicyInput, opts ...request.Option) (*UpdateAssumeRolePolicyOutput, error) { req, out := c.UpdateAssumeRolePolicyRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opUpdateGroup = "UpdateGroup" // UpdateGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the UpdateGroup operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See UpdateGroup for more information on using the UpdateGroup // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the UpdateGroupRequest method. // req, resp := client.UpdateGroupRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/UpdateGroup func (c *IAM) UpdateGroupRequest(input *UpdateGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *UpdateGroupOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opUpdateGroup, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &UpdateGroupInput{} } output = &UpdateGroupOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Remove(query.UnmarshalHandler) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBackNamed(protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // UpdateGroup API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Updates the name and/or the path of the specified IAM group. // // You should understand the implications of changing a group's path or name. // For more information, see Renaming Users and Groups (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/Using_WorkingWithGroupsAndUsers.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // To change an IAM group name the requester must have appropriate permissions // on both the source object and the target object. For example, to change "Managers" // to "MGRs", the entity making the request must have permission on both "Managers" // and "MGRs", or must have permission on all (*). For more information about // permissions, see Permissions and Policies (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/PermissionsAndPolicies.html). // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation UpdateGroup for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeEntityAlreadyExistsException "EntityAlreadyExists" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create a resource that already // exists. // // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/UpdateGroup func (c *IAM) UpdateGroup(input *UpdateGroupInput) (*UpdateGroupOutput, error) { req, out := c.UpdateGroupRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // UpdateGroupWithContext is the same as UpdateGroup with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See UpdateGroup for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) UpdateGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *UpdateGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*UpdateGroupOutput, error) { req, out := c.UpdateGroupRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opUpdateLoginProfile = "UpdateLoginProfile" // UpdateLoginProfileRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the UpdateLoginProfile operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See UpdateLoginProfile for more information on using the UpdateLoginProfile // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the UpdateLoginProfileRequest method. // req, resp := client.UpdateLoginProfileRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/UpdateLoginProfile func (c *IAM) UpdateLoginProfileRequest(input *UpdateLoginProfileInput) (req *request.Request, output *UpdateLoginProfileOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opUpdateLoginProfile, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &UpdateLoginProfileInput{} } output = &UpdateLoginProfileOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Remove(query.UnmarshalHandler) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBackNamed(protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // UpdateLoginProfile API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Changes the password for the specified IAM user. // // IAM users can change their own passwords by calling ChangePassword. For more // information about modifying passwords, see Managing Passwords (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/Using_ManagingLogins.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation UpdateLoginProfile for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeEntityTemporarilyUnmodifiableException "EntityTemporarilyUnmodifiable" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that is temporarily // unmodifiable, such as a user name that was deleted and then recreated. The // error indicates that the request is likely to succeed if you try again after // waiting several minutes. The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodePasswordPolicyViolationException "PasswordPolicyViolation" // The request was rejected because the provided password did not meet the requirements // imposed by the account password policy. // // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/UpdateLoginProfile func (c *IAM) UpdateLoginProfile(input *UpdateLoginProfileInput) (*UpdateLoginProfileOutput, error) { req, out := c.UpdateLoginProfileRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // UpdateLoginProfileWithContext is the same as UpdateLoginProfile with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See UpdateLoginProfile for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) UpdateLoginProfileWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *UpdateLoginProfileInput, opts ...request.Option) (*UpdateLoginProfileOutput, error) { req, out := c.UpdateLoginProfileRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opUpdateOpenIDConnectProviderThumbprint = "UpdateOpenIDConnectProviderThumbprint" // UpdateOpenIDConnectProviderThumbprintRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the UpdateOpenIDConnectProviderThumbprint operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See UpdateOpenIDConnectProviderThumbprint for more information on using the UpdateOpenIDConnectProviderThumbprint // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the UpdateOpenIDConnectProviderThumbprintRequest method. // req, resp := client.UpdateOpenIDConnectProviderThumbprintRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/UpdateOpenIDConnectProviderThumbprint func (c *IAM) UpdateOpenIDConnectProviderThumbprintRequest(input *UpdateOpenIDConnectProviderThumbprintInput) (req *request.Request, output *UpdateOpenIDConnectProviderThumbprintOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opUpdateOpenIDConnectProviderThumbprint, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &UpdateOpenIDConnectProviderThumbprintInput{} } output = &UpdateOpenIDConnectProviderThumbprintOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Remove(query.UnmarshalHandler) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBackNamed(protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // UpdateOpenIDConnectProviderThumbprint API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Replaces the existing list of server certificate thumbprints associated with // an OpenID Connect (OIDC) provider resource object with a new list of thumbprints. // // The list that you pass with this action completely replaces the existing // list of thumbprints. (The lists are not merged.) // // Typically, you need to update a thumbprint only when the identity provider's // certificate changes, which occurs rarely. However, if the provider's certificate // does change, any attempt to assume an IAM role that specifies the OIDC provider // as a principal fails until the certificate thumbprint is updated. // // Because trust for the OIDC provider is ultimately derived from the provider's // certificate and is validated by the thumbprint, it is a best practice to // limit access to the UpdateOpenIDConnectProviderThumbprint action to highly-privileged // users. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation UpdateOpenIDConnectProviderThumbprint for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInput" // The request was rejected because an invalid or out-of-range value was supplied // for an input parameter. // // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/UpdateOpenIDConnectProviderThumbprint func (c *IAM) UpdateOpenIDConnectProviderThumbprint(input *UpdateOpenIDConnectProviderThumbprintInput) (*UpdateOpenIDConnectProviderThumbprintOutput, error) { req, out := c.UpdateOpenIDConnectProviderThumbprintRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // UpdateOpenIDConnectProviderThumbprintWithContext is the same as UpdateOpenIDConnectProviderThumbprint with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See UpdateOpenIDConnectProviderThumbprint for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) UpdateOpenIDConnectProviderThumbprintWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *UpdateOpenIDConnectProviderThumbprintInput, opts ...request.Option) (*UpdateOpenIDConnectProviderThumbprintOutput, error) { req, out := c.UpdateOpenIDConnectProviderThumbprintRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opUpdateRoleDescription = "UpdateRoleDescription" // UpdateRoleDescriptionRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the UpdateRoleDescription operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See UpdateRoleDescription for more information on using the UpdateRoleDescription // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the UpdateRoleDescriptionRequest method. // req, resp := client.UpdateRoleDescriptionRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/UpdateRoleDescription func (c *IAM) UpdateRoleDescriptionRequest(input *UpdateRoleDescriptionInput) (req *request.Request, output *UpdateRoleDescriptionOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opUpdateRoleDescription, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &UpdateRoleDescriptionInput{} } output = &UpdateRoleDescriptionOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // UpdateRoleDescription API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Modifies the description of a role. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation UpdateRoleDescription for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeUnmodifiableEntityException "UnmodifiableEntity" // The request was rejected because only the service that depends on the service-linked // role can modify or delete the role on your behalf. The error message includes // the name of the service that depends on this service-linked role. You must // request the change through that service. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/UpdateRoleDescription func (c *IAM) UpdateRoleDescription(input *UpdateRoleDescriptionInput) (*UpdateRoleDescriptionOutput, error) { req, out := c.UpdateRoleDescriptionRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // UpdateRoleDescriptionWithContext is the same as UpdateRoleDescription with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See UpdateRoleDescription for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) UpdateRoleDescriptionWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *UpdateRoleDescriptionInput, opts ...request.Option) (*UpdateRoleDescriptionOutput, error) { req, out := c.UpdateRoleDescriptionRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opUpdateSAMLProvider = "UpdateSAMLProvider" // UpdateSAMLProviderRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the UpdateSAMLProvider operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See UpdateSAMLProvider for more information on using the UpdateSAMLProvider // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the UpdateSAMLProviderRequest method. // req, resp := client.UpdateSAMLProviderRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/UpdateSAMLProvider func (c *IAM) UpdateSAMLProviderRequest(input *UpdateSAMLProviderInput) (req *request.Request, output *UpdateSAMLProviderOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opUpdateSAMLProvider, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &UpdateSAMLProviderInput{} } output = &UpdateSAMLProviderOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // UpdateSAMLProvider API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Updates the metadata document for an existing SAML provider resource object. // // This operation requires Signature Version 4 (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/signature-version-4.html). // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation UpdateSAMLProvider for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeInvalidInputException "InvalidInput" // The request was rejected because an invalid or out-of-range value was supplied // for an input parameter. // // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/UpdateSAMLProvider func (c *IAM) UpdateSAMLProvider(input *UpdateSAMLProviderInput) (*UpdateSAMLProviderOutput, error) { req, out := c.UpdateSAMLProviderRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // UpdateSAMLProviderWithContext is the same as UpdateSAMLProvider with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See UpdateSAMLProvider for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) UpdateSAMLProviderWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *UpdateSAMLProviderInput, opts ...request.Option) (*UpdateSAMLProviderOutput, error) { req, out := c.UpdateSAMLProviderRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opUpdateSSHPublicKey = "UpdateSSHPublicKey" // UpdateSSHPublicKeyRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the UpdateSSHPublicKey operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See UpdateSSHPublicKey for more information on using the UpdateSSHPublicKey // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the UpdateSSHPublicKeyRequest method. // req, resp := client.UpdateSSHPublicKeyRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/UpdateSSHPublicKey func (c *IAM) UpdateSSHPublicKeyRequest(input *UpdateSSHPublicKeyInput) (req *request.Request, output *UpdateSSHPublicKeyOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opUpdateSSHPublicKey, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &UpdateSSHPublicKeyInput{} } output = &UpdateSSHPublicKeyOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Remove(query.UnmarshalHandler) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBackNamed(protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // UpdateSSHPublicKey API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Sets the status of an IAM user's SSH public key to active or inactive. SSH // public keys that are inactive cannot be used for authentication. This action // can be used to disable a user's SSH public key as part of a key rotation // work flow. // // The SSH public key affected by this action is used only for authenticating // the associated IAM user to an AWS CodeCommit repository. For more information // about using SSH keys to authenticate to an AWS CodeCommit repository, see // Set up AWS CodeCommit for SSH Connections (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/codecommit/latest/userguide/setting-up-credentials-ssh.html) // in the AWS CodeCommit User Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation UpdateSSHPublicKey for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/UpdateSSHPublicKey func (c *IAM) UpdateSSHPublicKey(input *UpdateSSHPublicKeyInput) (*UpdateSSHPublicKeyOutput, error) { req, out := c.UpdateSSHPublicKeyRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // UpdateSSHPublicKeyWithContext is the same as UpdateSSHPublicKey with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See UpdateSSHPublicKey for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) UpdateSSHPublicKeyWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *UpdateSSHPublicKeyInput, opts ...request.Option) (*UpdateSSHPublicKeyOutput, error) { req, out := c.UpdateSSHPublicKeyRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opUpdateServerCertificate = "UpdateServerCertificate" // UpdateServerCertificateRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the UpdateServerCertificate operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See UpdateServerCertificate for more information on using the UpdateServerCertificate // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the UpdateServerCertificateRequest method. // req, resp := client.UpdateServerCertificateRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/UpdateServerCertificate func (c *IAM) UpdateServerCertificateRequest(input *UpdateServerCertificateInput) (req *request.Request, output *UpdateServerCertificateOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opUpdateServerCertificate, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &UpdateServerCertificateInput{} } output = &UpdateServerCertificateOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Remove(query.UnmarshalHandler) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBackNamed(protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // UpdateServerCertificate API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Updates the name and/or the path of the specified server certificate stored // in IAM. // // For more information about working with server certificates, including a // list of AWS services that can use the server certificates that you manage // with IAM, go to Working with Server Certificates (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/id_credentials_server-certs.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // You should understand the implications of changing a server certificate's // path or name. For more information, see Renaming a Server Certificate (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/id_credentials_server-certs_manage.html#RenamingServerCerts) // in the IAM User Guide. // // To change a server certificate name the requester must have appropriate permissions // on both the source object and the target object. For example, to change the // name from "ProductionCert" to "ProdCert", the entity making the request must // have permission on "ProductionCert" and "ProdCert", or must have permission // on all (*). For more information about permissions, see Access Management // (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/access.html) in the IAM // User Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation UpdateServerCertificate for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeEntityAlreadyExistsException "EntityAlreadyExists" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create a resource that already // exists. // // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/UpdateServerCertificate func (c *IAM) UpdateServerCertificate(input *UpdateServerCertificateInput) (*UpdateServerCertificateOutput, error) { req, out := c.UpdateServerCertificateRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // UpdateServerCertificateWithContext is the same as UpdateServerCertificate with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See UpdateServerCertificate for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) UpdateServerCertificateWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *UpdateServerCertificateInput, opts ...request.Option) (*UpdateServerCertificateOutput, error) { req, out := c.UpdateServerCertificateRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opUpdateServiceSpecificCredential = "UpdateServiceSpecificCredential" // UpdateServiceSpecificCredentialRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the UpdateServiceSpecificCredential operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See UpdateServiceSpecificCredential for more information on using the UpdateServiceSpecificCredential // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the UpdateServiceSpecificCredentialRequest method. // req, resp := client.UpdateServiceSpecificCredentialRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/UpdateServiceSpecificCredential func (c *IAM) UpdateServiceSpecificCredentialRequest(input *UpdateServiceSpecificCredentialInput) (req *request.Request, output *UpdateServiceSpecificCredentialOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opUpdateServiceSpecificCredential, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &UpdateServiceSpecificCredentialInput{} } output = &UpdateServiceSpecificCredentialOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Remove(query.UnmarshalHandler) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBackNamed(protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // UpdateServiceSpecificCredential API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Sets the status of a service-specific credential to Active or Inactive. Service-specific // credentials that are inactive cannot be used for authentication to the service. // This action can be used to disable a user’s service-specific credential as // part of a credential rotation work flow. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation UpdateServiceSpecificCredential for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/UpdateServiceSpecificCredential func (c *IAM) UpdateServiceSpecificCredential(input *UpdateServiceSpecificCredentialInput) (*UpdateServiceSpecificCredentialOutput, error) { req, out := c.UpdateServiceSpecificCredentialRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // UpdateServiceSpecificCredentialWithContext is the same as UpdateServiceSpecificCredential with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See UpdateServiceSpecificCredential for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) UpdateServiceSpecificCredentialWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *UpdateServiceSpecificCredentialInput, opts ...request.Option) (*UpdateServiceSpecificCredentialOutput, error) { req, out := c.UpdateServiceSpecificCredentialRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opUpdateSigningCertificate = "UpdateSigningCertificate" // UpdateSigningCertificateRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the UpdateSigningCertificate operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See UpdateSigningCertificate for more information on using the UpdateSigningCertificate // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the UpdateSigningCertificateRequest method. // req, resp := client.UpdateSigningCertificateRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/UpdateSigningCertificate func (c *IAM) UpdateSigningCertificateRequest(input *UpdateSigningCertificateInput) (req *request.Request, output *UpdateSigningCertificateOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opUpdateSigningCertificate, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &UpdateSigningCertificateInput{} } output = &UpdateSigningCertificateOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Remove(query.UnmarshalHandler) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBackNamed(protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // UpdateSigningCertificate API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Changes the status of the specified user signing certificate from active // to disabled, or vice versa. This action can be used to disable an IAM user's // signing certificate as part of a certificate rotation work flow. // // If the UserName field is not specified, the UserName is determined implicitly // based on the AWS access key ID used to sign the request. Because this action // works for access keys under the AWS account, you can use this action to manage // root credentials even if the AWS account has no associated users. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation UpdateSigningCertificate for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/UpdateSigningCertificate func (c *IAM) UpdateSigningCertificate(input *UpdateSigningCertificateInput) (*UpdateSigningCertificateOutput, error) { req, out := c.UpdateSigningCertificateRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // UpdateSigningCertificateWithContext is the same as UpdateSigningCertificate with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See UpdateSigningCertificate for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) UpdateSigningCertificateWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *UpdateSigningCertificateInput, opts ...request.Option) (*UpdateSigningCertificateOutput, error) { req, out := c.UpdateSigningCertificateRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opUpdateUser = "UpdateUser" // UpdateUserRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the UpdateUser operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See UpdateUser for more information on using the UpdateUser // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the UpdateUserRequest method. // req, resp := client.UpdateUserRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/UpdateUser func (c *IAM) UpdateUserRequest(input *UpdateUserInput) (req *request.Request, output *UpdateUserOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opUpdateUser, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &UpdateUserInput{} } output = &UpdateUserOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Remove(query.UnmarshalHandler) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBackNamed(protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // UpdateUser API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Updates the name and/or the path of the specified IAM user. // // You should understand the implications of changing an IAM user's path or // name. For more information, see Renaming an IAM User (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/id_users_manage.html#id_users_renaming) // and Renaming an IAM Group (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/id_groups_manage_rename.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // To change a user name the requester must have appropriate permissions on // both the source object and the target object. For example, to change Bob // to Robert, the entity making the request must have permission on Bob and // Robert, or must have permission on all (*). For more information about permissions, // see Permissions and Policies (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/PermissionsAndPolicies.html). // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation UpdateUser for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeEntityAlreadyExistsException "EntityAlreadyExists" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create a resource that already // exists. // // * ErrCodeEntityTemporarilyUnmodifiableException "EntityTemporarilyUnmodifiable" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that is temporarily // unmodifiable, such as a user name that was deleted and then recreated. The // error indicates that the request is likely to succeed if you try again after // waiting several minutes. The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/UpdateUser func (c *IAM) UpdateUser(input *UpdateUserInput) (*UpdateUserOutput, error) { req, out := c.UpdateUserRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // UpdateUserWithContext is the same as UpdateUser with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See UpdateUser for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) UpdateUserWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *UpdateUserInput, opts ...request.Option) (*UpdateUserOutput, error) { req, out := c.UpdateUserRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opUploadSSHPublicKey = "UploadSSHPublicKey" // UploadSSHPublicKeyRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the UploadSSHPublicKey operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See UploadSSHPublicKey for more information on using the UploadSSHPublicKey // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the UploadSSHPublicKeyRequest method. // req, resp := client.UploadSSHPublicKeyRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/UploadSSHPublicKey func (c *IAM) UploadSSHPublicKeyRequest(input *UploadSSHPublicKeyInput) (req *request.Request, output *UploadSSHPublicKeyOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opUploadSSHPublicKey, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &UploadSSHPublicKeyInput{} } output = &UploadSSHPublicKeyOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // UploadSSHPublicKey API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Uploads an SSH public key and associates it with the specified IAM user. // // The SSH public key uploaded by this action can be used only for authenticating // the associated IAM user to an AWS CodeCommit repository. For more information // about using SSH keys to authenticate to an AWS CodeCommit repository, see // Set up AWS CodeCommit for SSH Connections (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/codecommit/latest/userguide/setting-up-credentials-ssh.html) // in the AWS CodeCommit User Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation UploadSSHPublicKey for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeInvalidPublicKeyException "InvalidPublicKey" // The request was rejected because the public key is malformed or otherwise // invalid. // // * ErrCodeDuplicateSSHPublicKeyException "DuplicateSSHPublicKey" // The request was rejected because the SSH public key is already associated // with the specified IAM user. // // * ErrCodeUnrecognizedPublicKeyEncodingException "UnrecognizedPublicKeyEncoding" // The request was rejected because the public key encoding format is unsupported // or unrecognized. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/UploadSSHPublicKey func (c *IAM) UploadSSHPublicKey(input *UploadSSHPublicKeyInput) (*UploadSSHPublicKeyOutput, error) { req, out := c.UploadSSHPublicKeyRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // UploadSSHPublicKeyWithContext is the same as UploadSSHPublicKey with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See UploadSSHPublicKey for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) UploadSSHPublicKeyWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *UploadSSHPublicKeyInput, opts ...request.Option) (*UploadSSHPublicKeyOutput, error) { req, out := c.UploadSSHPublicKeyRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opUploadServerCertificate = "UploadServerCertificate" // UploadServerCertificateRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the UploadServerCertificate operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See UploadServerCertificate for more information on using the UploadServerCertificate // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the UploadServerCertificateRequest method. // req, resp := client.UploadServerCertificateRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/UploadServerCertificate func (c *IAM) UploadServerCertificateRequest(input *UploadServerCertificateInput) (req *request.Request, output *UploadServerCertificateOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opUploadServerCertificate, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &UploadServerCertificateInput{} } output = &UploadServerCertificateOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // UploadServerCertificate API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Uploads a server certificate entity for the AWS account. The server certificate // entity includes a public key certificate, a private key, and an optional // certificate chain, which should all be PEM-encoded. // // We recommend that you use AWS Certificate Manager (https://aws.amazon.com/certificate-manager/) // to provision, manage, and deploy your server certificates. With ACM you can // request a certificate, deploy it to AWS resources, and let ACM handle certificate // renewals for you. Certificates provided by ACM are free. For more information // about using ACM, see the AWS Certificate Manager User Guide (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/acm/latest/userguide/). // // For more information about working with server certificates, including a // list of AWS services that can use the server certificates that you manage // with IAM, go to Working with Server Certificates (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/id_credentials_server-certs.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // For information about the number of server certificates you can upload, see // Limitations on IAM Entities and Objects (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/reference_iam-limits.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // Because the body of the public key certificate, private key, and the certificate // chain can be large, you should use POST rather than GET when calling UploadServerCertificate. // For information about setting up signatures and authorization through the // API, go to Signing AWS API Requests (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/signing_aws_api_requests.html) // in the AWS General Reference. For general information about using the Query // API with IAM, go to Calling the API by Making HTTP Query Requests (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/programming.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation UploadServerCertificate for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeEntityAlreadyExistsException "EntityAlreadyExists" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create a resource that already // exists. // // * ErrCodeMalformedCertificateException "MalformedCertificate" // The request was rejected because the certificate was malformed or expired. // The error message describes the specific error. // // * ErrCodeKeyPairMismatchException "KeyPairMismatch" // The request was rejected because the public key certificate and the private // key do not match. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/UploadServerCertificate func (c *IAM) UploadServerCertificate(input *UploadServerCertificateInput) (*UploadServerCertificateOutput, error) { req, out := c.UploadServerCertificateRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // UploadServerCertificateWithContext is the same as UploadServerCertificate with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See UploadServerCertificate for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) UploadServerCertificateWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *UploadServerCertificateInput, opts ...request.Option) (*UploadServerCertificateOutput, error) { req, out := c.UploadServerCertificateRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opUploadSigningCertificate = "UploadSigningCertificate" // UploadSigningCertificateRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the UploadSigningCertificate operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets // successfuly. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See UploadSigningCertificate for more information on using the UploadSigningCertificate // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the UploadSigningCertificateRequest method. // req, resp := client.UploadSigningCertificateRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/UploadSigningCertificate func (c *IAM) UploadSigningCertificateRequest(input *UploadSigningCertificateInput) (req *request.Request, output *UploadSigningCertificateOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opUploadSigningCertificate, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &UploadSigningCertificateInput{} } output = &UploadSigningCertificateOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // UploadSigningCertificate API operation for AWS Identity and Access Management. // // Uploads an X.509 signing certificate and associates it with the specified // IAM user. Some AWS services use X.509 signing certificates to validate requests // that are signed with a corresponding private key. When you upload the certificate, // its default status is Active. // // If the UserName field is not specified, the IAM user name is determined implicitly // based on the AWS access key ID used to sign the request. Because this action // works for access keys under the AWS account, you can use this action to manage // root credentials even if the AWS account has no associated users. // // Because the body of a X.509 certificate can be large, you should use POST // rather than GET when calling UploadSigningCertificate. For information about // setting up signatures and authorization through the API, go to Signing AWS // API Requests (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/signing_aws_api_requests.html) // in the AWS General Reference. For general information about using the Query // API with IAM, go to Making Query Requests (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/IAM_UsingQueryAPI.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Identity and Access Management's // API operation UploadSigningCertificate for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeLimitExceededException "LimitExceeded" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create resources beyond // the current AWS account limits. The error message describes the limit exceeded. // // * ErrCodeEntityAlreadyExistsException "EntityAlreadyExists" // The request was rejected because it attempted to create a resource that already // exists. // // * ErrCodeMalformedCertificateException "MalformedCertificate" // The request was rejected because the certificate was malformed or expired. // The error message describes the specific error. // // * ErrCodeInvalidCertificateException "InvalidCertificate" // The request was rejected because the certificate is invalid. // // * ErrCodeDuplicateCertificateException "DuplicateCertificate" // The request was rejected because the same certificate is associated with // an IAM user in the account. // // * ErrCodeNoSuchEntityException "NoSuchEntity" // The request was rejected because it referenced an entity that does not exist. // The error message describes the entity. // // * ErrCodeServiceFailureException "ServiceFailure" // The request processing has failed because of an unknown error, exception // or failure. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/iam-2010-05-08/UploadSigningCertificate func (c *IAM) UploadSigningCertificate(input *UploadSigningCertificateInput) (*UploadSigningCertificateOutput, error) { req, out := c.UploadSigningCertificateRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // UploadSigningCertificateWithContext is the same as UploadSigningCertificate with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See UploadSigningCertificate for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *IAM) UploadSigningCertificateWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *UploadSigningCertificateInput, opts ...request.Option) (*UploadSigningCertificateOutput, error) { req, out := c.UploadSigningCertificateRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } // Contains information about an AWS access key. // // This data type is used as a response element in the CreateAccessKey and ListAccessKeys // actions. // // The SecretAccessKey value is returned only in response to CreateAccessKey. // You can get a secret access key only when you first create an access key; // you cannot recover the secret access key later. If you lose a secret access // key, you must create a new access key. type AccessKey struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The ID for this access key. // // AccessKeyId is a required field AccessKeyId *string `min:"16" type:"string" required:"true"` // The date when the access key was created. CreateDate *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"` // The secret key used to sign requests. // // SecretAccessKey is a required field SecretAccessKey *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // The status of the access key. Active means the key is valid for API calls, // while Inactive means it is not. // // Status is a required field Status *string `type:"string" required:"true" enum:"statusType"` // The name of the IAM user that the access key is associated with. // // UserName is a required field UserName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s AccessKey) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s AccessKey) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetAccessKeyId sets the AccessKeyId field's value. func (s *AccessKey) SetAccessKeyId(v string) *AccessKey { s.AccessKeyId = &v return s } // SetCreateDate sets the CreateDate field's value. func (s *AccessKey) SetCreateDate(v time.Time) *AccessKey { s.CreateDate = &v return s } // SetSecretAccessKey sets the SecretAccessKey field's value. func (s *AccessKey) SetSecretAccessKey(v string) *AccessKey { s.SecretAccessKey = &v return s } // SetStatus sets the Status field's value. func (s *AccessKey) SetStatus(v string) *AccessKey { s.Status = &v return s } // SetUserName sets the UserName field's value. func (s *AccessKey) SetUserName(v string) *AccessKey { s.UserName = &v return s } // Contains information about the last time an AWS access key was used. // // This data type is used as a response element in the GetAccessKeyLastUsed // action. type AccessKeyLastUsed struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The date and time, in ISO 8601 date-time format (http://www.iso.org/iso/iso8601), // when the access key was most recently used. This field is null when: // // * The user does not have an access key. // // * An access key exists but has never been used, at least not since IAM // started tracking this information on April 22nd, 2015. // // * There is no sign-in data associated with the user // // LastUsedDate is a required field LastUsedDate *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601" required:"true"` // The AWS region where this access key was most recently used. This field is // displays "N/A" when: // // * The user does not have an access key. // // * An access key exists but has never been used, at least not since IAM // started tracking this information on April 22nd, 2015. // // * There is no sign-in data associated with the user // // For more information about AWS regions, see Regions and Endpoints (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/rande.html) // in the Amazon Web Services General Reference. // // Region is a required field Region *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // The name of the AWS service with which this access key was most recently // used. This field displays "N/A" when: // // * The user does not have an access key. // // * An access key exists but has never been used, at least not since IAM // started tracking this information on April 22nd, 2015. // // * There is no sign-in data associated with the user // // ServiceName is a required field ServiceName *string `type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s AccessKeyLastUsed) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s AccessKeyLastUsed) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetLastUsedDate sets the LastUsedDate field's value. func (s *AccessKeyLastUsed) SetLastUsedDate(v time.Time) *AccessKeyLastUsed { s.LastUsedDate = &v return s } // SetRegion sets the Region field's value. func (s *AccessKeyLastUsed) SetRegion(v string) *AccessKeyLastUsed { s.Region = &v return s } // SetServiceName sets the ServiceName field's value. func (s *AccessKeyLastUsed) SetServiceName(v string) *AccessKeyLastUsed { s.ServiceName = &v return s } // Contains information about an AWS access key, without its secret key. // // This data type is used as a response element in the ListAccessKeys action. type AccessKeyMetadata struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The ID for this access key. AccessKeyId *string `min:"16" type:"string"` // The date when the access key was created. CreateDate *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"` // The status of the access key. Active means the key is valid for API calls; // Inactive means it is not. Status *string `type:"string" enum:"statusType"` // The name of the IAM user that the key is associated with. UserName *string `min:"1" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s AccessKeyMetadata) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s AccessKeyMetadata) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetAccessKeyId sets the AccessKeyId field's value. func (s *AccessKeyMetadata) SetAccessKeyId(v string) *AccessKeyMetadata { s.AccessKeyId = &v return s } // SetCreateDate sets the CreateDate field's value. func (s *AccessKeyMetadata) SetCreateDate(v time.Time) *AccessKeyMetadata { s.CreateDate = &v return s } // SetStatus sets the Status field's value. func (s *AccessKeyMetadata) SetStatus(v string) *AccessKeyMetadata { s.Status = &v return s } // SetUserName sets the UserName field's value. func (s *AccessKeyMetadata) SetUserName(v string) *AccessKeyMetadata { s.UserName = &v return s } type AddClientIDToOpenIDConnectProviderInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The client ID (also known as audience) to add to the IAM OpenID Connect provider // resource. // // ClientID is a required field ClientID *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` // The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the IAM OpenID Connect (OIDC) provider // resource to add the client ID to. You can get a list of OIDC provider ARNs // by using the ListOpenIDConnectProviders action. // // OpenIDConnectProviderArn is a required field OpenIDConnectProviderArn *string `min:"20" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s AddClientIDToOpenIDConnectProviderInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s AddClientIDToOpenIDConnectProviderInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *AddClientIDToOpenIDConnectProviderInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "AddClientIDToOpenIDConnectProviderInput"} if s.ClientID == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ClientID")) } if s.ClientID != nil && len(*s.ClientID) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("ClientID", 1)) } if s.OpenIDConnectProviderArn == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("OpenIDConnectProviderArn")) } if s.OpenIDConnectProviderArn != nil && len(*s.OpenIDConnectProviderArn) < 20 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("OpenIDConnectProviderArn", 20)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetClientID sets the ClientID field's value. func (s *AddClientIDToOpenIDConnectProviderInput) SetClientID(v string) *AddClientIDToOpenIDConnectProviderInput { s.ClientID = &v return s } // SetOpenIDConnectProviderArn sets the OpenIDConnectProviderArn field's value. func (s *AddClientIDToOpenIDConnectProviderInput) SetOpenIDConnectProviderArn(v string) *AddClientIDToOpenIDConnectProviderInput { s.OpenIDConnectProviderArn = &v return s } type AddClientIDToOpenIDConnectProviderOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s AddClientIDToOpenIDConnectProviderOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s AddClientIDToOpenIDConnectProviderOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } type AddRoleToInstanceProfileInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name of the instance profile to update. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- // // InstanceProfileName is a required field InstanceProfileName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` // The name of the role to add. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@- // // RoleName is a required field RoleName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s AddRoleToInstanceProfileInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s AddRoleToInstanceProfileInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *AddRoleToInstanceProfileInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "AddRoleToInstanceProfileInput"} if s.InstanceProfileName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("InstanceProfileName")) } if s.InstanceProfileName != nil && len(*s.InstanceProfileName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("InstanceProfileName", 1)) } if s.RoleName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("RoleName")) } if s.RoleName != nil && len(*s.RoleName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("RoleName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetInstanceProfileName sets the InstanceProfileName field's value. func (s *AddRoleToInstanceProfileInput) SetInstanceProfileName(v string) *AddRoleToInstanceProfileInput { s.InstanceProfileName = &v return s } // SetRoleName sets the RoleName field's value. func (s *AddRoleToInstanceProfileInput) SetRoleName(v string) *AddRoleToInstanceProfileInput { s.RoleName = &v return s } type AddRoleToInstanceProfileOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s AddRoleToInstanceProfileOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s AddRoleToInstanceProfileOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } type AddUserToGroupInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name of the group to update. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- // // GroupName is a required field GroupName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` // The name of the user to add. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- // // UserName is a required field UserName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s AddUserToGroupInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s AddUserToGroupInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *AddUserToGroupInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "AddUserToGroupInput"} if s.GroupName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("GroupName")) } if s.GroupName != nil && len(*s.GroupName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("GroupName", 1)) } if s.UserName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("UserName")) } if s.UserName != nil && len(*s.UserName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("UserName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetGroupName sets the GroupName field's value. func (s *AddUserToGroupInput) SetGroupName(v string) *AddUserToGroupInput { s.GroupName = &v return s } // SetUserName sets the UserName field's value. func (s *AddUserToGroupInput) SetUserName(v string) *AddUserToGroupInput { s.UserName = &v return s } type AddUserToGroupOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s AddUserToGroupOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s AddUserToGroupOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } type AttachGroupPolicyInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name (friendly name, not ARN) of the group to attach the policy to. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- // // GroupName is a required field GroupName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` // The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the IAM policy you want to attach. // // For more information about ARNs, see Amazon Resource Names (ARNs) and AWS // Service Namespaces (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/aws-arns-and-namespaces.html) // in the AWS General Reference. // // PolicyArn is a required field PolicyArn *string `min:"20" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s AttachGroupPolicyInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s AttachGroupPolicyInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *AttachGroupPolicyInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "AttachGroupPolicyInput"} if s.GroupName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("GroupName")) } if s.GroupName != nil && len(*s.GroupName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("GroupName", 1)) } if s.PolicyArn == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("PolicyArn")) } if s.PolicyArn != nil && len(*s.PolicyArn) < 20 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("PolicyArn", 20)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetGroupName sets the GroupName field's value. func (s *AttachGroupPolicyInput) SetGroupName(v string) *AttachGroupPolicyInput { s.GroupName = &v return s } // SetPolicyArn sets the PolicyArn field's value. func (s *AttachGroupPolicyInput) SetPolicyArn(v string) *AttachGroupPolicyInput { s.PolicyArn = &v return s } type AttachGroupPolicyOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s AttachGroupPolicyOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s AttachGroupPolicyOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } type AttachRolePolicyInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the IAM policy you want to attach. // // For more information about ARNs, see Amazon Resource Names (ARNs) and AWS // Service Namespaces (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/aws-arns-and-namespaces.html) // in the AWS General Reference. // // PolicyArn is a required field PolicyArn *string `min:"20" type:"string" required:"true"` // The name (friendly name, not ARN) of the role to attach the policy to. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@- // // RoleName is a required field RoleName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s AttachRolePolicyInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s AttachRolePolicyInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *AttachRolePolicyInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "AttachRolePolicyInput"} if s.PolicyArn == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("PolicyArn")) } if s.PolicyArn != nil && len(*s.PolicyArn) < 20 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("PolicyArn", 20)) } if s.RoleName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("RoleName")) } if s.RoleName != nil && len(*s.RoleName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("RoleName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetPolicyArn sets the PolicyArn field's value. func (s *AttachRolePolicyInput) SetPolicyArn(v string) *AttachRolePolicyInput { s.PolicyArn = &v return s } // SetRoleName sets the RoleName field's value. func (s *AttachRolePolicyInput) SetRoleName(v string) *AttachRolePolicyInput { s.RoleName = &v return s } type AttachRolePolicyOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s AttachRolePolicyOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s AttachRolePolicyOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } type AttachUserPolicyInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the IAM policy you want to attach. // // For more information about ARNs, see Amazon Resource Names (ARNs) and AWS // Service Namespaces (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/aws-arns-and-namespaces.html) // in the AWS General Reference. // // PolicyArn is a required field PolicyArn *string `min:"20" type:"string" required:"true"` // The name (friendly name, not ARN) of the IAM user to attach the policy to. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- // // UserName is a required field UserName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s AttachUserPolicyInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s AttachUserPolicyInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *AttachUserPolicyInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "AttachUserPolicyInput"} if s.PolicyArn == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("PolicyArn")) } if s.PolicyArn != nil && len(*s.PolicyArn) < 20 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("PolicyArn", 20)) } if s.UserName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("UserName")) } if s.UserName != nil && len(*s.UserName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("UserName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetPolicyArn sets the PolicyArn field's value. func (s *AttachUserPolicyInput) SetPolicyArn(v string) *AttachUserPolicyInput { s.PolicyArn = &v return s } // SetUserName sets the UserName field's value. func (s *AttachUserPolicyInput) SetUserName(v string) *AttachUserPolicyInput { s.UserName = &v return s } type AttachUserPolicyOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s AttachUserPolicyOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s AttachUserPolicyOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Contains information about an attached policy. // // An attached policy is a managed policy that has been attached to a user, // group, or role. This data type is used as a response element in the ListAttachedGroupPolicies, // ListAttachedRolePolicies, ListAttachedUserPolicies, and GetAccountAuthorizationDetails // actions. // // For more information about managed policies, refer to Managed Policies and // Inline Policies (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) // in the Using IAM guide. type AttachedPolicy struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The Amazon Resource Name (ARN). ARNs are unique identifiers for AWS resources. // // For more information about ARNs, go to Amazon Resource Names (ARNs) and AWS // Service Namespaces (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/aws-arns-and-namespaces.html) // in the AWS General Reference. PolicyArn *string `min:"20" type:"string"` // The friendly name of the attached policy. PolicyName *string `min:"1" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s AttachedPolicy) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s AttachedPolicy) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetPolicyArn sets the PolicyArn field's value. func (s *AttachedPolicy) SetPolicyArn(v string) *AttachedPolicy { s.PolicyArn = &v return s } // SetPolicyName sets the PolicyName field's value. func (s *AttachedPolicy) SetPolicyName(v string) *AttachedPolicy { s.PolicyName = &v return s } type ChangePasswordInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The new password. The new password must conform to the AWS account's password // policy, if one exists. // // The regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex) used to validate this // parameter is a string of characters consisting of almost any printable ASCII // character from the space (\u0020) through the end of the ASCII character // range (\u00FF). You can also include the tab (\u0009), line feed (\u000A), // and carriage return (\u000D) characters. Although any of these characters // are valid in a password, note that many tools, such as the AWS Management // Console, might restrict the ability to enter certain characters because they // have special meaning within that tool. // // NewPassword is a required field NewPassword *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` // The IAM user's current password. // // OldPassword is a required field OldPassword *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ChangePasswordInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ChangePasswordInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *ChangePasswordInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ChangePasswordInput"} if s.NewPassword == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("NewPassword")) } if s.NewPassword != nil && len(*s.NewPassword) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("NewPassword", 1)) } if s.OldPassword == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("OldPassword")) } if s.OldPassword != nil && len(*s.OldPassword) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("OldPassword", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetNewPassword sets the NewPassword field's value. func (s *ChangePasswordInput) SetNewPassword(v string) *ChangePasswordInput { s.NewPassword = &v return s } // SetOldPassword sets the OldPassword field's value. func (s *ChangePasswordInput) SetOldPassword(v string) *ChangePasswordInput { s.OldPassword = &v return s } type ChangePasswordOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ChangePasswordOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ChangePasswordOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Contains information about a condition context key. It includes the name // of the key and specifies the value (or values, if the context key supports // multiple values) to use in the simulation. This information is used when // evaluating the Condition elements of the input policies. // // This data type is used as an input parameter to SimulateCustomPolicy and // SimulateCustomPolicy. type ContextEntry struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The full name of a condition context key, including the service prefix. For // example, aws:SourceIp or s3:VersionId. ContextKeyName *string `min:"5" type:"string"` // The data type of the value (or values) specified in the ContextKeyValues // parameter. ContextKeyType *string `type:"string" enum:"ContextKeyTypeEnum"` // The value (or values, if the condition context key supports multiple values) // to provide to the simulation for use when the key is referenced by a Condition // element in an input policy. ContextKeyValues []*string `type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ContextEntry) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ContextEntry) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *ContextEntry) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ContextEntry"} if s.ContextKeyName != nil && len(*s.ContextKeyName) < 5 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("ContextKeyName", 5)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetContextKeyName sets the ContextKeyName field's value. func (s *ContextEntry) SetContextKeyName(v string) *ContextEntry { s.ContextKeyName = &v return s } // SetContextKeyType sets the ContextKeyType field's value. func (s *ContextEntry) SetContextKeyType(v string) *ContextEntry { s.ContextKeyType = &v return s } // SetContextKeyValues sets the ContextKeyValues field's value. func (s *ContextEntry) SetContextKeyValues(v []*string) *ContextEntry { s.ContextKeyValues = v return s } type CreateAccessKeyInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name of the IAM user that the new key will belong to. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- UserName *string `min:"1" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CreateAccessKeyInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CreateAccessKeyInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *CreateAccessKeyInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateAccessKeyInput"} if s.UserName != nil && len(*s.UserName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("UserName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetUserName sets the UserName field's value. func (s *CreateAccessKeyInput) SetUserName(v string) *CreateAccessKeyInput { s.UserName = &v return s } // Contains the response to a successful CreateAccessKey request. type CreateAccessKeyOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A structure with details about the access key. // // AccessKey is a required field AccessKey *AccessKey `type:"structure" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CreateAccessKeyOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CreateAccessKeyOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetAccessKey sets the AccessKey field's value. func (s *CreateAccessKeyOutput) SetAccessKey(v *AccessKey) *CreateAccessKeyOutput { s.AccessKey = v return s } type CreateAccountAliasInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The account alias to create. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of lowercase letters, digits, and dashes. // You cannot start or finish with a dash, nor can you have two dashes in a // row. // // AccountAlias is a required field AccountAlias *string `min:"3" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CreateAccountAliasInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CreateAccountAliasInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *CreateAccountAliasInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateAccountAliasInput"} if s.AccountAlias == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("AccountAlias")) } if s.AccountAlias != nil && len(*s.AccountAlias) < 3 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("AccountAlias", 3)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetAccountAlias sets the AccountAlias field's value. func (s *CreateAccountAliasInput) SetAccountAlias(v string) *CreateAccountAliasInput { s.AccountAlias = &v return s } type CreateAccountAliasOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CreateAccountAliasOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CreateAccountAliasOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } type CreateGroupInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name of the group to create. Do not include the path in this value. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@-. // The group name must be unique within the account. Group names are not distinguished // by case. For example, you cannot create groups named both "ADMINS" and "admins". // // GroupName is a required field GroupName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` // The path to the group. For more information about paths, see IAM Identifiers // (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/Using_Identifiers.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // This parameter is optional. If it is not included, it defaults to a slash // (/). // // This paramater allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of either a forward slash (/) by itself // or a string that must begin and end with forward slashes, containing any // ASCII character from the ! (\u0021) thru the DEL character (\u007F), including // most punctuation characters, digits, and upper and lowercased letters. Path *string `min:"1" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CreateGroupInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CreateGroupInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *CreateGroupInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateGroupInput"} if s.GroupName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("GroupName")) } if s.GroupName != nil && len(*s.GroupName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("GroupName", 1)) } if s.Path != nil && len(*s.Path) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Path", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetGroupName sets the GroupName field's value. func (s *CreateGroupInput) SetGroupName(v string) *CreateGroupInput { s.GroupName = &v return s } // SetPath sets the Path field's value. func (s *CreateGroupInput) SetPath(v string) *CreateGroupInput { s.Path = &v return s } // Contains the response to a successful CreateGroup request. type CreateGroupOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A structure containing details about the new group. // // Group is a required field Group *Group `type:"structure" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CreateGroupOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CreateGroupOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetGroup sets the Group field's value. func (s *CreateGroupOutput) SetGroup(v *Group) *CreateGroupOutput { s.Group = v return s } type CreateInstanceProfileInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name of the instance profile to create. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- // // InstanceProfileName is a required field InstanceProfileName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` // The path to the instance profile. For more information about paths, see IAM // Identifiers (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/Using_Identifiers.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // This parameter is optional. If it is not included, it defaults to a slash // (/). // // This paramater allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of either a forward slash (/) by itself // or a string that must begin and end with forward slashes, containing any // ASCII character from the ! (\u0021) thru the DEL character (\u007F), including // most punctuation characters, digits, and upper and lowercased letters. Path *string `min:"1" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CreateInstanceProfileInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CreateInstanceProfileInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *CreateInstanceProfileInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateInstanceProfileInput"} if s.InstanceProfileName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("InstanceProfileName")) } if s.InstanceProfileName != nil && len(*s.InstanceProfileName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("InstanceProfileName", 1)) } if s.Path != nil && len(*s.Path) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Path", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetInstanceProfileName sets the InstanceProfileName field's value. func (s *CreateInstanceProfileInput) SetInstanceProfileName(v string) *CreateInstanceProfileInput { s.InstanceProfileName = &v return s } // SetPath sets the Path field's value. func (s *CreateInstanceProfileInput) SetPath(v string) *CreateInstanceProfileInput { s.Path = &v return s } // Contains the response to a successful CreateInstanceProfile request. type CreateInstanceProfileOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A structure containing details about the new instance profile. // // InstanceProfile is a required field InstanceProfile *InstanceProfile `type:"structure" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CreateInstanceProfileOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CreateInstanceProfileOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetInstanceProfile sets the InstanceProfile field's value. func (s *CreateInstanceProfileOutput) SetInstanceProfile(v *InstanceProfile) *CreateInstanceProfileOutput { s.InstanceProfile = v return s } type CreateLoginProfileInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The new password for the user. // // The regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex) used to validate this // parameter is a string of characters consisting of almost any printable ASCII // character from the space (\u0020) through the end of the ASCII character // range (\u00FF). You can also include the tab (\u0009), line feed (\u000A), // and carriage return (\u000D) characters. Although any of these characters // are valid in a password, note that many tools, such as the AWS Management // Console, might restrict the ability to enter certain characters because they // have special meaning within that tool. // // Password is a required field Password *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` // Specifies whether the user is required to set a new password on next sign-in. PasswordResetRequired *bool `type:"boolean"` // The name of the IAM user to create a password for. The user must already // exist. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- // // UserName is a required field UserName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CreateLoginProfileInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CreateLoginProfileInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *CreateLoginProfileInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateLoginProfileInput"} if s.Password == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Password")) } if s.Password != nil && len(*s.Password) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Password", 1)) } if s.UserName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("UserName")) } if s.UserName != nil && len(*s.UserName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("UserName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetPassword sets the Password field's value. func (s *CreateLoginProfileInput) SetPassword(v string) *CreateLoginProfileInput { s.Password = &v return s } // SetPasswordResetRequired sets the PasswordResetRequired field's value. func (s *CreateLoginProfileInput) SetPasswordResetRequired(v bool) *CreateLoginProfileInput { s.PasswordResetRequired = &v return s } // SetUserName sets the UserName field's value. func (s *CreateLoginProfileInput) SetUserName(v string) *CreateLoginProfileInput { s.UserName = &v return s } // Contains the response to a successful CreateLoginProfile request. type CreateLoginProfileOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A structure containing the user name and password create date. // // LoginProfile is a required field LoginProfile *LoginProfile `type:"structure" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CreateLoginProfileOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CreateLoginProfileOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetLoginProfile sets the LoginProfile field's value. func (s *CreateLoginProfileOutput) SetLoginProfile(v *LoginProfile) *CreateLoginProfileOutput { s.LoginProfile = v return s } type CreateOpenIDConnectProviderInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A list of client IDs (also known as audiences). When a mobile or web app // registers with an OpenID Connect provider, they establish a value that identifies // the application. (This is the value that's sent as the client_id parameter // on OAuth requests.) // // You can register multiple client IDs with the same provider. For example, // you might have multiple applications that use the same OIDC provider. You // cannot register more than 100 client IDs with a single IAM OIDC provider. // // There is no defined format for a client ID. The CreateOpenIDConnectProviderRequest // action accepts client IDs up to 255 characters long. ClientIDList []*string `type:"list"` // A list of server certificate thumbprints for the OpenID Connect (OIDC) identity // provider's server certificate(s). Typically this list includes only one entry. // However, IAM lets you have up to five thumbprints for an OIDC provider. This // lets you maintain multiple thumbprints if the identity provider is rotating // certificates. // // The server certificate thumbprint is the hex-encoded SHA-1 hash value of // the X.509 certificate used by the domain where the OpenID Connect provider // makes its keys available. It is always a 40-character string. // // You must provide at least one thumbprint when creating an IAM OIDC provider. // For example, if the OIDC provider is server.example.com and the provider // stores its keys at "https://keys.server.example.com/openid-connect", the // thumbprint string would be the hex-encoded SHA-1 hash value of the certificate // used by https://keys.server.example.com. // // For more information about obtaining the OIDC provider's thumbprint, see // Obtaining the Thumbprint for an OpenID Connect Provider (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/identity-providers-oidc-obtain-thumbprint.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // ThumbprintList is a required field ThumbprintList []*string `type:"list" required:"true"` // The URL of the identity provider. The URL must begin with "https://" and // should correspond to the iss claim in the provider's OpenID Connect ID tokens. // Per the OIDC standard, path components are allowed but query parameters are // not. Typically the URL consists of only a host name, like "https://server.example.org" // or "https://example.com". // // You cannot register the same provider multiple times in a single AWS account. // If you try to submit a URL that has already been used for an OpenID Connect // provider in the AWS account, you will get an error. // // Url is a required field Url *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CreateOpenIDConnectProviderInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CreateOpenIDConnectProviderInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *CreateOpenIDConnectProviderInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateOpenIDConnectProviderInput"} if s.ThumbprintList == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ThumbprintList")) } if s.Url == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Url")) } if s.Url != nil && len(*s.Url) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Url", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetClientIDList sets the ClientIDList field's value. func (s *CreateOpenIDConnectProviderInput) SetClientIDList(v []*string) *CreateOpenIDConnectProviderInput { s.ClientIDList = v return s } // SetThumbprintList sets the ThumbprintList field's value. func (s *CreateOpenIDConnectProviderInput) SetThumbprintList(v []*string) *CreateOpenIDConnectProviderInput { s.ThumbprintList = v return s } // SetUrl sets the Url field's value. func (s *CreateOpenIDConnectProviderInput) SetUrl(v string) *CreateOpenIDConnectProviderInput { s.Url = &v return s } // Contains the response to a successful CreateOpenIDConnectProvider request. type CreateOpenIDConnectProviderOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the new IAM OpenID Connect provider that // is created. For more information, see OpenIDConnectProviderListEntry. OpenIDConnectProviderArn *string `min:"20" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CreateOpenIDConnectProviderOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CreateOpenIDConnectProviderOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetOpenIDConnectProviderArn sets the OpenIDConnectProviderArn field's value. func (s *CreateOpenIDConnectProviderOutput) SetOpenIDConnectProviderArn(v string) *CreateOpenIDConnectProviderOutput { s.OpenIDConnectProviderArn = &v return s } type CreatePolicyInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A friendly description of the policy. // // Typically used to store information about the permissions defined in the // policy. For example, "Grants access to production DynamoDB tables." // // The policy description is immutable. After a value is assigned, it cannot // be changed. Description *string `type:"string"` // The path for the policy. // // For more information about paths, see IAM Identifiers (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/Using_Identifiers.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // This parameter is optional. If it is not included, it defaults to a slash // (/). // // This paramater allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of either a forward slash (/) by itself // or a string that must begin and end with forward slashes, containing any // ASCII character from the ! (\u0021) thru the DEL character (\u007F), including // most punctuation characters, digits, and upper and lowercased letters. Path *string `type:"string"` // The JSON policy document that you want to use as the content for the new // policy. // // The regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex) used to validate this // parameter is a string of characters consisting of any printable ASCII character // ranging from the space character (\u0020) through end of the ASCII character // range as well as the printable characters in the Basic Latin and Latin-1 // Supplement character set (through \u00FF). It also includes the special characters // tab (\u0009), line feed (\u000A), and carriage return (\u000D). // // PolicyDocument is a required field PolicyDocument *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` // The friendly name of the policy. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@-+ // // PolicyName is a required field PolicyName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CreatePolicyInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CreatePolicyInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *CreatePolicyInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreatePolicyInput"} if s.PolicyDocument == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("PolicyDocument")) } if s.PolicyDocument != nil && len(*s.PolicyDocument) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("PolicyDocument", 1)) } if s.PolicyName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("PolicyName")) } if s.PolicyName != nil && len(*s.PolicyName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("PolicyName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetDescription sets the Description field's value. func (s *CreatePolicyInput) SetDescription(v string) *CreatePolicyInput { s.Description = &v return s } // SetPath sets the Path field's value. func (s *CreatePolicyInput) SetPath(v string) *CreatePolicyInput { s.Path = &v return s } // SetPolicyDocument sets the PolicyDocument field's value. func (s *CreatePolicyInput) SetPolicyDocument(v string) *CreatePolicyInput { s.PolicyDocument = &v return s } // SetPolicyName sets the PolicyName field's value. func (s *CreatePolicyInput) SetPolicyName(v string) *CreatePolicyInput { s.PolicyName = &v return s } // Contains the response to a successful CreatePolicy request. type CreatePolicyOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A structure containing details about the new policy. Policy *Policy `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CreatePolicyOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CreatePolicyOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetPolicy sets the Policy field's value. func (s *CreatePolicyOutput) SetPolicy(v *Policy) *CreatePolicyOutput { s.Policy = v return s } type CreatePolicyVersionInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the IAM policy to which you want to add // a new version. // // For more information about ARNs, see Amazon Resource Names (ARNs) and AWS // Service Namespaces (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/aws-arns-and-namespaces.html) // in the AWS General Reference. // // PolicyArn is a required field PolicyArn *string `min:"20" type:"string" required:"true"` // The JSON policy document that you want to use as the content for this new // version of the policy. // // The regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex) used to validate this // parameter is a string of characters consisting of any printable ASCII character // ranging from the space character (\u0020) through end of the ASCII character // range as well as the printable characters in the Basic Latin and Latin-1 // Supplement character set (through \u00FF). It also includes the special characters // tab (\u0009), line feed (\u000A), and carriage return (\u000D). // // PolicyDocument is a required field PolicyDocument *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` // Specifies whether to set this version as the policy's default version. // // When this parameter is true, the new policy version becomes the operative // version; that is, the version that is in effect for the IAM users, groups, // and roles that the policy is attached to. // // For more information about managed policy versions, see Versioning for Managed // Policies (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-versions.html) // in the IAM User Guide. SetAsDefault *bool `type:"boolean"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CreatePolicyVersionInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CreatePolicyVersionInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *CreatePolicyVersionInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreatePolicyVersionInput"} if s.PolicyArn == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("PolicyArn")) } if s.PolicyArn != nil && len(*s.PolicyArn) < 20 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("PolicyArn", 20)) } if s.PolicyDocument == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("PolicyDocument")) } if s.PolicyDocument != nil && len(*s.PolicyDocument) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("PolicyDocument", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetPolicyArn sets the PolicyArn field's value. func (s *CreatePolicyVersionInput) SetPolicyArn(v string) *CreatePolicyVersionInput { s.PolicyArn = &v return s } // SetPolicyDocument sets the PolicyDocument field's value. func (s *CreatePolicyVersionInput) SetPolicyDocument(v string) *CreatePolicyVersionInput { s.PolicyDocument = &v return s } // SetSetAsDefault sets the SetAsDefault field's value. func (s *CreatePolicyVersionInput) SetSetAsDefault(v bool) *CreatePolicyVersionInput { s.SetAsDefault = &v return s } // Contains the response to a successful CreatePolicyVersion request. type CreatePolicyVersionOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A structure containing details about the new policy version. PolicyVersion *PolicyVersion `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CreatePolicyVersionOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CreatePolicyVersionOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetPolicyVersion sets the PolicyVersion field's value. func (s *CreatePolicyVersionOutput) SetPolicyVersion(v *PolicyVersion) *CreatePolicyVersionOutput { s.PolicyVersion = v return s } type CreateRoleInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The trust relationship policy document that grants an entity permission to // assume the role. // // The regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex) used to validate this // parameter is a string of characters consisting of any printable ASCII character // ranging from the space character (\u0020) through end of the ASCII character // range as well as the printable characters in the Basic Latin and Latin-1 // Supplement character set (through \u00FF). It also includes the special characters // tab (\u0009), line feed (\u000A), and carriage return (\u000D). // // AssumeRolePolicyDocument is a required field AssumeRolePolicyDocument *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` // A customer-provided description of the role. Description *string `type:"string"` // The path to the role. For more information about paths, see IAM Identifiers // (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/Using_Identifiers.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // This parameter is optional. If it is not included, it defaults to a slash // (/). // // This paramater allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of either a forward slash (/) by itself // or a string that must begin and end with forward slashes, containing any // ASCII character from the ! (\u0021) thru the DEL character (\u007F), including // most punctuation characters, digits, and upper and lowercased letters. Path *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // The name of the role to create. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@- // // Role names are not distinguished by case. For example, you cannot create // roles named both "PRODROLE" and "prodrole". // // RoleName is a required field RoleName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CreateRoleInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CreateRoleInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *CreateRoleInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateRoleInput"} if s.AssumeRolePolicyDocument == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("AssumeRolePolicyDocument")) } if s.AssumeRolePolicyDocument != nil && len(*s.AssumeRolePolicyDocument) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("AssumeRolePolicyDocument", 1)) } if s.Path != nil && len(*s.Path) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Path", 1)) } if s.RoleName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("RoleName")) } if s.RoleName != nil && len(*s.RoleName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("RoleName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetAssumeRolePolicyDocument sets the AssumeRolePolicyDocument field's value. func (s *CreateRoleInput) SetAssumeRolePolicyDocument(v string) *CreateRoleInput { s.AssumeRolePolicyDocument = &v return s } // SetDescription sets the Description field's value. func (s *CreateRoleInput) SetDescription(v string) *CreateRoleInput { s.Description = &v return s } // SetPath sets the Path field's value. func (s *CreateRoleInput) SetPath(v string) *CreateRoleInput { s.Path = &v return s } // SetRoleName sets the RoleName field's value. func (s *CreateRoleInput) SetRoleName(v string) *CreateRoleInput { s.RoleName = &v return s } // Contains the response to a successful CreateRole request. type CreateRoleOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A structure containing details about the new role. // // Role is a required field Role *Role `type:"structure" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CreateRoleOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CreateRoleOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetRole sets the Role field's value. func (s *CreateRoleOutput) SetRole(v *Role) *CreateRoleOutput { s.Role = v return s } type CreateSAMLProviderInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name of the provider to create. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- // // Name is a required field Name *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` // An XML document generated by an identity provider (IdP) that supports SAML // 2.0. The document includes the issuer's name, expiration information, and // keys that can be used to validate the SAML authentication response (assertions) // that are received from the IdP. You must generate the metadata document using // the identity management software that is used as your organization's IdP. // // For more information, see About SAML 2.0-based Federation (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/id_roles_providers_saml.html) // in the IAM User Guide // // SAMLMetadataDocument is a required field SAMLMetadataDocument *string `min:"1000" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CreateSAMLProviderInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CreateSAMLProviderInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *CreateSAMLProviderInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateSAMLProviderInput"} if s.Name == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Name")) } if s.Name != nil && len(*s.Name) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Name", 1)) } if s.SAMLMetadataDocument == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SAMLMetadataDocument")) } if s.SAMLMetadataDocument != nil && len(*s.SAMLMetadataDocument) < 1000 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("SAMLMetadataDocument", 1000)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetName sets the Name field's value. func (s *CreateSAMLProviderInput) SetName(v string) *CreateSAMLProviderInput { s.Name = &v return s } // SetSAMLMetadataDocument sets the SAMLMetadataDocument field's value. func (s *CreateSAMLProviderInput) SetSAMLMetadataDocument(v string) *CreateSAMLProviderInput { s.SAMLMetadataDocument = &v return s } // Contains the response to a successful CreateSAMLProvider request. type CreateSAMLProviderOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the new SAML provider resource in IAM. SAMLProviderArn *string `min:"20" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CreateSAMLProviderOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CreateSAMLProviderOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetSAMLProviderArn sets the SAMLProviderArn field's value. func (s *CreateSAMLProviderOutput) SetSAMLProviderArn(v string) *CreateSAMLProviderOutput { s.SAMLProviderArn = &v return s } type CreateServiceLinkedRoleInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The AWS service to which this role is attached. You use a string similar // to a URL but without the http:// in front. For example: elasticbeanstalk.amazonaws.com // // AWSServiceName is a required field AWSServiceName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` // A string that you provide, which is combined with the service name to form // the complete role name. If you make multiple requests for the same service, // then you must supply a different CustomSuffix for each request. Otherwise // the request fails with a duplicate role name error. For example, you could // add -1 or -debug to the suffix. CustomSuffix *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // The description of the role. Description *string `type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CreateServiceLinkedRoleInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CreateServiceLinkedRoleInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *CreateServiceLinkedRoleInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateServiceLinkedRoleInput"} if s.AWSServiceName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("AWSServiceName")) } if s.AWSServiceName != nil && len(*s.AWSServiceName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("AWSServiceName", 1)) } if s.CustomSuffix != nil && len(*s.CustomSuffix) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("CustomSuffix", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetAWSServiceName sets the AWSServiceName field's value. func (s *CreateServiceLinkedRoleInput) SetAWSServiceName(v string) *CreateServiceLinkedRoleInput { s.AWSServiceName = &v return s } // SetCustomSuffix sets the CustomSuffix field's value. func (s *CreateServiceLinkedRoleInput) SetCustomSuffix(v string) *CreateServiceLinkedRoleInput { s.CustomSuffix = &v return s } // SetDescription sets the Description field's value. func (s *CreateServiceLinkedRoleInput) SetDescription(v string) *CreateServiceLinkedRoleInput { s.Description = &v return s } type CreateServiceLinkedRoleOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A Role object that contains details about the newly created role. Role *Role `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CreateServiceLinkedRoleOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CreateServiceLinkedRoleOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetRole sets the Role field's value. func (s *CreateServiceLinkedRoleOutput) SetRole(v *Role) *CreateServiceLinkedRoleOutput { s.Role = v return s } type CreateServiceSpecificCredentialInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name of the AWS service that is to be associated with the credentials. // The service you specify here is the only service that can be accessed using // these credentials. // // ServiceName is a required field ServiceName *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // The name of the IAM user that is to be associated with the credentials. The // new service-specific credentials have the same permissions as the associated // user except that they can be used only to access the specified service. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- // // UserName is a required field UserName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CreateServiceSpecificCredentialInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CreateServiceSpecificCredentialInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *CreateServiceSpecificCredentialInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateServiceSpecificCredentialInput"} if s.ServiceName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ServiceName")) } if s.UserName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("UserName")) } if s.UserName != nil && len(*s.UserName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("UserName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetServiceName sets the ServiceName field's value. func (s *CreateServiceSpecificCredentialInput) SetServiceName(v string) *CreateServiceSpecificCredentialInput { s.ServiceName = &v return s } // SetUserName sets the UserName field's value. func (s *CreateServiceSpecificCredentialInput) SetUserName(v string) *CreateServiceSpecificCredentialInput { s.UserName = &v return s } type CreateServiceSpecificCredentialOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A structure that contains information about the newly created service-specific // credential. // // This is the only time that the password for this credential set is available. // It cannot be recovered later. Instead, you will have to reset the password // with ResetServiceSpecificCredential. ServiceSpecificCredential *ServiceSpecificCredential `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CreateServiceSpecificCredentialOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CreateServiceSpecificCredentialOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetServiceSpecificCredential sets the ServiceSpecificCredential field's value. func (s *CreateServiceSpecificCredentialOutput) SetServiceSpecificCredential(v *ServiceSpecificCredential) *CreateServiceSpecificCredentialOutput { s.ServiceSpecificCredential = v return s } type CreateUserInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The path for the user name. For more information about paths, see IAM Identifiers // (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/Using_Identifiers.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // This parameter is optional. If it is not included, it defaults to a slash // (/). // // This paramater allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of either a forward slash (/) by itself // or a string that must begin and end with forward slashes, containing any // ASCII character from the ! (\u0021) thru the DEL character (\u007F), including // most punctuation characters, digits, and upper and lowercased letters. Path *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // The name of the user to create. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@-. // User names are not distinguished by case. For example, you cannot create // users named both "TESTUSER" and "testuser". // // UserName is a required field UserName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CreateUserInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CreateUserInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *CreateUserInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateUserInput"} if s.Path != nil && len(*s.Path) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Path", 1)) } if s.UserName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("UserName")) } if s.UserName != nil && len(*s.UserName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("UserName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetPath sets the Path field's value. func (s *CreateUserInput) SetPath(v string) *CreateUserInput { s.Path = &v return s } // SetUserName sets the UserName field's value. func (s *CreateUserInput) SetUserName(v string) *CreateUserInput { s.UserName = &v return s } // Contains the response to a successful CreateUser request. type CreateUserOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A structure with details about the new IAM user. User *User `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CreateUserOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CreateUserOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetUser sets the User field's value. func (s *CreateUserOutput) SetUser(v *User) *CreateUserOutput { s.User = v return s } type CreateVirtualMFADeviceInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The path for the virtual MFA device. For more information about paths, see // IAM Identifiers (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/Using_Identifiers.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // This parameter is optional. If it is not included, it defaults to a slash // (/). // // This paramater allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of either a forward slash (/) by itself // or a string that must begin and end with forward slashes, containing any // ASCII character from the ! (\u0021) thru the DEL character (\u007F), including // most punctuation characters, digits, and upper and lowercased letters. Path *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // The name of the virtual MFA device. Use with path to uniquely identify a // virtual MFA device. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- // // VirtualMFADeviceName is a required field VirtualMFADeviceName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CreateVirtualMFADeviceInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CreateVirtualMFADeviceInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *CreateVirtualMFADeviceInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateVirtualMFADeviceInput"} if s.Path != nil && len(*s.Path) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Path", 1)) } if s.VirtualMFADeviceName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("VirtualMFADeviceName")) } if s.VirtualMFADeviceName != nil && len(*s.VirtualMFADeviceName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("VirtualMFADeviceName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetPath sets the Path field's value. func (s *CreateVirtualMFADeviceInput) SetPath(v string) *CreateVirtualMFADeviceInput { s.Path = &v return s } // SetVirtualMFADeviceName sets the VirtualMFADeviceName field's value. func (s *CreateVirtualMFADeviceInput) SetVirtualMFADeviceName(v string) *CreateVirtualMFADeviceInput { s.VirtualMFADeviceName = &v return s } // Contains the response to a successful CreateVirtualMFADevice request. type CreateVirtualMFADeviceOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A structure containing details about the new virtual MFA device. // // VirtualMFADevice is a required field VirtualMFADevice *VirtualMFADevice `type:"structure" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CreateVirtualMFADeviceOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CreateVirtualMFADeviceOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetVirtualMFADevice sets the VirtualMFADevice field's value. func (s *CreateVirtualMFADeviceOutput) SetVirtualMFADevice(v *VirtualMFADevice) *CreateVirtualMFADeviceOutput { s.VirtualMFADevice = v return s } type DeactivateMFADeviceInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The serial number that uniquely identifies the MFA device. For virtual MFA // devices, the serial number is the device ARN. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@:/- // // SerialNumber is a required field SerialNumber *string `min:"9" type:"string" required:"true"` // The name of the user whose MFA device you want to deactivate. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- // // UserName is a required field UserName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeactivateMFADeviceInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeactivateMFADeviceInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *DeactivateMFADeviceInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeactivateMFADeviceInput"} if s.SerialNumber == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SerialNumber")) } if s.SerialNumber != nil && len(*s.SerialNumber) < 9 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("SerialNumber", 9)) } if s.UserName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("UserName")) } if s.UserName != nil && len(*s.UserName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("UserName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetSerialNumber sets the SerialNumber field's value. func (s *DeactivateMFADeviceInput) SetSerialNumber(v string) *DeactivateMFADeviceInput { s.SerialNumber = &v return s } // SetUserName sets the UserName field's value. func (s *DeactivateMFADeviceInput) SetUserName(v string) *DeactivateMFADeviceInput { s.UserName = &v return s } type DeactivateMFADeviceOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeactivateMFADeviceOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeactivateMFADeviceOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } type DeleteAccessKeyInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The access key ID for the access key ID and secret access key you want to // delete. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters that can consist of any upper or lowercased letter // or digit. // // AccessKeyId is a required field AccessKeyId *string `min:"16" type:"string" required:"true"` // The name of the user whose access key pair you want to delete. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- UserName *string `min:"1" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteAccessKeyInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteAccessKeyInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *DeleteAccessKeyInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteAccessKeyInput"} if s.AccessKeyId == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("AccessKeyId")) } if s.AccessKeyId != nil && len(*s.AccessKeyId) < 16 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("AccessKeyId", 16)) } if s.UserName != nil && len(*s.UserName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("UserName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetAccessKeyId sets the AccessKeyId field's value. func (s *DeleteAccessKeyInput) SetAccessKeyId(v string) *DeleteAccessKeyInput { s.AccessKeyId = &v return s } // SetUserName sets the UserName field's value. func (s *DeleteAccessKeyInput) SetUserName(v string) *DeleteAccessKeyInput { s.UserName = &v return s } type DeleteAccessKeyOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteAccessKeyOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteAccessKeyOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } type DeleteAccountAliasInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name of the account alias to delete. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of lowercase letters, digits, and dashes. // You cannot start or finish with a dash, nor can you have two dashes in a // row. // // AccountAlias is a required field AccountAlias *string `min:"3" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteAccountAliasInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteAccountAliasInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *DeleteAccountAliasInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteAccountAliasInput"} if s.AccountAlias == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("AccountAlias")) } if s.AccountAlias != nil && len(*s.AccountAlias) < 3 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("AccountAlias", 3)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetAccountAlias sets the AccountAlias field's value. func (s *DeleteAccountAliasInput) SetAccountAlias(v string) *DeleteAccountAliasInput { s.AccountAlias = &v return s } type DeleteAccountAliasOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteAccountAliasOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteAccountAliasOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } type DeleteAccountPasswordPolicyInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteAccountPasswordPolicyInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteAccountPasswordPolicyInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } type DeleteAccountPasswordPolicyOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteAccountPasswordPolicyOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteAccountPasswordPolicyOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } type DeleteGroupInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name of the IAM group to delete. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- // // GroupName is a required field GroupName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteGroupInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteGroupInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *DeleteGroupInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteGroupInput"} if s.GroupName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("GroupName")) } if s.GroupName != nil && len(*s.GroupName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("GroupName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetGroupName sets the GroupName field's value. func (s *DeleteGroupInput) SetGroupName(v string) *DeleteGroupInput { s.GroupName = &v return s } type DeleteGroupOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteGroupOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteGroupOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } type DeleteGroupPolicyInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name (friendly name, not ARN) identifying the group that the policy is // embedded in. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- // // GroupName is a required field GroupName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` // The name identifying the policy document to delete. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@-+ // // PolicyName is a required field PolicyName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteGroupPolicyInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteGroupPolicyInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *DeleteGroupPolicyInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteGroupPolicyInput"} if s.GroupName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("GroupName")) } if s.GroupName != nil && len(*s.GroupName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("GroupName", 1)) } if s.PolicyName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("PolicyName")) } if s.PolicyName != nil && len(*s.PolicyName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("PolicyName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetGroupName sets the GroupName field's value. func (s *DeleteGroupPolicyInput) SetGroupName(v string) *DeleteGroupPolicyInput { s.GroupName = &v return s } // SetPolicyName sets the PolicyName field's value. func (s *DeleteGroupPolicyInput) SetPolicyName(v string) *DeleteGroupPolicyInput { s.PolicyName = &v return s } type DeleteGroupPolicyOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteGroupPolicyOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteGroupPolicyOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } type DeleteInstanceProfileInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name of the instance profile to delete. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- // // InstanceProfileName is a required field InstanceProfileName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteInstanceProfileInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteInstanceProfileInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *DeleteInstanceProfileInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteInstanceProfileInput"} if s.InstanceProfileName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("InstanceProfileName")) } if s.InstanceProfileName != nil && len(*s.InstanceProfileName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("InstanceProfileName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetInstanceProfileName sets the InstanceProfileName field's value. func (s *DeleteInstanceProfileInput) SetInstanceProfileName(v string) *DeleteInstanceProfileInput { s.InstanceProfileName = &v return s } type DeleteInstanceProfileOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteInstanceProfileOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteInstanceProfileOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } type DeleteLoginProfileInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name of the user whose password you want to delete. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- // // UserName is a required field UserName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteLoginProfileInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteLoginProfileInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *DeleteLoginProfileInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteLoginProfileInput"} if s.UserName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("UserName")) } if s.UserName != nil && len(*s.UserName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("UserName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetUserName sets the UserName field's value. func (s *DeleteLoginProfileInput) SetUserName(v string) *DeleteLoginProfileInput { s.UserName = &v return s } type DeleteLoginProfileOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteLoginProfileOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteLoginProfileOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } type DeleteOpenIDConnectProviderInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the IAM OpenID Connect provider resource // object to delete. You can get a list of OpenID Connect provider resource // ARNs by using the ListOpenIDConnectProviders action. // // OpenIDConnectProviderArn is a required field OpenIDConnectProviderArn *string `min:"20" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteOpenIDConnectProviderInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteOpenIDConnectProviderInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *DeleteOpenIDConnectProviderInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteOpenIDConnectProviderInput"} if s.OpenIDConnectProviderArn == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("OpenIDConnectProviderArn")) } if s.OpenIDConnectProviderArn != nil && len(*s.OpenIDConnectProviderArn) < 20 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("OpenIDConnectProviderArn", 20)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetOpenIDConnectProviderArn sets the OpenIDConnectProviderArn field's value. func (s *DeleteOpenIDConnectProviderInput) SetOpenIDConnectProviderArn(v string) *DeleteOpenIDConnectProviderInput { s.OpenIDConnectProviderArn = &v return s } type DeleteOpenIDConnectProviderOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteOpenIDConnectProviderOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteOpenIDConnectProviderOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } type DeletePolicyInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the IAM policy you want to delete. // // For more information about ARNs, see Amazon Resource Names (ARNs) and AWS // Service Namespaces (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/aws-arns-and-namespaces.html) // in the AWS General Reference. // // PolicyArn is a required field PolicyArn *string `min:"20" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeletePolicyInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeletePolicyInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *DeletePolicyInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeletePolicyInput"} if s.PolicyArn == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("PolicyArn")) } if s.PolicyArn != nil && len(*s.PolicyArn) < 20 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("PolicyArn", 20)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetPolicyArn sets the PolicyArn field's value. func (s *DeletePolicyInput) SetPolicyArn(v string) *DeletePolicyInput { s.PolicyArn = &v return s } type DeletePolicyOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeletePolicyOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeletePolicyOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } type DeletePolicyVersionInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the IAM policy from which you want to delete // a version. // // For more information about ARNs, see Amazon Resource Names (ARNs) and AWS // Service Namespaces (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/aws-arns-and-namespaces.html) // in the AWS General Reference. // // PolicyArn is a required field PolicyArn *string `min:"20" type:"string" required:"true"` // The policy version to delete. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters that consists of the lowercase letter 'v' followed // by one or two digits, and optionally followed by a period '.' and a string // of letters and digits. // // For more information about managed policy versions, see Versioning for Managed // Policies (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-versions.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // VersionId is a required field VersionId *string `type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeletePolicyVersionInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeletePolicyVersionInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *DeletePolicyVersionInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeletePolicyVersionInput"} if s.PolicyArn == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("PolicyArn")) } if s.PolicyArn != nil && len(*s.PolicyArn) < 20 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("PolicyArn", 20)) } if s.VersionId == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("VersionId")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetPolicyArn sets the PolicyArn field's value. func (s *DeletePolicyVersionInput) SetPolicyArn(v string) *DeletePolicyVersionInput { s.PolicyArn = &v return s } // SetVersionId sets the VersionId field's value. func (s *DeletePolicyVersionInput) SetVersionId(v string) *DeletePolicyVersionInput { s.VersionId = &v return s } type DeletePolicyVersionOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeletePolicyVersionOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeletePolicyVersionOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } type DeleteRoleInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name of the role to delete. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@- // // RoleName is a required field RoleName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteRoleInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteRoleInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *DeleteRoleInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteRoleInput"} if s.RoleName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("RoleName")) } if s.RoleName != nil && len(*s.RoleName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("RoleName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetRoleName sets the RoleName field's value. func (s *DeleteRoleInput) SetRoleName(v string) *DeleteRoleInput { s.RoleName = &v return s } type DeleteRoleOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteRoleOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteRoleOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } type DeleteRolePolicyInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name of the inline policy to delete from the specified IAM role. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@-+ // // PolicyName is a required field PolicyName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` // The name (friendly name, not ARN) identifying the role that the policy is // embedded in. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@- // // RoleName is a required field RoleName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteRolePolicyInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteRolePolicyInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *DeleteRolePolicyInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteRolePolicyInput"} if s.PolicyName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("PolicyName")) } if s.PolicyName != nil && len(*s.PolicyName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("PolicyName", 1)) } if s.RoleName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("RoleName")) } if s.RoleName != nil && len(*s.RoleName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("RoleName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetPolicyName sets the PolicyName field's value. func (s *DeleteRolePolicyInput) SetPolicyName(v string) *DeleteRolePolicyInput { s.PolicyName = &v return s } // SetRoleName sets the RoleName field's value. func (s *DeleteRolePolicyInput) SetRoleName(v string) *DeleteRolePolicyInput { s.RoleName = &v return s } type DeleteRolePolicyOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteRolePolicyOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteRolePolicyOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } type DeleteSAMLProviderInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the SAML provider to delete. // // SAMLProviderArn is a required field SAMLProviderArn *string `min:"20" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteSAMLProviderInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteSAMLProviderInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *DeleteSAMLProviderInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteSAMLProviderInput"} if s.SAMLProviderArn == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SAMLProviderArn")) } if s.SAMLProviderArn != nil && len(*s.SAMLProviderArn) < 20 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("SAMLProviderArn", 20)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetSAMLProviderArn sets the SAMLProviderArn field's value. func (s *DeleteSAMLProviderInput) SetSAMLProviderArn(v string) *DeleteSAMLProviderInput { s.SAMLProviderArn = &v return s } type DeleteSAMLProviderOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteSAMLProviderOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteSAMLProviderOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } type DeleteSSHPublicKeyInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The unique identifier for the SSH public key. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters that can consist of any upper or lowercased letter // or digit. // // SSHPublicKeyId is a required field SSHPublicKeyId *string `min:"20" type:"string" required:"true"` // The name of the IAM user associated with the SSH public key. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- // // UserName is a required field UserName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteSSHPublicKeyInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteSSHPublicKeyInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *DeleteSSHPublicKeyInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteSSHPublicKeyInput"} if s.SSHPublicKeyId == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SSHPublicKeyId")) } if s.SSHPublicKeyId != nil && len(*s.SSHPublicKeyId) < 20 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("SSHPublicKeyId", 20)) } if s.UserName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("UserName")) } if s.UserName != nil && len(*s.UserName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("UserName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetSSHPublicKeyId sets the SSHPublicKeyId field's value. func (s *DeleteSSHPublicKeyInput) SetSSHPublicKeyId(v string) *DeleteSSHPublicKeyInput { s.SSHPublicKeyId = &v return s } // SetUserName sets the UserName field's value. func (s *DeleteSSHPublicKeyInput) SetUserName(v string) *DeleteSSHPublicKeyInput { s.UserName = &v return s } type DeleteSSHPublicKeyOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteSSHPublicKeyOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteSSHPublicKeyOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } type DeleteServerCertificateInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name of the server certificate you want to delete. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- // // ServerCertificateName is a required field ServerCertificateName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteServerCertificateInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteServerCertificateInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *DeleteServerCertificateInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteServerCertificateInput"} if s.ServerCertificateName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ServerCertificateName")) } if s.ServerCertificateName != nil && len(*s.ServerCertificateName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("ServerCertificateName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetServerCertificateName sets the ServerCertificateName field's value. func (s *DeleteServerCertificateInput) SetServerCertificateName(v string) *DeleteServerCertificateInput { s.ServerCertificateName = &v return s } type DeleteServerCertificateOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteServerCertificateOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteServerCertificateOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } type DeleteServiceLinkedRoleInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name of the service-linked role to be deleted. // // RoleName is a required field RoleName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteServiceLinkedRoleInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteServiceLinkedRoleInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *DeleteServiceLinkedRoleInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteServiceLinkedRoleInput"} if s.RoleName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("RoleName")) } if s.RoleName != nil && len(*s.RoleName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("RoleName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetRoleName sets the RoleName field's value. func (s *DeleteServiceLinkedRoleInput) SetRoleName(v string) *DeleteServiceLinkedRoleInput { s.RoleName = &v return s } type DeleteServiceLinkedRoleOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The deletion task identifier that you can use to check the status of the // deletion. This identifier is returned in the format task/aws-service-role///. // // DeletionTaskId is a required field DeletionTaskId *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteServiceLinkedRoleOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteServiceLinkedRoleOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetDeletionTaskId sets the DeletionTaskId field's value. func (s *DeleteServiceLinkedRoleOutput) SetDeletionTaskId(v string) *DeleteServiceLinkedRoleOutput { s.DeletionTaskId = &v return s } type DeleteServiceSpecificCredentialInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The unique identifier of the service-specific credential. You can get this // value by calling ListServiceSpecificCredentials. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters that can consist of any upper or lowercased letter // or digit. // // ServiceSpecificCredentialId is a required field ServiceSpecificCredentialId *string `min:"20" type:"string" required:"true"` // The name of the IAM user associated with the service-specific credential. // If this value is not specified, then the operation assumes the user whose // credentials are used to call the operation. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- UserName *string `min:"1" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteServiceSpecificCredentialInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteServiceSpecificCredentialInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *DeleteServiceSpecificCredentialInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteServiceSpecificCredentialInput"} if s.ServiceSpecificCredentialId == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ServiceSpecificCredentialId")) } if s.ServiceSpecificCredentialId != nil && len(*s.ServiceSpecificCredentialId) < 20 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("ServiceSpecificCredentialId", 20)) } if s.UserName != nil && len(*s.UserName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("UserName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetServiceSpecificCredentialId sets the ServiceSpecificCredentialId field's value. func (s *DeleteServiceSpecificCredentialInput) SetServiceSpecificCredentialId(v string) *DeleteServiceSpecificCredentialInput { s.ServiceSpecificCredentialId = &v return s } // SetUserName sets the UserName field's value. func (s *DeleteServiceSpecificCredentialInput) SetUserName(v string) *DeleteServiceSpecificCredentialInput { s.UserName = &v return s } type DeleteServiceSpecificCredentialOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteServiceSpecificCredentialOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteServiceSpecificCredentialOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } type DeleteSigningCertificateInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The ID of the signing certificate to delete. // // The format of this parameter, as described by its regex (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex) // pattern, is a string of characters that can be upper- or lower-cased letters // or digits. // // CertificateId is a required field CertificateId *string `min:"24" type:"string" required:"true"` // The name of the user the signing certificate belongs to. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- UserName *string `min:"1" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteSigningCertificateInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteSigningCertificateInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *DeleteSigningCertificateInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteSigningCertificateInput"} if s.CertificateId == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("CertificateId")) } if s.CertificateId != nil && len(*s.CertificateId) < 24 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("CertificateId", 24)) } if s.UserName != nil && len(*s.UserName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("UserName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetCertificateId sets the CertificateId field's value. func (s *DeleteSigningCertificateInput) SetCertificateId(v string) *DeleteSigningCertificateInput { s.CertificateId = &v return s } // SetUserName sets the UserName field's value. func (s *DeleteSigningCertificateInput) SetUserName(v string) *DeleteSigningCertificateInput { s.UserName = &v return s } type DeleteSigningCertificateOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteSigningCertificateOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteSigningCertificateOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } type DeleteUserInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name of the user to delete. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- // // UserName is a required field UserName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteUserInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteUserInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *DeleteUserInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteUserInput"} if s.UserName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("UserName")) } if s.UserName != nil && len(*s.UserName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("UserName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetUserName sets the UserName field's value. func (s *DeleteUserInput) SetUserName(v string) *DeleteUserInput { s.UserName = &v return s } type DeleteUserOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteUserOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteUserOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } type DeleteUserPolicyInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name identifying the policy document to delete. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@-+ // // PolicyName is a required field PolicyName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` // The name (friendly name, not ARN) identifying the user that the policy is // embedded in. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- // // UserName is a required field UserName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteUserPolicyInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteUserPolicyInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *DeleteUserPolicyInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteUserPolicyInput"} if s.PolicyName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("PolicyName")) } if s.PolicyName != nil && len(*s.PolicyName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("PolicyName", 1)) } if s.UserName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("UserName")) } if s.UserName != nil && len(*s.UserName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("UserName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetPolicyName sets the PolicyName field's value. func (s *DeleteUserPolicyInput) SetPolicyName(v string) *DeleteUserPolicyInput { s.PolicyName = &v return s } // SetUserName sets the UserName field's value. func (s *DeleteUserPolicyInput) SetUserName(v string) *DeleteUserPolicyInput { s.UserName = &v return s } type DeleteUserPolicyOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteUserPolicyOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteUserPolicyOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } type DeleteVirtualMFADeviceInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The serial number that uniquely identifies the MFA device. For virtual MFA // devices, the serial number is the same as the ARN. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@:/- // // SerialNumber is a required field SerialNumber *string `min:"9" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteVirtualMFADeviceInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteVirtualMFADeviceInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *DeleteVirtualMFADeviceInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteVirtualMFADeviceInput"} if s.SerialNumber == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SerialNumber")) } if s.SerialNumber != nil && len(*s.SerialNumber) < 9 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("SerialNumber", 9)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetSerialNumber sets the SerialNumber field's value. func (s *DeleteVirtualMFADeviceInput) SetSerialNumber(v string) *DeleteVirtualMFADeviceInput { s.SerialNumber = &v return s } type DeleteVirtualMFADeviceOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteVirtualMFADeviceOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteVirtualMFADeviceOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // The reason that the service-linked role deletion failed. // // This data type is used as a response element in the GetServiceLinkedRoleDeletionStatus // operation. type DeletionTaskFailureReasonType struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A short description of the reason that the service-linked role deletion failed. Reason *string `type:"string"` // A list of objects that contains details about the service-linked role deletion // failure. If the service-linked role has active sessions or if any resources // that were used by the role have not been deleted from the linked service, // the role can't be deleted. This parameter includes a list of the resources // that are associated with the role and the region in which the resources are // being used. RoleUsageList []*RoleUsageType `type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeletionTaskFailureReasonType) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeletionTaskFailureReasonType) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetReason sets the Reason field's value. func (s *DeletionTaskFailureReasonType) SetReason(v string) *DeletionTaskFailureReasonType { s.Reason = &v return s } // SetRoleUsageList sets the RoleUsageList field's value. func (s *DeletionTaskFailureReasonType) SetRoleUsageList(v []*RoleUsageType) *DeletionTaskFailureReasonType { s.RoleUsageList = v return s } type DetachGroupPolicyInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name (friendly name, not ARN) of the IAM group to detach the policy from. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- // // GroupName is a required field GroupName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` // The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the IAM policy you want to detach. // // For more information about ARNs, see Amazon Resource Names (ARNs) and AWS // Service Namespaces (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/aws-arns-and-namespaces.html) // in the AWS General Reference. // // PolicyArn is a required field PolicyArn *string `min:"20" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DetachGroupPolicyInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DetachGroupPolicyInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *DetachGroupPolicyInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DetachGroupPolicyInput"} if s.GroupName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("GroupName")) } if s.GroupName != nil && len(*s.GroupName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("GroupName", 1)) } if s.PolicyArn == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("PolicyArn")) } if s.PolicyArn != nil && len(*s.PolicyArn) < 20 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("PolicyArn", 20)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetGroupName sets the GroupName field's value. func (s *DetachGroupPolicyInput) SetGroupName(v string) *DetachGroupPolicyInput { s.GroupName = &v return s } // SetPolicyArn sets the PolicyArn field's value. func (s *DetachGroupPolicyInput) SetPolicyArn(v string) *DetachGroupPolicyInput { s.PolicyArn = &v return s } type DetachGroupPolicyOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DetachGroupPolicyOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DetachGroupPolicyOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } type DetachRolePolicyInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the IAM policy you want to detach. // // For more information about ARNs, see Amazon Resource Names (ARNs) and AWS // Service Namespaces (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/aws-arns-and-namespaces.html) // in the AWS General Reference. // // PolicyArn is a required field PolicyArn *string `min:"20" type:"string" required:"true"` // The name (friendly name, not ARN) of the IAM role to detach the policy from. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@- // // RoleName is a required field RoleName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DetachRolePolicyInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DetachRolePolicyInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *DetachRolePolicyInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DetachRolePolicyInput"} if s.PolicyArn == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("PolicyArn")) } if s.PolicyArn != nil && len(*s.PolicyArn) < 20 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("PolicyArn", 20)) } if s.RoleName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("RoleName")) } if s.RoleName != nil && len(*s.RoleName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("RoleName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetPolicyArn sets the PolicyArn field's value. func (s *DetachRolePolicyInput) SetPolicyArn(v string) *DetachRolePolicyInput { s.PolicyArn = &v return s } // SetRoleName sets the RoleName field's value. func (s *DetachRolePolicyInput) SetRoleName(v string) *DetachRolePolicyInput { s.RoleName = &v return s } type DetachRolePolicyOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DetachRolePolicyOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DetachRolePolicyOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } type DetachUserPolicyInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the IAM policy you want to detach. // // For more information about ARNs, see Amazon Resource Names (ARNs) and AWS // Service Namespaces (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/aws-arns-and-namespaces.html) // in the AWS General Reference. // // PolicyArn is a required field PolicyArn *string `min:"20" type:"string" required:"true"` // The name (friendly name, not ARN) of the IAM user to detach the policy from. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- // // UserName is a required field UserName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DetachUserPolicyInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DetachUserPolicyInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *DetachUserPolicyInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DetachUserPolicyInput"} if s.PolicyArn == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("PolicyArn")) } if s.PolicyArn != nil && len(*s.PolicyArn) < 20 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("PolicyArn", 20)) } if s.UserName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("UserName")) } if s.UserName != nil && len(*s.UserName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("UserName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetPolicyArn sets the PolicyArn field's value. func (s *DetachUserPolicyInput) SetPolicyArn(v string) *DetachUserPolicyInput { s.PolicyArn = &v return s } // SetUserName sets the UserName field's value. func (s *DetachUserPolicyInput) SetUserName(v string) *DetachUserPolicyInput { s.UserName = &v return s } type DetachUserPolicyOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DetachUserPolicyOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DetachUserPolicyOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } type EnableMFADeviceInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // An authentication code emitted by the device. // // The format for this parameter is a string of 6 digits. // // Submit your request immediately after generating the authentication codes. // If you generate the codes and then wait too long to submit the request, the // MFA device successfully associates with the user but the MFA device becomes // out of sync. This happens because time-based one-time passwords (TOTP) expire // after a short period of time. If this happens, you can resync the device // (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/id_credentials_mfa_sync.html). // // AuthenticationCode1 is a required field AuthenticationCode1 *string `min:"6" type:"string" required:"true"` // A subsequent authentication code emitted by the device. // // The format for this parameter is a string of 6 digits. // // Submit your request immediately after generating the authentication codes. // If you generate the codes and then wait too long to submit the request, the // MFA device successfully associates with the user but the MFA device becomes // out of sync. This happens because time-based one-time passwords (TOTP) expire // after a short period of time. If this happens, you can resync the device // (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/id_credentials_mfa_sync.html). // // AuthenticationCode2 is a required field AuthenticationCode2 *string `min:"6" type:"string" required:"true"` // The serial number that uniquely identifies the MFA device. For virtual MFA // devices, the serial number is the device ARN. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@:/- // // SerialNumber is a required field SerialNumber *string `min:"9" type:"string" required:"true"` // The name of the IAM user for whom you want to enable the MFA device. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- // // UserName is a required field UserName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s EnableMFADeviceInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s EnableMFADeviceInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *EnableMFADeviceInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "EnableMFADeviceInput"} if s.AuthenticationCode1 == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("AuthenticationCode1")) } if s.AuthenticationCode1 != nil && len(*s.AuthenticationCode1) < 6 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("AuthenticationCode1", 6)) } if s.AuthenticationCode2 == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("AuthenticationCode2")) } if s.AuthenticationCode2 != nil && len(*s.AuthenticationCode2) < 6 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("AuthenticationCode2", 6)) } if s.SerialNumber == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SerialNumber")) } if s.SerialNumber != nil && len(*s.SerialNumber) < 9 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("SerialNumber", 9)) } if s.UserName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("UserName")) } if s.UserName != nil && len(*s.UserName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("UserName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetAuthenticationCode1 sets the AuthenticationCode1 field's value. func (s *EnableMFADeviceInput) SetAuthenticationCode1(v string) *EnableMFADeviceInput { s.AuthenticationCode1 = &v return s } // SetAuthenticationCode2 sets the AuthenticationCode2 field's value. func (s *EnableMFADeviceInput) SetAuthenticationCode2(v string) *EnableMFADeviceInput { s.AuthenticationCode2 = &v return s } // SetSerialNumber sets the SerialNumber field's value. func (s *EnableMFADeviceInput) SetSerialNumber(v string) *EnableMFADeviceInput { s.SerialNumber = &v return s } // SetUserName sets the UserName field's value. func (s *EnableMFADeviceInput) SetUserName(v string) *EnableMFADeviceInput { s.UserName = &v return s } type EnableMFADeviceOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s EnableMFADeviceOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s EnableMFADeviceOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Contains the results of a simulation. // // This data type is used by the return parameter of SimulateCustomPolicy and // SimulatePrincipalPolicy. type EvaluationResult struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name of the API action tested on the indicated resource. // // EvalActionName is a required field EvalActionName *string `min:"3" type:"string" required:"true"` // The result of the simulation. // // EvalDecision is a required field EvalDecision *string `type:"string" required:"true" enum:"PolicyEvaluationDecisionType"` // Additional details about the results of the evaluation decision. When there // are both IAM policies and resource policies, this parameter explains how // each set of policies contributes to the final evaluation decision. When simulating // cross-account access to a resource, both the resource-based policy and the // caller's IAM policy must grant access. See How IAM Roles Differ from Resource-based // Policies (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/id_roles_compare-resource-policies.html) EvalDecisionDetails map[string]*string `type:"map"` // The ARN of the resource that the indicated API action was tested on. EvalResourceName *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // A list of the statements in the input policies that determine the result // for this scenario. Remember that even if multiple statements allow the action // on the resource, if only one statement denies that action, then the explicit // deny overrides any allow, and the deny statement is the only entry included // in the result. MatchedStatements []*Statement `type:"list"` // A list of context keys that are required by the included input policies but // that were not provided by one of the input parameters. This list is used // when the resource in a simulation is "*", either explicitly, or when the // ResourceArns parameter blank. If you include a list of resources, then any // missing context values are instead included under the ResourceSpecificResults // section. To discover the context keys used by a set of policies, you can // call GetContextKeysForCustomPolicy or GetContextKeysForPrincipalPolicy. MissingContextValues []*string `type:"list"` // A structure that details how AWS Organizations and its service control policies // affect the results of the simulation. Only applies if the simulated user's // account is part of an organization. OrganizationsDecisionDetail *OrganizationsDecisionDetail `type:"structure"` // The individual results of the simulation of the API action specified in EvalActionName // on each resource. ResourceSpecificResults []*ResourceSpecificResult `type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s EvaluationResult) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s EvaluationResult) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetEvalActionName sets the EvalActionName field's value. func (s *EvaluationResult) SetEvalActionName(v string) *EvaluationResult { s.EvalActionName = &v return s } // SetEvalDecision sets the EvalDecision field's value. func (s *EvaluationResult) SetEvalDecision(v string) *EvaluationResult { s.EvalDecision = &v return s } // SetEvalDecisionDetails sets the EvalDecisionDetails field's value. func (s *EvaluationResult) SetEvalDecisionDetails(v map[string]*string) *EvaluationResult { s.EvalDecisionDetails = v return s } // SetEvalResourceName sets the EvalResourceName field's value. func (s *EvaluationResult) SetEvalResourceName(v string) *EvaluationResult { s.EvalResourceName = &v return s } // SetMatchedStatements sets the MatchedStatements field's value. func (s *EvaluationResult) SetMatchedStatements(v []*Statement) *EvaluationResult { s.MatchedStatements = v return s } // SetMissingContextValues sets the MissingContextValues field's value. func (s *EvaluationResult) SetMissingContextValues(v []*string) *EvaluationResult { s.MissingContextValues = v return s } // SetOrganizationsDecisionDetail sets the OrganizationsDecisionDetail field's value. func (s *EvaluationResult) SetOrganizationsDecisionDetail(v *OrganizationsDecisionDetail) *EvaluationResult { s.OrganizationsDecisionDetail = v return s } // SetResourceSpecificResults sets the ResourceSpecificResults field's value. func (s *EvaluationResult) SetResourceSpecificResults(v []*ResourceSpecificResult) *EvaluationResult { s.ResourceSpecificResults = v return s } type GenerateCredentialReportInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s GenerateCredentialReportInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s GenerateCredentialReportInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Contains the response to a successful GenerateCredentialReport request. type GenerateCredentialReportOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Information about the credential report. Description *string `type:"string"` // Information about the state of the credential report. State *string `type:"string" enum:"ReportStateType"` } // String returns the string representation func (s GenerateCredentialReportOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s GenerateCredentialReportOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetDescription sets the Description field's value. func (s *GenerateCredentialReportOutput) SetDescription(v string) *GenerateCredentialReportOutput { s.Description = &v return s } // SetState sets the State field's value. func (s *GenerateCredentialReportOutput) SetState(v string) *GenerateCredentialReportOutput { s.State = &v return s } type GetAccessKeyLastUsedInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The identifier of an access key. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters that can consist of any upper or lowercased letter // or digit. // // AccessKeyId is a required field AccessKeyId *string `min:"16" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s GetAccessKeyLastUsedInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s GetAccessKeyLastUsedInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *GetAccessKeyLastUsedInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetAccessKeyLastUsedInput"} if s.AccessKeyId == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("AccessKeyId")) } if s.AccessKeyId != nil && len(*s.AccessKeyId) < 16 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("AccessKeyId", 16)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetAccessKeyId sets the AccessKeyId field's value. func (s *GetAccessKeyLastUsedInput) SetAccessKeyId(v string) *GetAccessKeyLastUsedInput { s.AccessKeyId = &v return s } // Contains the response to a successful GetAccessKeyLastUsed request. It is // also returned as a member of the AccessKeyMetaData structure returned by // the ListAccessKeys action. type GetAccessKeyLastUsedOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Contains information about the last time the access key was used. AccessKeyLastUsed *AccessKeyLastUsed `type:"structure"` // The name of the AWS IAM user that owns this access key. UserName *string `min:"1" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s GetAccessKeyLastUsedOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s GetAccessKeyLastUsedOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetAccessKeyLastUsed sets the AccessKeyLastUsed field's value. func (s *GetAccessKeyLastUsedOutput) SetAccessKeyLastUsed(v *AccessKeyLastUsed) *GetAccessKeyLastUsedOutput { s.AccessKeyLastUsed = v return s } // SetUserName sets the UserName field's value. func (s *GetAccessKeyLastUsedOutput) SetUserName(v string) *GetAccessKeyLastUsedOutput { s.UserName = &v return s } type GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A list of entity types used to filter the results. Only the entities that // match the types you specify are included in the output. Use the value LocalManagedPolicy // to include customer managed policies. // // The format for this parameter is a comma-separated (if more than one) list // of strings. Each string value in the list must be one of the valid values // listed below. Filter []*string `type:"list"` // Use this parameter only when paginating results and only after you receive // a response indicating that the results are truncated. Set it to the value // of the Marker element in the response that you received to indicate where // the next call should start. Marker *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // (Optional) Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum // number of items you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond // the maximum you specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. // // If you do not include this parameter, it defaults to 100. Note that IAM might // return fewer results, even when there are more results available. In that // case, the IsTruncated response element returns true and Marker contains a // value to include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue // from. MaxItems *int64 `min:"1" type:"integer"` } // String returns the string representation func (s GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsInput"} if s.Marker != nil && len(*s.Marker) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Marker", 1)) } if s.MaxItems != nil && *s.MaxItems < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("MaxItems", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetFilter sets the Filter field's value. func (s *GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsInput) SetFilter(v []*string) *GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsInput { s.Filter = v return s } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsInput) SetMarker(v string) *GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsInput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetMaxItems sets the MaxItems field's value. func (s *GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsInput) SetMaxItems(v int64) *GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsInput { s.MaxItems = &v return s } // Contains the response to a successful GetAccountAuthorizationDetails request. type GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A list containing information about IAM groups. GroupDetailList []*GroupDetail `type:"list"` // A flag that indicates whether there are more items to return. If your results // were truncated, you can make a subsequent pagination request using the Marker // request parameter to retrieve more items. Note that IAM might return fewer // than the MaxItems number of results even when there are more results available. // We recommend that you check IsTruncated after every call to ensure that you // receive all of your results. IsTruncated *bool `type:"boolean"` // When IsTruncated is true, this element is present and contains the value // to use for the Marker parameter in a subsequent pagination request. Marker *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // A list containing information about managed policies. Policies []*ManagedPolicyDetail `type:"list"` // A list containing information about IAM roles. RoleDetailList []*RoleDetail `type:"list"` // A list containing information about IAM users. UserDetailList []*UserDetail `type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetGroupDetailList sets the GroupDetailList field's value. func (s *GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsOutput) SetGroupDetailList(v []*GroupDetail) *GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsOutput { s.GroupDetailList = v return s } // SetIsTruncated sets the IsTruncated field's value. func (s *GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsOutput) SetIsTruncated(v bool) *GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsOutput { s.IsTruncated = &v return s } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsOutput) SetMarker(v string) *GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsOutput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetPolicies sets the Policies field's value. func (s *GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsOutput) SetPolicies(v []*ManagedPolicyDetail) *GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsOutput { s.Policies = v return s } // SetRoleDetailList sets the RoleDetailList field's value. func (s *GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsOutput) SetRoleDetailList(v []*RoleDetail) *GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsOutput { s.RoleDetailList = v return s } // SetUserDetailList sets the UserDetailList field's value. func (s *GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsOutput) SetUserDetailList(v []*UserDetail) *GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsOutput { s.UserDetailList = v return s } type GetAccountPasswordPolicyInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s GetAccountPasswordPolicyInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s GetAccountPasswordPolicyInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Contains the response to a successful GetAccountPasswordPolicy request. type GetAccountPasswordPolicyOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A structure that contains details about the account's password policy. // // PasswordPolicy is a required field PasswordPolicy *PasswordPolicy `type:"structure" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s GetAccountPasswordPolicyOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s GetAccountPasswordPolicyOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetPasswordPolicy sets the PasswordPolicy field's value. func (s *GetAccountPasswordPolicyOutput) SetPasswordPolicy(v *PasswordPolicy) *GetAccountPasswordPolicyOutput { s.PasswordPolicy = v return s } type GetAccountSummaryInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s GetAccountSummaryInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s GetAccountSummaryInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Contains the response to a successful GetAccountSummary request. type GetAccountSummaryOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A set of key value pairs containing information about IAM entity usage and // IAM quotas. SummaryMap map[string]*int64 `type:"map"` } // String returns the string representation func (s GetAccountSummaryOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s GetAccountSummaryOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetSummaryMap sets the SummaryMap field's value. func (s *GetAccountSummaryOutput) SetSummaryMap(v map[string]*int64) *GetAccountSummaryOutput { s.SummaryMap = v return s } type GetContextKeysForCustomPolicyInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A list of policies for which you want the list of context keys referenced // in those policies. Each document is specified as a string containing the // complete, valid JSON text of an IAM policy. // // The regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex) used to validate this // parameter is a string of characters consisting of any printable ASCII character // ranging from the space character (\u0020) through end of the ASCII character // range as well as the printable characters in the Basic Latin and Latin-1 // Supplement character set (through \u00FF). It also includes the special characters // tab (\u0009), line feed (\u000A), and carriage return (\u000D). // // PolicyInputList is a required field PolicyInputList []*string `type:"list" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s GetContextKeysForCustomPolicyInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s GetContextKeysForCustomPolicyInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *GetContextKeysForCustomPolicyInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetContextKeysForCustomPolicyInput"} if s.PolicyInputList == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("PolicyInputList")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetPolicyInputList sets the PolicyInputList field's value. func (s *GetContextKeysForCustomPolicyInput) SetPolicyInputList(v []*string) *GetContextKeysForCustomPolicyInput { s.PolicyInputList = v return s } // Contains the response to a successful GetContextKeysForPrincipalPolicy or // GetContextKeysForCustomPolicy request. type GetContextKeysForPolicyResponse struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The list of context keys that are referenced in the input policies. ContextKeyNames []*string `type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s GetContextKeysForPolicyResponse) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s GetContextKeysForPolicyResponse) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetContextKeyNames sets the ContextKeyNames field's value. func (s *GetContextKeysForPolicyResponse) SetContextKeyNames(v []*string) *GetContextKeysForPolicyResponse { s.ContextKeyNames = v return s } type GetContextKeysForPrincipalPolicyInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // An optional list of additional policies for which you want the list of context // keys that are referenced. // // The regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex) used to validate this // parameter is a string of characters consisting of any printable ASCII character // ranging from the space character (\u0020) through end of the ASCII character // range as well as the printable characters in the Basic Latin and Latin-1 // Supplement character set (through \u00FF). It also includes the special characters // tab (\u0009), line feed (\u000A), and carriage return (\u000D). PolicyInputList []*string `type:"list"` // The ARN of a user, group, or role whose policies contain the context keys // that you want listed. If you specify a user, the list includes context keys // that are found in all policies attached to the user as well as to all groups // that the user is a member of. If you pick a group or a role, then it includes // only those context keys that are found in policies attached to that entity. // Note that all parameters are shown in unencoded form here for clarity, but // must be URL encoded to be included as a part of a real HTML request. // // For more information about ARNs, see Amazon Resource Names (ARNs) and AWS // Service Namespaces (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/aws-arns-and-namespaces.html) // in the AWS General Reference. // // PolicySourceArn is a required field PolicySourceArn *string `min:"20" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s GetContextKeysForPrincipalPolicyInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s GetContextKeysForPrincipalPolicyInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *GetContextKeysForPrincipalPolicyInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetContextKeysForPrincipalPolicyInput"} if s.PolicySourceArn == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("PolicySourceArn")) } if s.PolicySourceArn != nil && len(*s.PolicySourceArn) < 20 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("PolicySourceArn", 20)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetPolicyInputList sets the PolicyInputList field's value. func (s *GetContextKeysForPrincipalPolicyInput) SetPolicyInputList(v []*string) *GetContextKeysForPrincipalPolicyInput { s.PolicyInputList = v return s } // SetPolicySourceArn sets the PolicySourceArn field's value. func (s *GetContextKeysForPrincipalPolicyInput) SetPolicySourceArn(v string) *GetContextKeysForPrincipalPolicyInput { s.PolicySourceArn = &v return s } type GetCredentialReportInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s GetCredentialReportInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s GetCredentialReportInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Contains the response to a successful GetCredentialReport request. type GetCredentialReportOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Contains the credential report. The report is Base64-encoded. // // Content is automatically base64 encoded/decoded by the SDK. Content []byte `type:"blob"` // The date and time when the credential report was created, in ISO 8601 date-time // format (http://www.iso.org/iso/iso8601). GeneratedTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"` // The format (MIME type) of the credential report. ReportFormat *string `type:"string" enum:"ReportFormatType"` } // String returns the string representation func (s GetCredentialReportOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s GetCredentialReportOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetContent sets the Content field's value. func (s *GetCredentialReportOutput) SetContent(v []byte) *GetCredentialReportOutput { s.Content = v return s } // SetGeneratedTime sets the GeneratedTime field's value. func (s *GetCredentialReportOutput) SetGeneratedTime(v time.Time) *GetCredentialReportOutput { s.GeneratedTime = &v return s } // SetReportFormat sets the ReportFormat field's value. func (s *GetCredentialReportOutput) SetReportFormat(v string) *GetCredentialReportOutput { s.ReportFormat = &v return s } type GetGroupInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name of the group. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- // // GroupName is a required field GroupName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` // Use this parameter only when paginating results and only after you receive // a response indicating that the results are truncated. Set it to the value // of the Marker element in the response that you received to indicate where // the next call should start. Marker *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // (Optional) Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum // number of items you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond // the maximum you specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. // // If you do not include this parameter, it defaults to 100. Note that IAM might // return fewer results, even when there are more results available. In that // case, the IsTruncated response element returns true and Marker contains a // value to include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue // from. MaxItems *int64 `min:"1" type:"integer"` } // String returns the string representation func (s GetGroupInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s GetGroupInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *GetGroupInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetGroupInput"} if s.GroupName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("GroupName")) } if s.GroupName != nil && len(*s.GroupName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("GroupName", 1)) } if s.Marker != nil && len(*s.Marker) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Marker", 1)) } if s.MaxItems != nil && *s.MaxItems < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("MaxItems", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetGroupName sets the GroupName field's value. func (s *GetGroupInput) SetGroupName(v string) *GetGroupInput { s.GroupName = &v return s } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *GetGroupInput) SetMarker(v string) *GetGroupInput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetMaxItems sets the MaxItems field's value. func (s *GetGroupInput) SetMaxItems(v int64) *GetGroupInput { s.MaxItems = &v return s } // Contains the response to a successful GetGroup request. type GetGroupOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A structure that contains details about the group. // // Group is a required field Group *Group `type:"structure" required:"true"` // A flag that indicates whether there are more items to return. If your results // were truncated, you can make a subsequent pagination request using the Marker // request parameter to retrieve more items. Note that IAM might return fewer // than the MaxItems number of results even when there are more results available. // We recommend that you check IsTruncated after every call to ensure that you // receive all of your results. IsTruncated *bool `type:"boolean"` // When IsTruncated is true, this element is present and contains the value // to use for the Marker parameter in a subsequent pagination request. Marker *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // A list of users in the group. // // Users is a required field Users []*User `type:"list" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s GetGroupOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s GetGroupOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetGroup sets the Group field's value. func (s *GetGroupOutput) SetGroup(v *Group) *GetGroupOutput { s.Group = v return s } // SetIsTruncated sets the IsTruncated field's value. func (s *GetGroupOutput) SetIsTruncated(v bool) *GetGroupOutput { s.IsTruncated = &v return s } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *GetGroupOutput) SetMarker(v string) *GetGroupOutput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetUsers sets the Users field's value. func (s *GetGroupOutput) SetUsers(v []*User) *GetGroupOutput { s.Users = v return s } type GetGroupPolicyInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name of the group the policy is associated with. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- // // GroupName is a required field GroupName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` // The name of the policy document to get. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@-+ // // PolicyName is a required field PolicyName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s GetGroupPolicyInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s GetGroupPolicyInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *GetGroupPolicyInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetGroupPolicyInput"} if s.GroupName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("GroupName")) } if s.GroupName != nil && len(*s.GroupName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("GroupName", 1)) } if s.PolicyName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("PolicyName")) } if s.PolicyName != nil && len(*s.PolicyName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("PolicyName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetGroupName sets the GroupName field's value. func (s *GetGroupPolicyInput) SetGroupName(v string) *GetGroupPolicyInput { s.GroupName = &v return s } // SetPolicyName sets the PolicyName field's value. func (s *GetGroupPolicyInput) SetPolicyName(v string) *GetGroupPolicyInput { s.PolicyName = &v return s } // Contains the response to a successful GetGroupPolicy request. type GetGroupPolicyOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The group the policy is associated with. // // GroupName is a required field GroupName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` // The policy document. // // PolicyDocument is a required field PolicyDocument *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` // The name of the policy. // // PolicyName is a required field PolicyName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s GetGroupPolicyOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s GetGroupPolicyOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetGroupName sets the GroupName field's value. func (s *GetGroupPolicyOutput) SetGroupName(v string) *GetGroupPolicyOutput { s.GroupName = &v return s } // SetPolicyDocument sets the PolicyDocument field's value. func (s *GetGroupPolicyOutput) SetPolicyDocument(v string) *GetGroupPolicyOutput { s.PolicyDocument = &v return s } // SetPolicyName sets the PolicyName field's value. func (s *GetGroupPolicyOutput) SetPolicyName(v string) *GetGroupPolicyOutput { s.PolicyName = &v return s } type GetInstanceProfileInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name of the instance profile to get information about. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- // // InstanceProfileName is a required field InstanceProfileName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s GetInstanceProfileInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s GetInstanceProfileInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *GetInstanceProfileInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetInstanceProfileInput"} if s.InstanceProfileName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("InstanceProfileName")) } if s.InstanceProfileName != nil && len(*s.InstanceProfileName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("InstanceProfileName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetInstanceProfileName sets the InstanceProfileName field's value. func (s *GetInstanceProfileInput) SetInstanceProfileName(v string) *GetInstanceProfileInput { s.InstanceProfileName = &v return s } // Contains the response to a successful GetInstanceProfile request. type GetInstanceProfileOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A structure containing details about the instance profile. // // InstanceProfile is a required field InstanceProfile *InstanceProfile `type:"structure" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s GetInstanceProfileOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s GetInstanceProfileOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetInstanceProfile sets the InstanceProfile field's value. func (s *GetInstanceProfileOutput) SetInstanceProfile(v *InstanceProfile) *GetInstanceProfileOutput { s.InstanceProfile = v return s } type GetLoginProfileInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name of the user whose login profile you want to retrieve. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- // // UserName is a required field UserName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s GetLoginProfileInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s GetLoginProfileInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *GetLoginProfileInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetLoginProfileInput"} if s.UserName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("UserName")) } if s.UserName != nil && len(*s.UserName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("UserName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetUserName sets the UserName field's value. func (s *GetLoginProfileInput) SetUserName(v string) *GetLoginProfileInput { s.UserName = &v return s } // Contains the response to a successful GetLoginProfile request. type GetLoginProfileOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A structure containing the user name and password create date for the user. // // LoginProfile is a required field LoginProfile *LoginProfile `type:"structure" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s GetLoginProfileOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s GetLoginProfileOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetLoginProfile sets the LoginProfile field's value. func (s *GetLoginProfileOutput) SetLoginProfile(v *LoginProfile) *GetLoginProfileOutput { s.LoginProfile = v return s } type GetOpenIDConnectProviderInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the OIDC provider resource object in IAM // to get information for. You can get a list of OIDC provider resource ARNs // by using the ListOpenIDConnectProviders action. // // For more information about ARNs, see Amazon Resource Names (ARNs) and AWS // Service Namespaces (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/aws-arns-and-namespaces.html) // in the AWS General Reference. // // OpenIDConnectProviderArn is a required field OpenIDConnectProviderArn *string `min:"20" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s GetOpenIDConnectProviderInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s GetOpenIDConnectProviderInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *GetOpenIDConnectProviderInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetOpenIDConnectProviderInput"} if s.OpenIDConnectProviderArn == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("OpenIDConnectProviderArn")) } if s.OpenIDConnectProviderArn != nil && len(*s.OpenIDConnectProviderArn) < 20 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("OpenIDConnectProviderArn", 20)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetOpenIDConnectProviderArn sets the OpenIDConnectProviderArn field's value. func (s *GetOpenIDConnectProviderInput) SetOpenIDConnectProviderArn(v string) *GetOpenIDConnectProviderInput { s.OpenIDConnectProviderArn = &v return s } // Contains the response to a successful GetOpenIDConnectProvider request. type GetOpenIDConnectProviderOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A list of client IDs (also known as audiences) that are associated with the // specified IAM OIDC provider resource object. For more information, see CreateOpenIDConnectProvider. ClientIDList []*string `type:"list"` // The date and time when the IAM OIDC provider resource object was created // in the AWS account. CreateDate *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"` // A list of certificate thumbprints that are associated with the specified // IAM OIDC provider resource object. For more information, see CreateOpenIDConnectProvider. ThumbprintList []*string `type:"list"` // The URL that the IAM OIDC provider resource object is associated with. For // more information, see CreateOpenIDConnectProvider. Url *string `min:"1" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s GetOpenIDConnectProviderOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s GetOpenIDConnectProviderOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetClientIDList sets the ClientIDList field's value. func (s *GetOpenIDConnectProviderOutput) SetClientIDList(v []*string) *GetOpenIDConnectProviderOutput { s.ClientIDList = v return s } // SetCreateDate sets the CreateDate field's value. func (s *GetOpenIDConnectProviderOutput) SetCreateDate(v time.Time) *GetOpenIDConnectProviderOutput { s.CreateDate = &v return s } // SetThumbprintList sets the ThumbprintList field's value. func (s *GetOpenIDConnectProviderOutput) SetThumbprintList(v []*string) *GetOpenIDConnectProviderOutput { s.ThumbprintList = v return s } // SetUrl sets the Url field's value. func (s *GetOpenIDConnectProviderOutput) SetUrl(v string) *GetOpenIDConnectProviderOutput { s.Url = &v return s } type GetPolicyInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the managed policy that you want information // about. // // For more information about ARNs, see Amazon Resource Names (ARNs) and AWS // Service Namespaces (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/aws-arns-and-namespaces.html) // in the AWS General Reference. // // PolicyArn is a required field PolicyArn *string `min:"20" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s GetPolicyInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s GetPolicyInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *GetPolicyInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetPolicyInput"} if s.PolicyArn == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("PolicyArn")) } if s.PolicyArn != nil && len(*s.PolicyArn) < 20 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("PolicyArn", 20)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetPolicyArn sets the PolicyArn field's value. func (s *GetPolicyInput) SetPolicyArn(v string) *GetPolicyInput { s.PolicyArn = &v return s } // Contains the response to a successful GetPolicy request. type GetPolicyOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A structure containing details about the policy. Policy *Policy `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s GetPolicyOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s GetPolicyOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetPolicy sets the Policy field's value. func (s *GetPolicyOutput) SetPolicy(v *Policy) *GetPolicyOutput { s.Policy = v return s } type GetPolicyVersionInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the managed policy that you want information // about. // // For more information about ARNs, see Amazon Resource Names (ARNs) and AWS // Service Namespaces (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/aws-arns-and-namespaces.html) // in the AWS General Reference. // // PolicyArn is a required field PolicyArn *string `min:"20" type:"string" required:"true"` // Identifies the policy version to retrieve. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters that consists of the lowercase letter 'v' followed // by one or two digits, and optionally followed by a period '.' and a string // of letters and digits. // // VersionId is a required field VersionId *string `type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s GetPolicyVersionInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s GetPolicyVersionInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *GetPolicyVersionInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetPolicyVersionInput"} if s.PolicyArn == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("PolicyArn")) } if s.PolicyArn != nil && len(*s.PolicyArn) < 20 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("PolicyArn", 20)) } if s.VersionId == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("VersionId")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetPolicyArn sets the PolicyArn field's value. func (s *GetPolicyVersionInput) SetPolicyArn(v string) *GetPolicyVersionInput { s.PolicyArn = &v return s } // SetVersionId sets the VersionId field's value. func (s *GetPolicyVersionInput) SetVersionId(v string) *GetPolicyVersionInput { s.VersionId = &v return s } // Contains the response to a successful GetPolicyVersion request. type GetPolicyVersionOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A structure containing details about the policy version. PolicyVersion *PolicyVersion `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s GetPolicyVersionOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s GetPolicyVersionOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetPolicyVersion sets the PolicyVersion field's value. func (s *GetPolicyVersionOutput) SetPolicyVersion(v *PolicyVersion) *GetPolicyVersionOutput { s.PolicyVersion = v return s } type GetRoleInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name of the IAM role to get information about. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@- // // RoleName is a required field RoleName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s GetRoleInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s GetRoleInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *GetRoleInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetRoleInput"} if s.RoleName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("RoleName")) } if s.RoleName != nil && len(*s.RoleName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("RoleName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetRoleName sets the RoleName field's value. func (s *GetRoleInput) SetRoleName(v string) *GetRoleInput { s.RoleName = &v return s } // Contains the response to a successful GetRole request. type GetRoleOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A structure containing details about the IAM role. // // Role is a required field Role *Role `type:"structure" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s GetRoleOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s GetRoleOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetRole sets the Role field's value. func (s *GetRoleOutput) SetRole(v *Role) *GetRoleOutput { s.Role = v return s } type GetRolePolicyInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name of the policy document to get. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@-+ // // PolicyName is a required field PolicyName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` // The name of the role associated with the policy. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@- // // RoleName is a required field RoleName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s GetRolePolicyInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s GetRolePolicyInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *GetRolePolicyInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetRolePolicyInput"} if s.PolicyName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("PolicyName")) } if s.PolicyName != nil && len(*s.PolicyName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("PolicyName", 1)) } if s.RoleName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("RoleName")) } if s.RoleName != nil && len(*s.RoleName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("RoleName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetPolicyName sets the PolicyName field's value. func (s *GetRolePolicyInput) SetPolicyName(v string) *GetRolePolicyInput { s.PolicyName = &v return s } // SetRoleName sets the RoleName field's value. func (s *GetRolePolicyInput) SetRoleName(v string) *GetRolePolicyInput { s.RoleName = &v return s } // Contains the response to a successful GetRolePolicy request. type GetRolePolicyOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The policy document. // // PolicyDocument is a required field PolicyDocument *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` // The name of the policy. // // PolicyName is a required field PolicyName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` // The role the policy is associated with. // // RoleName is a required field RoleName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s GetRolePolicyOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s GetRolePolicyOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetPolicyDocument sets the PolicyDocument field's value. func (s *GetRolePolicyOutput) SetPolicyDocument(v string) *GetRolePolicyOutput { s.PolicyDocument = &v return s } // SetPolicyName sets the PolicyName field's value. func (s *GetRolePolicyOutput) SetPolicyName(v string) *GetRolePolicyOutput { s.PolicyName = &v return s } // SetRoleName sets the RoleName field's value. func (s *GetRolePolicyOutput) SetRoleName(v string) *GetRolePolicyOutput { s.RoleName = &v return s } type GetSAMLProviderInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the SAML provider resource object in IAM // to get information about. // // For more information about ARNs, see Amazon Resource Names (ARNs) and AWS // Service Namespaces (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/aws-arns-and-namespaces.html) // in the AWS General Reference. // // SAMLProviderArn is a required field SAMLProviderArn *string `min:"20" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s GetSAMLProviderInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s GetSAMLProviderInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *GetSAMLProviderInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetSAMLProviderInput"} if s.SAMLProviderArn == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SAMLProviderArn")) } if s.SAMLProviderArn != nil && len(*s.SAMLProviderArn) < 20 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("SAMLProviderArn", 20)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetSAMLProviderArn sets the SAMLProviderArn field's value. func (s *GetSAMLProviderInput) SetSAMLProviderArn(v string) *GetSAMLProviderInput { s.SAMLProviderArn = &v return s } // Contains the response to a successful GetSAMLProvider request. type GetSAMLProviderOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The date and time when the SAML provider was created. CreateDate *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"` // The XML metadata document that includes information about an identity provider. SAMLMetadataDocument *string `min:"1000" type:"string"` // The expiration date and time for the SAML provider. ValidUntil *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"` } // String returns the string representation func (s GetSAMLProviderOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s GetSAMLProviderOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetCreateDate sets the CreateDate field's value. func (s *GetSAMLProviderOutput) SetCreateDate(v time.Time) *GetSAMLProviderOutput { s.CreateDate = &v return s } // SetSAMLMetadataDocument sets the SAMLMetadataDocument field's value. func (s *GetSAMLProviderOutput) SetSAMLMetadataDocument(v string) *GetSAMLProviderOutput { s.SAMLMetadataDocument = &v return s } // SetValidUntil sets the ValidUntil field's value. func (s *GetSAMLProviderOutput) SetValidUntil(v time.Time) *GetSAMLProviderOutput { s.ValidUntil = &v return s } type GetSSHPublicKeyInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Specifies the public key encoding format to use in the response. To retrieve // the public key in ssh-rsa format, use SSH. To retrieve the public key in // PEM format, use PEM. // // Encoding is a required field Encoding *string `type:"string" required:"true" enum:"encodingType"` // The unique identifier for the SSH public key. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters that can consist of any upper or lowercased letter // or digit. // // SSHPublicKeyId is a required field SSHPublicKeyId *string `min:"20" type:"string" required:"true"` // The name of the IAM user associated with the SSH public key. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- // // UserName is a required field UserName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s GetSSHPublicKeyInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s GetSSHPublicKeyInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *GetSSHPublicKeyInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetSSHPublicKeyInput"} if s.Encoding == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Encoding")) } if s.SSHPublicKeyId == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SSHPublicKeyId")) } if s.SSHPublicKeyId != nil && len(*s.SSHPublicKeyId) < 20 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("SSHPublicKeyId", 20)) } if s.UserName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("UserName")) } if s.UserName != nil && len(*s.UserName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("UserName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetEncoding sets the Encoding field's value. func (s *GetSSHPublicKeyInput) SetEncoding(v string) *GetSSHPublicKeyInput { s.Encoding = &v return s } // SetSSHPublicKeyId sets the SSHPublicKeyId field's value. func (s *GetSSHPublicKeyInput) SetSSHPublicKeyId(v string) *GetSSHPublicKeyInput { s.SSHPublicKeyId = &v return s } // SetUserName sets the UserName field's value. func (s *GetSSHPublicKeyInput) SetUserName(v string) *GetSSHPublicKeyInput { s.UserName = &v return s } // Contains the response to a successful GetSSHPublicKey request. type GetSSHPublicKeyOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A structure containing details about the SSH public key. SSHPublicKey *SSHPublicKey `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s GetSSHPublicKeyOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s GetSSHPublicKeyOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetSSHPublicKey sets the SSHPublicKey field's value. func (s *GetSSHPublicKeyOutput) SetSSHPublicKey(v *SSHPublicKey) *GetSSHPublicKeyOutput { s.SSHPublicKey = v return s } type GetServerCertificateInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name of the server certificate you want to retrieve information about. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- // // ServerCertificateName is a required field ServerCertificateName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s GetServerCertificateInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s GetServerCertificateInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *GetServerCertificateInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetServerCertificateInput"} if s.ServerCertificateName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ServerCertificateName")) } if s.ServerCertificateName != nil && len(*s.ServerCertificateName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("ServerCertificateName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetServerCertificateName sets the ServerCertificateName field's value. func (s *GetServerCertificateInput) SetServerCertificateName(v string) *GetServerCertificateInput { s.ServerCertificateName = &v return s } // Contains the response to a successful GetServerCertificate request. type GetServerCertificateOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A structure containing details about the server certificate. // // ServerCertificate is a required field ServerCertificate *ServerCertificate `type:"structure" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s GetServerCertificateOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s GetServerCertificateOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetServerCertificate sets the ServerCertificate field's value. func (s *GetServerCertificateOutput) SetServerCertificate(v *ServerCertificate) *GetServerCertificateOutput { s.ServerCertificate = v return s } type GetServiceLinkedRoleDeletionStatusInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The deletion task identifier. This identifier is returned by the DeleteServiceLinkedRole // operation in the format task/aws-service-role///. // // DeletionTaskId is a required field DeletionTaskId *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s GetServiceLinkedRoleDeletionStatusInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s GetServiceLinkedRoleDeletionStatusInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *GetServiceLinkedRoleDeletionStatusInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetServiceLinkedRoleDeletionStatusInput"} if s.DeletionTaskId == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DeletionTaskId")) } if s.DeletionTaskId != nil && len(*s.DeletionTaskId) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("DeletionTaskId", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetDeletionTaskId sets the DeletionTaskId field's value. func (s *GetServiceLinkedRoleDeletionStatusInput) SetDeletionTaskId(v string) *GetServiceLinkedRoleDeletionStatusInput { s.DeletionTaskId = &v return s } type GetServiceLinkedRoleDeletionStatusOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // An object that contains details about the reason the deletion failed. Reason *DeletionTaskFailureReasonType `type:"structure"` // The status of the deletion. // // Status is a required field Status *string `type:"string" required:"true" enum:"DeletionTaskStatusType"` } // String returns the string representation func (s GetServiceLinkedRoleDeletionStatusOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s GetServiceLinkedRoleDeletionStatusOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetReason sets the Reason field's value. func (s *GetServiceLinkedRoleDeletionStatusOutput) SetReason(v *DeletionTaskFailureReasonType) *GetServiceLinkedRoleDeletionStatusOutput { s.Reason = v return s } // SetStatus sets the Status field's value. func (s *GetServiceLinkedRoleDeletionStatusOutput) SetStatus(v string) *GetServiceLinkedRoleDeletionStatusOutput { s.Status = &v return s } type GetUserInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name of the user to get information about. // // This parameter is optional. If it is not included, it defaults to the user // making the request. This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- UserName *string `min:"1" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s GetUserInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s GetUserInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *GetUserInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetUserInput"} if s.UserName != nil && len(*s.UserName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("UserName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetUserName sets the UserName field's value. func (s *GetUserInput) SetUserName(v string) *GetUserInput { s.UserName = &v return s } // Contains the response to a successful GetUser request. type GetUserOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A structure containing details about the IAM user. // // User is a required field User *User `type:"structure" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s GetUserOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s GetUserOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetUser sets the User field's value. func (s *GetUserOutput) SetUser(v *User) *GetUserOutput { s.User = v return s } type GetUserPolicyInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name of the policy document to get. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@-+ // // PolicyName is a required field PolicyName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` // The name of the user who the policy is associated with. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- // // UserName is a required field UserName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s GetUserPolicyInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s GetUserPolicyInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *GetUserPolicyInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetUserPolicyInput"} if s.PolicyName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("PolicyName")) } if s.PolicyName != nil && len(*s.PolicyName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("PolicyName", 1)) } if s.UserName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("UserName")) } if s.UserName != nil && len(*s.UserName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("UserName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetPolicyName sets the PolicyName field's value. func (s *GetUserPolicyInput) SetPolicyName(v string) *GetUserPolicyInput { s.PolicyName = &v return s } // SetUserName sets the UserName field's value. func (s *GetUserPolicyInput) SetUserName(v string) *GetUserPolicyInput { s.UserName = &v return s } // Contains the response to a successful GetUserPolicy request. type GetUserPolicyOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The policy document. // // PolicyDocument is a required field PolicyDocument *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` // The name of the policy. // // PolicyName is a required field PolicyName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` // The user the policy is associated with. // // UserName is a required field UserName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s GetUserPolicyOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s GetUserPolicyOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetPolicyDocument sets the PolicyDocument field's value. func (s *GetUserPolicyOutput) SetPolicyDocument(v string) *GetUserPolicyOutput { s.PolicyDocument = &v return s } // SetPolicyName sets the PolicyName field's value. func (s *GetUserPolicyOutput) SetPolicyName(v string) *GetUserPolicyOutput { s.PolicyName = &v return s } // SetUserName sets the UserName field's value. func (s *GetUserPolicyOutput) SetUserName(v string) *GetUserPolicyOutput { s.UserName = &v return s } // Contains information about an IAM group entity. // // This data type is used as a response element in the following actions: // // * CreateGroup // // * GetGroup // // * ListGroups type Group struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) specifying the group. For more information // about ARNs and how to use them in policies, see IAM Identifiers (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/Using_Identifiers.html) // in the Using IAM guide. // // Arn is a required field Arn *string `min:"20" type:"string" required:"true"` // The date and time, in ISO 8601 date-time format (http://www.iso.org/iso/iso8601), // when the group was created. // // CreateDate is a required field CreateDate *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601" required:"true"` // The stable and unique string identifying the group. For more information // about IDs, see IAM Identifiers (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/Using_Identifiers.html) // in the Using IAM guide. // // GroupId is a required field GroupId *string `min:"16" type:"string" required:"true"` // The friendly name that identifies the group. // // GroupName is a required field GroupName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` // The path to the group. For more information about paths, see IAM Identifiers // (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/Using_Identifiers.html) // in the Using IAM guide. // // Path is a required field Path *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s Group) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s Group) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetArn sets the Arn field's value. func (s *Group) SetArn(v string) *Group { s.Arn = &v return s } // SetCreateDate sets the CreateDate field's value. func (s *Group) SetCreateDate(v time.Time) *Group { s.CreateDate = &v return s } // SetGroupId sets the GroupId field's value. func (s *Group) SetGroupId(v string) *Group { s.GroupId = &v return s } // SetGroupName sets the GroupName field's value. func (s *Group) SetGroupName(v string) *Group { s.GroupName = &v return s } // SetPath sets the Path field's value. func (s *Group) SetPath(v string) *Group { s.Path = &v return s } // Contains information about an IAM group, including all of the group's policies. // // This data type is used as a response element in the GetAccountAuthorizationDetails // action. type GroupDetail struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The Amazon Resource Name (ARN). ARNs are unique identifiers for AWS resources. // // For more information about ARNs, go to Amazon Resource Names (ARNs) and AWS // Service Namespaces (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/aws-arns-and-namespaces.html) // in the AWS General Reference. Arn *string `min:"20" type:"string"` // A list of the managed policies attached to the group. AttachedManagedPolicies []*AttachedPolicy `type:"list"` // The date and time, in ISO 8601 date-time format (http://www.iso.org/iso/iso8601), // when the group was created. CreateDate *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"` // The stable and unique string identifying the group. For more information // about IDs, see IAM Identifiers (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/Using_Identifiers.html) // in the Using IAM guide. GroupId *string `min:"16" type:"string"` // The friendly name that identifies the group. GroupName *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // A list of the inline policies embedded in the group. GroupPolicyList []*PolicyDetail `type:"list"` // The path to the group. For more information about paths, see IAM Identifiers // (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/Using_Identifiers.html) // in the Using IAM guide. Path *string `min:"1" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s GroupDetail) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s GroupDetail) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetArn sets the Arn field's value. func (s *GroupDetail) SetArn(v string) *GroupDetail { s.Arn = &v return s } // SetAttachedManagedPolicies sets the AttachedManagedPolicies field's value. func (s *GroupDetail) SetAttachedManagedPolicies(v []*AttachedPolicy) *GroupDetail { s.AttachedManagedPolicies = v return s } // SetCreateDate sets the CreateDate field's value. func (s *GroupDetail) SetCreateDate(v time.Time) *GroupDetail { s.CreateDate = &v return s } // SetGroupId sets the GroupId field's value. func (s *GroupDetail) SetGroupId(v string) *GroupDetail { s.GroupId = &v return s } // SetGroupName sets the GroupName field's value. func (s *GroupDetail) SetGroupName(v string) *GroupDetail { s.GroupName = &v return s } // SetGroupPolicyList sets the GroupPolicyList field's value. func (s *GroupDetail) SetGroupPolicyList(v []*PolicyDetail) *GroupDetail { s.GroupPolicyList = v return s } // SetPath sets the Path field's value. func (s *GroupDetail) SetPath(v string) *GroupDetail { s.Path = &v return s } // Contains information about an instance profile. // // This data type is used as a response element in the following actions: // // * CreateInstanceProfile // // * GetInstanceProfile // // * ListInstanceProfiles // // * ListInstanceProfilesForRole type InstanceProfile struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) specifying the instance profile. For more // information about ARNs and how to use them in policies, see IAM Identifiers // (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/Using_Identifiers.html) // in the Using IAM guide. // // Arn is a required field Arn *string `min:"20" type:"string" required:"true"` // The date when the instance profile was created. // // CreateDate is a required field CreateDate *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601" required:"true"` // The stable and unique string identifying the instance profile. For more information // about IDs, see IAM Identifiers (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/Using_Identifiers.html) // in the Using IAM guide. // // InstanceProfileId is a required field InstanceProfileId *string `min:"16" type:"string" required:"true"` // The name identifying the instance profile. // // InstanceProfileName is a required field InstanceProfileName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` // The path to the instance profile. For more information about paths, see IAM // Identifiers (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/Using_Identifiers.html) // in the Using IAM guide. // // Path is a required field Path *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` // The role associated with the instance profile. // // Roles is a required field Roles []*Role `type:"list" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s InstanceProfile) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s InstanceProfile) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetArn sets the Arn field's value. func (s *InstanceProfile) SetArn(v string) *InstanceProfile { s.Arn = &v return s } // SetCreateDate sets the CreateDate field's value. func (s *InstanceProfile) SetCreateDate(v time.Time) *InstanceProfile { s.CreateDate = &v return s } // SetInstanceProfileId sets the InstanceProfileId field's value. func (s *InstanceProfile) SetInstanceProfileId(v string) *InstanceProfile { s.InstanceProfileId = &v return s } // SetInstanceProfileName sets the InstanceProfileName field's value. func (s *InstanceProfile) SetInstanceProfileName(v string) *InstanceProfile { s.InstanceProfileName = &v return s } // SetPath sets the Path field's value. func (s *InstanceProfile) SetPath(v string) *InstanceProfile { s.Path = &v return s } // SetRoles sets the Roles field's value. func (s *InstanceProfile) SetRoles(v []*Role) *InstanceProfile { s.Roles = v return s } type ListAccessKeysInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Use this parameter only when paginating results and only after you receive // a response indicating that the results are truncated. Set it to the value // of the Marker element in the response that you received to indicate where // the next call should start. Marker *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // (Optional) Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum // number of items you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond // the maximum you specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. // // If you do not include this parameter, it defaults to 100. Note that IAM might // return fewer results, even when there are more results available. In that // case, the IsTruncated response element returns true and Marker contains a // value to include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue // from. MaxItems *int64 `min:"1" type:"integer"` // The name of the user. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- UserName *string `min:"1" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ListAccessKeysInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ListAccessKeysInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *ListAccessKeysInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ListAccessKeysInput"} if s.Marker != nil && len(*s.Marker) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Marker", 1)) } if s.MaxItems != nil && *s.MaxItems < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("MaxItems", 1)) } if s.UserName != nil && len(*s.UserName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("UserName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *ListAccessKeysInput) SetMarker(v string) *ListAccessKeysInput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetMaxItems sets the MaxItems field's value. func (s *ListAccessKeysInput) SetMaxItems(v int64) *ListAccessKeysInput { s.MaxItems = &v return s } // SetUserName sets the UserName field's value. func (s *ListAccessKeysInput) SetUserName(v string) *ListAccessKeysInput { s.UserName = &v return s } // Contains the response to a successful ListAccessKeys request. type ListAccessKeysOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A list of objects containing metadata about the access keys. // // AccessKeyMetadata is a required field AccessKeyMetadata []*AccessKeyMetadata `type:"list" required:"true"` // A flag that indicates whether there are more items to return. If your results // were truncated, you can make a subsequent pagination request using the Marker // request parameter to retrieve more items. Note that IAM might return fewer // than the MaxItems number of results even when there are more results available. // We recommend that you check IsTruncated after every call to ensure that you // receive all of your results. IsTruncated *bool `type:"boolean"` // When IsTruncated is true, this element is present and contains the value // to use for the Marker parameter in a subsequent pagination request. Marker *string `min:"1" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ListAccessKeysOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ListAccessKeysOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetAccessKeyMetadata sets the AccessKeyMetadata field's value. func (s *ListAccessKeysOutput) SetAccessKeyMetadata(v []*AccessKeyMetadata) *ListAccessKeysOutput { s.AccessKeyMetadata = v return s } // SetIsTruncated sets the IsTruncated field's value. func (s *ListAccessKeysOutput) SetIsTruncated(v bool) *ListAccessKeysOutput { s.IsTruncated = &v return s } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *ListAccessKeysOutput) SetMarker(v string) *ListAccessKeysOutput { s.Marker = &v return s } type ListAccountAliasesInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Use this parameter only when paginating results and only after you receive // a response indicating that the results are truncated. Set it to the value // of the Marker element in the response that you received to indicate where // the next call should start. Marker *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // (Optional) Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum // number of items you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond // the maximum you specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. // // If you do not include this parameter, it defaults to 100. Note that IAM might // return fewer results, even when there are more results available. In that // case, the IsTruncated response element returns true and Marker contains a // value to include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue // from. MaxItems *int64 `min:"1" type:"integer"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ListAccountAliasesInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ListAccountAliasesInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *ListAccountAliasesInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ListAccountAliasesInput"} if s.Marker != nil && len(*s.Marker) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Marker", 1)) } if s.MaxItems != nil && *s.MaxItems < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("MaxItems", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *ListAccountAliasesInput) SetMarker(v string) *ListAccountAliasesInput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetMaxItems sets the MaxItems field's value. func (s *ListAccountAliasesInput) SetMaxItems(v int64) *ListAccountAliasesInput { s.MaxItems = &v return s } // Contains the response to a successful ListAccountAliases request. type ListAccountAliasesOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A list of aliases associated with the account. AWS supports only one alias // per account. // // AccountAliases is a required field AccountAliases []*string `type:"list" required:"true"` // A flag that indicates whether there are more items to return. If your results // were truncated, you can make a subsequent pagination request using the Marker // request parameter to retrieve more items. Note that IAM might return fewer // than the MaxItems number of results even when there are more results available. // We recommend that you check IsTruncated after every call to ensure that you // receive all of your results. IsTruncated *bool `type:"boolean"` // When IsTruncated is true, this element is present and contains the value // to use for the Marker parameter in a subsequent pagination request. Marker *string `min:"1" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ListAccountAliasesOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ListAccountAliasesOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetAccountAliases sets the AccountAliases field's value. func (s *ListAccountAliasesOutput) SetAccountAliases(v []*string) *ListAccountAliasesOutput { s.AccountAliases = v return s } // SetIsTruncated sets the IsTruncated field's value. func (s *ListAccountAliasesOutput) SetIsTruncated(v bool) *ListAccountAliasesOutput { s.IsTruncated = &v return s } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *ListAccountAliasesOutput) SetMarker(v string) *ListAccountAliasesOutput { s.Marker = &v return s } type ListAttachedGroupPoliciesInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name (friendly name, not ARN) of the group to list attached policies // for. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- // // GroupName is a required field GroupName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` // Use this parameter only when paginating results and only after you receive // a response indicating that the results are truncated. Set it to the value // of the Marker element in the response that you received to indicate where // the next call should start. Marker *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // (Optional) Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum // number of items you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond // the maximum you specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. // // If you do not include this parameter, it defaults to 100. Note that IAM might // return fewer results, even when there are more results available. In that // case, the IsTruncated response element returns true and Marker contains a // value to include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue // from. MaxItems *int64 `min:"1" type:"integer"` // The path prefix for filtering the results. This parameter is optional. If // it is not included, it defaults to a slash (/), listing all policies. // // This paramater allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of either a forward slash (/) by itself // or a string that must begin and end with forward slashes, containing any // ASCII character from the ! (\u0021) thru the DEL character (\u007F), including // most punctuation characters, digits, and upper and lowercased letters. PathPrefix *string `type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ListAttachedGroupPoliciesInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ListAttachedGroupPoliciesInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *ListAttachedGroupPoliciesInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ListAttachedGroupPoliciesInput"} if s.GroupName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("GroupName")) } if s.GroupName != nil && len(*s.GroupName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("GroupName", 1)) } if s.Marker != nil && len(*s.Marker) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Marker", 1)) } if s.MaxItems != nil && *s.MaxItems < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("MaxItems", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetGroupName sets the GroupName field's value. func (s *ListAttachedGroupPoliciesInput) SetGroupName(v string) *ListAttachedGroupPoliciesInput { s.GroupName = &v return s } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *ListAttachedGroupPoliciesInput) SetMarker(v string) *ListAttachedGroupPoliciesInput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetMaxItems sets the MaxItems field's value. func (s *ListAttachedGroupPoliciesInput) SetMaxItems(v int64) *ListAttachedGroupPoliciesInput { s.MaxItems = &v return s } // SetPathPrefix sets the PathPrefix field's value. func (s *ListAttachedGroupPoliciesInput) SetPathPrefix(v string) *ListAttachedGroupPoliciesInput { s.PathPrefix = &v return s } // Contains the response to a successful ListAttachedGroupPolicies request. type ListAttachedGroupPoliciesOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A list of the attached policies. AttachedPolicies []*AttachedPolicy `type:"list"` // A flag that indicates whether there are more items to return. If your results // were truncated, you can make a subsequent pagination request using the Marker // request parameter to retrieve more items. Note that IAM might return fewer // than the MaxItems number of results even when there are more results available. // We recommend that you check IsTruncated after every call to ensure that you // receive all of your results. IsTruncated *bool `type:"boolean"` // When IsTruncated is true, this element is present and contains the value // to use for the Marker parameter in a subsequent pagination request. Marker *string `min:"1" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ListAttachedGroupPoliciesOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ListAttachedGroupPoliciesOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetAttachedPolicies sets the AttachedPolicies field's value. func (s *ListAttachedGroupPoliciesOutput) SetAttachedPolicies(v []*AttachedPolicy) *ListAttachedGroupPoliciesOutput { s.AttachedPolicies = v return s } // SetIsTruncated sets the IsTruncated field's value. func (s *ListAttachedGroupPoliciesOutput) SetIsTruncated(v bool) *ListAttachedGroupPoliciesOutput { s.IsTruncated = &v return s } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *ListAttachedGroupPoliciesOutput) SetMarker(v string) *ListAttachedGroupPoliciesOutput { s.Marker = &v return s } type ListAttachedRolePoliciesInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Use this parameter only when paginating results and only after you receive // a response indicating that the results are truncated. Set it to the value // of the Marker element in the response that you received to indicate where // the next call should start. Marker *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // (Optional) Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum // number of items you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond // the maximum you specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. // // If you do not include this parameter, it defaults to 100. Note that IAM might // return fewer results, even when there are more results available. In that // case, the IsTruncated response element returns true and Marker contains a // value to include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue // from. MaxItems *int64 `min:"1" type:"integer"` // The path prefix for filtering the results. This parameter is optional. If // it is not included, it defaults to a slash (/), listing all policies. // // This paramater allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of either a forward slash (/) by itself // or a string that must begin and end with forward slashes, containing any // ASCII character from the ! (\u0021) thru the DEL character (\u007F), including // most punctuation characters, digits, and upper and lowercased letters. PathPrefix *string `type:"string"` // The name (friendly name, not ARN) of the role to list attached policies for. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@- // // RoleName is a required field RoleName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ListAttachedRolePoliciesInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ListAttachedRolePoliciesInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *ListAttachedRolePoliciesInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ListAttachedRolePoliciesInput"} if s.Marker != nil && len(*s.Marker) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Marker", 1)) } if s.MaxItems != nil && *s.MaxItems < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("MaxItems", 1)) } if s.RoleName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("RoleName")) } if s.RoleName != nil && len(*s.RoleName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("RoleName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *ListAttachedRolePoliciesInput) SetMarker(v string) *ListAttachedRolePoliciesInput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetMaxItems sets the MaxItems field's value. func (s *ListAttachedRolePoliciesInput) SetMaxItems(v int64) *ListAttachedRolePoliciesInput { s.MaxItems = &v return s } // SetPathPrefix sets the PathPrefix field's value. func (s *ListAttachedRolePoliciesInput) SetPathPrefix(v string) *ListAttachedRolePoliciesInput { s.PathPrefix = &v return s } // SetRoleName sets the RoleName field's value. func (s *ListAttachedRolePoliciesInput) SetRoleName(v string) *ListAttachedRolePoliciesInput { s.RoleName = &v return s } // Contains the response to a successful ListAttachedRolePolicies request. type ListAttachedRolePoliciesOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A list of the attached policies. AttachedPolicies []*AttachedPolicy `type:"list"` // A flag that indicates whether there are more items to return. If your results // were truncated, you can make a subsequent pagination request using the Marker // request parameter to retrieve more items. Note that IAM might return fewer // than the MaxItems number of results even when there are more results available. // We recommend that you check IsTruncated after every call to ensure that you // receive all of your results. IsTruncated *bool `type:"boolean"` // When IsTruncated is true, this element is present and contains the value // to use for the Marker parameter in a subsequent pagination request. Marker *string `min:"1" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ListAttachedRolePoliciesOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ListAttachedRolePoliciesOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetAttachedPolicies sets the AttachedPolicies field's value. func (s *ListAttachedRolePoliciesOutput) SetAttachedPolicies(v []*AttachedPolicy) *ListAttachedRolePoliciesOutput { s.AttachedPolicies = v return s } // SetIsTruncated sets the IsTruncated field's value. func (s *ListAttachedRolePoliciesOutput) SetIsTruncated(v bool) *ListAttachedRolePoliciesOutput { s.IsTruncated = &v return s } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *ListAttachedRolePoliciesOutput) SetMarker(v string) *ListAttachedRolePoliciesOutput { s.Marker = &v return s } type ListAttachedUserPoliciesInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Use this parameter only when paginating results and only after you receive // a response indicating that the results are truncated. Set it to the value // of the Marker element in the response that you received to indicate where // the next call should start. Marker *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // (Optional) Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum // number of items you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond // the maximum you specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. // // If you do not include this parameter, it defaults to 100. Note that IAM might // return fewer results, even when there are more results available. In that // case, the IsTruncated response element returns true and Marker contains a // value to include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue // from. MaxItems *int64 `min:"1" type:"integer"` // The path prefix for filtering the results. This parameter is optional. If // it is not included, it defaults to a slash (/), listing all policies. // // This paramater allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of either a forward slash (/) by itself // or a string that must begin and end with forward slashes, containing any // ASCII character from the ! (\u0021) thru the DEL character (\u007F), including // most punctuation characters, digits, and upper and lowercased letters. PathPrefix *string `type:"string"` // The name (friendly name, not ARN) of the user to list attached policies for. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- // // UserName is a required field UserName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ListAttachedUserPoliciesInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ListAttachedUserPoliciesInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *ListAttachedUserPoliciesInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ListAttachedUserPoliciesInput"} if s.Marker != nil && len(*s.Marker) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Marker", 1)) } if s.MaxItems != nil && *s.MaxItems < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("MaxItems", 1)) } if s.UserName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("UserName")) } if s.UserName != nil && len(*s.UserName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("UserName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *ListAttachedUserPoliciesInput) SetMarker(v string) *ListAttachedUserPoliciesInput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetMaxItems sets the MaxItems field's value. func (s *ListAttachedUserPoliciesInput) SetMaxItems(v int64) *ListAttachedUserPoliciesInput { s.MaxItems = &v return s } // SetPathPrefix sets the PathPrefix field's value. func (s *ListAttachedUserPoliciesInput) SetPathPrefix(v string) *ListAttachedUserPoliciesInput { s.PathPrefix = &v return s } // SetUserName sets the UserName field's value. func (s *ListAttachedUserPoliciesInput) SetUserName(v string) *ListAttachedUserPoliciesInput { s.UserName = &v return s } // Contains the response to a successful ListAttachedUserPolicies request. type ListAttachedUserPoliciesOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A list of the attached policies. AttachedPolicies []*AttachedPolicy `type:"list"` // A flag that indicates whether there are more items to return. If your results // were truncated, you can make a subsequent pagination request using the Marker // request parameter to retrieve more items. Note that IAM might return fewer // than the MaxItems number of results even when there are more results available. // We recommend that you check IsTruncated after every call to ensure that you // receive all of your results. IsTruncated *bool `type:"boolean"` // When IsTruncated is true, this element is present and contains the value // to use for the Marker parameter in a subsequent pagination request. Marker *string `min:"1" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ListAttachedUserPoliciesOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ListAttachedUserPoliciesOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetAttachedPolicies sets the AttachedPolicies field's value. func (s *ListAttachedUserPoliciesOutput) SetAttachedPolicies(v []*AttachedPolicy) *ListAttachedUserPoliciesOutput { s.AttachedPolicies = v return s } // SetIsTruncated sets the IsTruncated field's value. func (s *ListAttachedUserPoliciesOutput) SetIsTruncated(v bool) *ListAttachedUserPoliciesOutput { s.IsTruncated = &v return s } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *ListAttachedUserPoliciesOutput) SetMarker(v string) *ListAttachedUserPoliciesOutput { s.Marker = &v return s } type ListEntitiesForPolicyInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The entity type to use for filtering the results. // // For example, when EntityFilter is Role, only the roles that are attached // to the specified policy are returned. This parameter is optional. If it is // not included, all attached entities (users, groups, and roles) are returned. // The argument for this parameter must be one of the valid values listed below. EntityFilter *string `type:"string" enum:"EntityType"` // Use this parameter only when paginating results and only after you receive // a response indicating that the results are truncated. Set it to the value // of the Marker element in the response that you received to indicate where // the next call should start. Marker *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // (Optional) Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum // number of items you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond // the maximum you specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. // // If you do not include this parameter, it defaults to 100. Note that IAM might // return fewer results, even when there are more results available. In that // case, the IsTruncated response element returns true and Marker contains a // value to include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue // from. MaxItems *int64 `min:"1" type:"integer"` // The path prefix for filtering the results. This parameter is optional. If // it is not included, it defaults to a slash (/), listing all entities. // // This paramater allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of either a forward slash (/) by itself // or a string that must begin and end with forward slashes, containing any // ASCII character from the ! (\u0021) thru the DEL character (\u007F), including // most punctuation characters, digits, and upper and lowercased letters. PathPrefix *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the IAM policy for which you want the versions. // // For more information about ARNs, see Amazon Resource Names (ARNs) and AWS // Service Namespaces (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/aws-arns-and-namespaces.html) // in the AWS General Reference. // // PolicyArn is a required field PolicyArn *string `min:"20" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ListEntitiesForPolicyInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ListEntitiesForPolicyInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *ListEntitiesForPolicyInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ListEntitiesForPolicyInput"} if s.Marker != nil && len(*s.Marker) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Marker", 1)) } if s.MaxItems != nil && *s.MaxItems < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("MaxItems", 1)) } if s.PathPrefix != nil && len(*s.PathPrefix) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("PathPrefix", 1)) } if s.PolicyArn == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("PolicyArn")) } if s.PolicyArn != nil && len(*s.PolicyArn) < 20 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("PolicyArn", 20)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetEntityFilter sets the EntityFilter field's value. func (s *ListEntitiesForPolicyInput) SetEntityFilter(v string) *ListEntitiesForPolicyInput { s.EntityFilter = &v return s } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *ListEntitiesForPolicyInput) SetMarker(v string) *ListEntitiesForPolicyInput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetMaxItems sets the MaxItems field's value. func (s *ListEntitiesForPolicyInput) SetMaxItems(v int64) *ListEntitiesForPolicyInput { s.MaxItems = &v return s } // SetPathPrefix sets the PathPrefix field's value. func (s *ListEntitiesForPolicyInput) SetPathPrefix(v string) *ListEntitiesForPolicyInput { s.PathPrefix = &v return s } // SetPolicyArn sets the PolicyArn field's value. func (s *ListEntitiesForPolicyInput) SetPolicyArn(v string) *ListEntitiesForPolicyInput { s.PolicyArn = &v return s } // Contains the response to a successful ListEntitiesForPolicy request. type ListEntitiesForPolicyOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A flag that indicates whether there are more items to return. If your results // were truncated, you can make a subsequent pagination request using the Marker // request parameter to retrieve more items. Note that IAM might return fewer // than the MaxItems number of results even when there are more results available. // We recommend that you check IsTruncated after every call to ensure that you // receive all of your results. IsTruncated *bool `type:"boolean"` // When IsTruncated is true, this element is present and contains the value // to use for the Marker parameter in a subsequent pagination request. Marker *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // A list of IAM groups that the policy is attached to. PolicyGroups []*PolicyGroup `type:"list"` // A list of IAM roles that the policy is attached to. PolicyRoles []*PolicyRole `type:"list"` // A list of IAM users that the policy is attached to. PolicyUsers []*PolicyUser `type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ListEntitiesForPolicyOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ListEntitiesForPolicyOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetIsTruncated sets the IsTruncated field's value. func (s *ListEntitiesForPolicyOutput) SetIsTruncated(v bool) *ListEntitiesForPolicyOutput { s.IsTruncated = &v return s } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *ListEntitiesForPolicyOutput) SetMarker(v string) *ListEntitiesForPolicyOutput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetPolicyGroups sets the PolicyGroups field's value. func (s *ListEntitiesForPolicyOutput) SetPolicyGroups(v []*PolicyGroup) *ListEntitiesForPolicyOutput { s.PolicyGroups = v return s } // SetPolicyRoles sets the PolicyRoles field's value. func (s *ListEntitiesForPolicyOutput) SetPolicyRoles(v []*PolicyRole) *ListEntitiesForPolicyOutput { s.PolicyRoles = v return s } // SetPolicyUsers sets the PolicyUsers field's value. func (s *ListEntitiesForPolicyOutput) SetPolicyUsers(v []*PolicyUser) *ListEntitiesForPolicyOutput { s.PolicyUsers = v return s } type ListGroupPoliciesInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name of the group to list policies for. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- // // GroupName is a required field GroupName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` // Use this parameter only when paginating results and only after you receive // a response indicating that the results are truncated. Set it to the value // of the Marker element in the response that you received to indicate where // the next call should start. Marker *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // (Optional) Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum // number of items you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond // the maximum you specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. // // If you do not include this parameter, it defaults to 100. Note that IAM might // return fewer results, even when there are more results available. In that // case, the IsTruncated response element returns true and Marker contains a // value to include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue // from. MaxItems *int64 `min:"1" type:"integer"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ListGroupPoliciesInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ListGroupPoliciesInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *ListGroupPoliciesInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ListGroupPoliciesInput"} if s.GroupName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("GroupName")) } if s.GroupName != nil && len(*s.GroupName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("GroupName", 1)) } if s.Marker != nil && len(*s.Marker) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Marker", 1)) } if s.MaxItems != nil && *s.MaxItems < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("MaxItems", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetGroupName sets the GroupName field's value. func (s *ListGroupPoliciesInput) SetGroupName(v string) *ListGroupPoliciesInput { s.GroupName = &v return s } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *ListGroupPoliciesInput) SetMarker(v string) *ListGroupPoliciesInput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetMaxItems sets the MaxItems field's value. func (s *ListGroupPoliciesInput) SetMaxItems(v int64) *ListGroupPoliciesInput { s.MaxItems = &v return s } // Contains the response to a successful ListGroupPolicies request. type ListGroupPoliciesOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A flag that indicates whether there are more items to return. If your results // were truncated, you can make a subsequent pagination request using the Marker // request parameter to retrieve more items. Note that IAM might return fewer // than the MaxItems number of results even when there are more results available. // We recommend that you check IsTruncated after every call to ensure that you // receive all of your results. IsTruncated *bool `type:"boolean"` // When IsTruncated is true, this element is present and contains the value // to use for the Marker parameter in a subsequent pagination request. Marker *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // A list of policy names. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@-+ // // PolicyNames is a required field PolicyNames []*string `type:"list" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ListGroupPoliciesOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ListGroupPoliciesOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetIsTruncated sets the IsTruncated field's value. func (s *ListGroupPoliciesOutput) SetIsTruncated(v bool) *ListGroupPoliciesOutput { s.IsTruncated = &v return s } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *ListGroupPoliciesOutput) SetMarker(v string) *ListGroupPoliciesOutput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetPolicyNames sets the PolicyNames field's value. func (s *ListGroupPoliciesOutput) SetPolicyNames(v []*string) *ListGroupPoliciesOutput { s.PolicyNames = v return s } type ListGroupsForUserInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Use this parameter only when paginating results and only after you receive // a response indicating that the results are truncated. Set it to the value // of the Marker element in the response that you received to indicate where // the next call should start. Marker *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // (Optional) Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum // number of items you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond // the maximum you specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. // // If you do not include this parameter, it defaults to 100. Note that IAM might // return fewer results, even when there are more results available. In that // case, the IsTruncated response element returns true and Marker contains a // value to include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue // from. MaxItems *int64 `min:"1" type:"integer"` // The name of the user to list groups for. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- // // UserName is a required field UserName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ListGroupsForUserInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ListGroupsForUserInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *ListGroupsForUserInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ListGroupsForUserInput"} if s.Marker != nil && len(*s.Marker) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Marker", 1)) } if s.MaxItems != nil && *s.MaxItems < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("MaxItems", 1)) } if s.UserName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("UserName")) } if s.UserName != nil && len(*s.UserName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("UserName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *ListGroupsForUserInput) SetMarker(v string) *ListGroupsForUserInput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetMaxItems sets the MaxItems field's value. func (s *ListGroupsForUserInput) SetMaxItems(v int64) *ListGroupsForUserInput { s.MaxItems = &v return s } // SetUserName sets the UserName field's value. func (s *ListGroupsForUserInput) SetUserName(v string) *ListGroupsForUserInput { s.UserName = &v return s } // Contains the response to a successful ListGroupsForUser request. type ListGroupsForUserOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A list of groups. // // Groups is a required field Groups []*Group `type:"list" required:"true"` // A flag that indicates whether there are more items to return. If your results // were truncated, you can make a subsequent pagination request using the Marker // request parameter to retrieve more items. Note that IAM might return fewer // than the MaxItems number of results even when there are more results available. // We recommend that you check IsTruncated after every call to ensure that you // receive all of your results. IsTruncated *bool `type:"boolean"` // When IsTruncated is true, this element is present and contains the value // to use for the Marker parameter in a subsequent pagination request. Marker *string `min:"1" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ListGroupsForUserOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ListGroupsForUserOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetGroups sets the Groups field's value. func (s *ListGroupsForUserOutput) SetGroups(v []*Group) *ListGroupsForUserOutput { s.Groups = v return s } // SetIsTruncated sets the IsTruncated field's value. func (s *ListGroupsForUserOutput) SetIsTruncated(v bool) *ListGroupsForUserOutput { s.IsTruncated = &v return s } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *ListGroupsForUserOutput) SetMarker(v string) *ListGroupsForUserOutput { s.Marker = &v return s } type ListGroupsInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Use this parameter only when paginating results and only after you receive // a response indicating that the results are truncated. Set it to the value // of the Marker element in the response that you received to indicate where // the next call should start. Marker *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // (Optional) Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum // number of items you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond // the maximum you specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. // // If you do not include this parameter, it defaults to 100. Note that IAM might // return fewer results, even when there are more results available. In that // case, the IsTruncated response element returns true and Marker contains a // value to include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue // from. MaxItems *int64 `min:"1" type:"integer"` // The path prefix for filtering the results. For example, the prefix /division_abc/subdivision_xyz/ // gets all groups whose path starts with /division_abc/subdivision_xyz/. // // This parameter is optional. If it is not included, it defaults to a slash // (/), listing all groups. This paramater allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of either a forward slash (/) by itself // or a string that must begin and end with forward slashes, containing any // ASCII character from the ! (\u0021) thru the DEL character (\u007F), including // most punctuation characters, digits, and upper and lowercased letters. PathPrefix *string `min:"1" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ListGroupsInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ListGroupsInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *ListGroupsInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ListGroupsInput"} if s.Marker != nil && len(*s.Marker) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Marker", 1)) } if s.MaxItems != nil && *s.MaxItems < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("MaxItems", 1)) } if s.PathPrefix != nil && len(*s.PathPrefix) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("PathPrefix", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *ListGroupsInput) SetMarker(v string) *ListGroupsInput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetMaxItems sets the MaxItems field's value. func (s *ListGroupsInput) SetMaxItems(v int64) *ListGroupsInput { s.MaxItems = &v return s } // SetPathPrefix sets the PathPrefix field's value. func (s *ListGroupsInput) SetPathPrefix(v string) *ListGroupsInput { s.PathPrefix = &v return s } // Contains the response to a successful ListGroups request. type ListGroupsOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A list of groups. // // Groups is a required field Groups []*Group `type:"list" required:"true"` // A flag that indicates whether there are more items to return. If your results // were truncated, you can make a subsequent pagination request using the Marker // request parameter to retrieve more items. Note that IAM might return fewer // than the MaxItems number of results even when there are more results available. // We recommend that you check IsTruncated after every call to ensure that you // receive all of your results. IsTruncated *bool `type:"boolean"` // When IsTruncated is true, this element is present and contains the value // to use for the Marker parameter in a subsequent pagination request. Marker *string `min:"1" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ListGroupsOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ListGroupsOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetGroups sets the Groups field's value. func (s *ListGroupsOutput) SetGroups(v []*Group) *ListGroupsOutput { s.Groups = v return s } // SetIsTruncated sets the IsTruncated field's value. func (s *ListGroupsOutput) SetIsTruncated(v bool) *ListGroupsOutput { s.IsTruncated = &v return s } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *ListGroupsOutput) SetMarker(v string) *ListGroupsOutput { s.Marker = &v return s } type ListInstanceProfilesForRoleInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Use this parameter only when paginating results and only after you receive // a response indicating that the results are truncated. Set it to the value // of the Marker element in the response that you received to indicate where // the next call should start. Marker *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // (Optional) Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum // number of items you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond // the maximum you specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. // // If you do not include this parameter, it defaults to 100. Note that IAM might // return fewer results, even when there are more results available. In that // case, the IsTruncated response element returns true and Marker contains a // value to include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue // from. MaxItems *int64 `min:"1" type:"integer"` // The name of the role to list instance profiles for. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@- // // RoleName is a required field RoleName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ListInstanceProfilesForRoleInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ListInstanceProfilesForRoleInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *ListInstanceProfilesForRoleInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ListInstanceProfilesForRoleInput"} if s.Marker != nil && len(*s.Marker) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Marker", 1)) } if s.MaxItems != nil && *s.MaxItems < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("MaxItems", 1)) } if s.RoleName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("RoleName")) } if s.RoleName != nil && len(*s.RoleName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("RoleName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *ListInstanceProfilesForRoleInput) SetMarker(v string) *ListInstanceProfilesForRoleInput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetMaxItems sets the MaxItems field's value. func (s *ListInstanceProfilesForRoleInput) SetMaxItems(v int64) *ListInstanceProfilesForRoleInput { s.MaxItems = &v return s } // SetRoleName sets the RoleName field's value. func (s *ListInstanceProfilesForRoleInput) SetRoleName(v string) *ListInstanceProfilesForRoleInput { s.RoleName = &v return s } // Contains the response to a successful ListInstanceProfilesForRole request. type ListInstanceProfilesForRoleOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A list of instance profiles. // // InstanceProfiles is a required field InstanceProfiles []*InstanceProfile `type:"list" required:"true"` // A flag that indicates whether there are more items to return. If your results // were truncated, you can make a subsequent pagination request using the Marker // request parameter to retrieve more items. Note that IAM might return fewer // than the MaxItems number of results even when there are more results available. // We recommend that you check IsTruncated after every call to ensure that you // receive all of your results. IsTruncated *bool `type:"boolean"` // When IsTruncated is true, this element is present and contains the value // to use for the Marker parameter in a subsequent pagination request. Marker *string `min:"1" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ListInstanceProfilesForRoleOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ListInstanceProfilesForRoleOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetInstanceProfiles sets the InstanceProfiles field's value. func (s *ListInstanceProfilesForRoleOutput) SetInstanceProfiles(v []*InstanceProfile) *ListInstanceProfilesForRoleOutput { s.InstanceProfiles = v return s } // SetIsTruncated sets the IsTruncated field's value. func (s *ListInstanceProfilesForRoleOutput) SetIsTruncated(v bool) *ListInstanceProfilesForRoleOutput { s.IsTruncated = &v return s } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *ListInstanceProfilesForRoleOutput) SetMarker(v string) *ListInstanceProfilesForRoleOutput { s.Marker = &v return s } type ListInstanceProfilesInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Use this parameter only when paginating results and only after you receive // a response indicating that the results are truncated. Set it to the value // of the Marker element in the response that you received to indicate where // the next call should start. Marker *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // (Optional) Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum // number of items you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond // the maximum you specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. // // If you do not include this parameter, it defaults to 100. Note that IAM might // return fewer results, even when there are more results available. In that // case, the IsTruncated response element returns true and Marker contains a // value to include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue // from. MaxItems *int64 `min:"1" type:"integer"` // The path prefix for filtering the results. For example, the prefix /application_abc/component_xyz/ // gets all instance profiles whose path starts with /application_abc/component_xyz/. // // This parameter is optional. If it is not included, it defaults to a slash // (/), listing all instance profiles. This paramater allows (per its regex // pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters consisting // of either a forward slash (/) by itself or a string that must begin and end // with forward slashes, containing any ASCII character from the ! (\u0021) // thru the DEL character (\u007F), including most punctuation characters, digits, // and upper and lowercased letters. PathPrefix *string `min:"1" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ListInstanceProfilesInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ListInstanceProfilesInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *ListInstanceProfilesInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ListInstanceProfilesInput"} if s.Marker != nil && len(*s.Marker) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Marker", 1)) } if s.MaxItems != nil && *s.MaxItems < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("MaxItems", 1)) } if s.PathPrefix != nil && len(*s.PathPrefix) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("PathPrefix", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *ListInstanceProfilesInput) SetMarker(v string) *ListInstanceProfilesInput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetMaxItems sets the MaxItems field's value. func (s *ListInstanceProfilesInput) SetMaxItems(v int64) *ListInstanceProfilesInput { s.MaxItems = &v return s } // SetPathPrefix sets the PathPrefix field's value. func (s *ListInstanceProfilesInput) SetPathPrefix(v string) *ListInstanceProfilesInput { s.PathPrefix = &v return s } // Contains the response to a successful ListInstanceProfiles request. type ListInstanceProfilesOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A list of instance profiles. // // InstanceProfiles is a required field InstanceProfiles []*InstanceProfile `type:"list" required:"true"` // A flag that indicates whether there are more items to return. If your results // were truncated, you can make a subsequent pagination request using the Marker // request parameter to retrieve more items. Note that IAM might return fewer // than the MaxItems number of results even when there are more results available. // We recommend that you check IsTruncated after every call to ensure that you // receive all of your results. IsTruncated *bool `type:"boolean"` // When IsTruncated is true, this element is present and contains the value // to use for the Marker parameter in a subsequent pagination request. Marker *string `min:"1" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ListInstanceProfilesOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ListInstanceProfilesOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetInstanceProfiles sets the InstanceProfiles field's value. func (s *ListInstanceProfilesOutput) SetInstanceProfiles(v []*InstanceProfile) *ListInstanceProfilesOutput { s.InstanceProfiles = v return s } // SetIsTruncated sets the IsTruncated field's value. func (s *ListInstanceProfilesOutput) SetIsTruncated(v bool) *ListInstanceProfilesOutput { s.IsTruncated = &v return s } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *ListInstanceProfilesOutput) SetMarker(v string) *ListInstanceProfilesOutput { s.Marker = &v return s } type ListMFADevicesInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Use this parameter only when paginating results and only after you receive // a response indicating that the results are truncated. Set it to the value // of the Marker element in the response that you received to indicate where // the next call should start. Marker *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // (Optional) Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum // number of items you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond // the maximum you specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. // // If you do not include this parameter, it defaults to 100. Note that IAM might // return fewer results, even when there are more results available. In that // case, the IsTruncated response element returns true and Marker contains a // value to include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue // from. MaxItems *int64 `min:"1" type:"integer"` // The name of the user whose MFA devices you want to list. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- UserName *string `min:"1" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ListMFADevicesInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ListMFADevicesInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *ListMFADevicesInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ListMFADevicesInput"} if s.Marker != nil && len(*s.Marker) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Marker", 1)) } if s.MaxItems != nil && *s.MaxItems < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("MaxItems", 1)) } if s.UserName != nil && len(*s.UserName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("UserName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *ListMFADevicesInput) SetMarker(v string) *ListMFADevicesInput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetMaxItems sets the MaxItems field's value. func (s *ListMFADevicesInput) SetMaxItems(v int64) *ListMFADevicesInput { s.MaxItems = &v return s } // SetUserName sets the UserName field's value. func (s *ListMFADevicesInput) SetUserName(v string) *ListMFADevicesInput { s.UserName = &v return s } // Contains the response to a successful ListMFADevices request. type ListMFADevicesOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A flag that indicates whether there are more items to return. If your results // were truncated, you can make a subsequent pagination request using the Marker // request parameter to retrieve more items. Note that IAM might return fewer // than the MaxItems number of results even when there are more results available. // We recommend that you check IsTruncated after every call to ensure that you // receive all of your results. IsTruncated *bool `type:"boolean"` // A list of MFA devices. // // MFADevices is a required field MFADevices []*MFADevice `type:"list" required:"true"` // When IsTruncated is true, this element is present and contains the value // to use for the Marker parameter in a subsequent pagination request. Marker *string `min:"1" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ListMFADevicesOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ListMFADevicesOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetIsTruncated sets the IsTruncated field's value. func (s *ListMFADevicesOutput) SetIsTruncated(v bool) *ListMFADevicesOutput { s.IsTruncated = &v return s } // SetMFADevices sets the MFADevices field's value. func (s *ListMFADevicesOutput) SetMFADevices(v []*MFADevice) *ListMFADevicesOutput { s.MFADevices = v return s } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *ListMFADevicesOutput) SetMarker(v string) *ListMFADevicesOutput { s.Marker = &v return s } type ListOpenIDConnectProvidersInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ListOpenIDConnectProvidersInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ListOpenIDConnectProvidersInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Contains the response to a successful ListOpenIDConnectProviders request. type ListOpenIDConnectProvidersOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The list of IAM OIDC provider resource objects defined in the AWS account. OpenIDConnectProviderList []*OpenIDConnectProviderListEntry `type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ListOpenIDConnectProvidersOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ListOpenIDConnectProvidersOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetOpenIDConnectProviderList sets the OpenIDConnectProviderList field's value. func (s *ListOpenIDConnectProvidersOutput) SetOpenIDConnectProviderList(v []*OpenIDConnectProviderListEntry) *ListOpenIDConnectProvidersOutput { s.OpenIDConnectProviderList = v return s } type ListPoliciesInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Use this parameter only when paginating results and only after you receive // a response indicating that the results are truncated. Set it to the value // of the Marker element in the response that you received to indicate where // the next call should start. Marker *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // (Optional) Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum // number of items you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond // the maximum you specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. // // If you do not include this parameter, it defaults to 100. Note that IAM might // return fewer results, even when there are more results available. In that // case, the IsTruncated response element returns true and Marker contains a // value to include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue // from. MaxItems *int64 `min:"1" type:"integer"` // A flag to filter the results to only the attached policies. // // When OnlyAttached is true, the returned list contains only the policies that // are attached to an IAM user, group, or role. When OnlyAttached is false, // or when the parameter is not included, all policies are returned. OnlyAttached *bool `type:"boolean"` // The path prefix for filtering the results. This parameter is optional. If // it is not included, it defaults to a slash (/), listing all policies. This // paramater allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of either a forward slash (/) by itself // or a string that must begin and end with forward slashes, containing any // ASCII character from the ! (\u0021) thru the DEL character (\u007F), including // most punctuation characters, digits, and upper and lowercased letters. PathPrefix *string `type:"string"` // The scope to use for filtering the results. // // To list only AWS managed policies, set Scope to AWS. To list only the customer // managed policies in your AWS account, set Scope to Local. // // This parameter is optional. If it is not included, or if it is set to All, // all policies are returned. Scope *string `type:"string" enum:"policyScopeType"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ListPoliciesInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ListPoliciesInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *ListPoliciesInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ListPoliciesInput"} if s.Marker != nil && len(*s.Marker) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Marker", 1)) } if s.MaxItems != nil && *s.MaxItems < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("MaxItems", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *ListPoliciesInput) SetMarker(v string) *ListPoliciesInput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetMaxItems sets the MaxItems field's value. func (s *ListPoliciesInput) SetMaxItems(v int64) *ListPoliciesInput { s.MaxItems = &v return s } // SetOnlyAttached sets the OnlyAttached field's value. func (s *ListPoliciesInput) SetOnlyAttached(v bool) *ListPoliciesInput { s.OnlyAttached = &v return s } // SetPathPrefix sets the PathPrefix field's value. func (s *ListPoliciesInput) SetPathPrefix(v string) *ListPoliciesInput { s.PathPrefix = &v return s } // SetScope sets the Scope field's value. func (s *ListPoliciesInput) SetScope(v string) *ListPoliciesInput { s.Scope = &v return s } // Contains the response to a successful ListPolicies request. type ListPoliciesOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A flag that indicates whether there are more items to return. If your results // were truncated, you can make a subsequent pagination request using the Marker // request parameter to retrieve more items. Note that IAM might return fewer // than the MaxItems number of results even when there are more results available. // We recommend that you check IsTruncated after every call to ensure that you // receive all of your results. IsTruncated *bool `type:"boolean"` // When IsTruncated is true, this element is present and contains the value // to use for the Marker parameter in a subsequent pagination request. Marker *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // A list of policies. Policies []*Policy `type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ListPoliciesOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ListPoliciesOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetIsTruncated sets the IsTruncated field's value. func (s *ListPoliciesOutput) SetIsTruncated(v bool) *ListPoliciesOutput { s.IsTruncated = &v return s } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *ListPoliciesOutput) SetMarker(v string) *ListPoliciesOutput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetPolicies sets the Policies field's value. func (s *ListPoliciesOutput) SetPolicies(v []*Policy) *ListPoliciesOutput { s.Policies = v return s } type ListPolicyVersionsInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Use this parameter only when paginating results and only after you receive // a response indicating that the results are truncated. Set it to the value // of the Marker element in the response that you received to indicate where // the next call should start. Marker *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // (Optional) Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum // number of items you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond // the maximum you specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. // // If you do not include this parameter, it defaults to 100. Note that IAM might // return fewer results, even when there are more results available. In that // case, the IsTruncated response element returns true and Marker contains a // value to include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue // from. MaxItems *int64 `min:"1" type:"integer"` // The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the IAM policy for which you want the versions. // // For more information about ARNs, see Amazon Resource Names (ARNs) and AWS // Service Namespaces (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/aws-arns-and-namespaces.html) // in the AWS General Reference. // // PolicyArn is a required field PolicyArn *string `min:"20" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ListPolicyVersionsInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ListPolicyVersionsInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *ListPolicyVersionsInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ListPolicyVersionsInput"} if s.Marker != nil && len(*s.Marker) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Marker", 1)) } if s.MaxItems != nil && *s.MaxItems < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("MaxItems", 1)) } if s.PolicyArn == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("PolicyArn")) } if s.PolicyArn != nil && len(*s.PolicyArn) < 20 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("PolicyArn", 20)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *ListPolicyVersionsInput) SetMarker(v string) *ListPolicyVersionsInput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetMaxItems sets the MaxItems field's value. func (s *ListPolicyVersionsInput) SetMaxItems(v int64) *ListPolicyVersionsInput { s.MaxItems = &v return s } // SetPolicyArn sets the PolicyArn field's value. func (s *ListPolicyVersionsInput) SetPolicyArn(v string) *ListPolicyVersionsInput { s.PolicyArn = &v return s } // Contains the response to a successful ListPolicyVersions request. type ListPolicyVersionsOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A flag that indicates whether there are more items to return. If your results // were truncated, you can make a subsequent pagination request using the Marker // request parameter to retrieve more items. Note that IAM might return fewer // than the MaxItems number of results even when there are more results available. // We recommend that you check IsTruncated after every call to ensure that you // receive all of your results. IsTruncated *bool `type:"boolean"` // When IsTruncated is true, this element is present and contains the value // to use for the Marker parameter in a subsequent pagination request. Marker *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // A list of policy versions. // // For more information about managed policy versions, see Versioning for Managed // Policies (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-versions.html) // in the IAM User Guide. Versions []*PolicyVersion `type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ListPolicyVersionsOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ListPolicyVersionsOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetIsTruncated sets the IsTruncated field's value. func (s *ListPolicyVersionsOutput) SetIsTruncated(v bool) *ListPolicyVersionsOutput { s.IsTruncated = &v return s } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *ListPolicyVersionsOutput) SetMarker(v string) *ListPolicyVersionsOutput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetVersions sets the Versions field's value. func (s *ListPolicyVersionsOutput) SetVersions(v []*PolicyVersion) *ListPolicyVersionsOutput { s.Versions = v return s } type ListRolePoliciesInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Use this parameter only when paginating results and only after you receive // a response indicating that the results are truncated. Set it to the value // of the Marker element in the response that you received to indicate where // the next call should start. Marker *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // (Optional) Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum // number of items you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond // the maximum you specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. // // If you do not include this parameter, it defaults to 100. Note that IAM might // return fewer results, even when there are more results available. In that // case, the IsTruncated response element returns true and Marker contains a // value to include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue // from. MaxItems *int64 `min:"1" type:"integer"` // The name of the role to list policies for. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@- // // RoleName is a required field RoleName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ListRolePoliciesInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ListRolePoliciesInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *ListRolePoliciesInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ListRolePoliciesInput"} if s.Marker != nil && len(*s.Marker) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Marker", 1)) } if s.MaxItems != nil && *s.MaxItems < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("MaxItems", 1)) } if s.RoleName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("RoleName")) } if s.RoleName != nil && len(*s.RoleName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("RoleName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *ListRolePoliciesInput) SetMarker(v string) *ListRolePoliciesInput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetMaxItems sets the MaxItems field's value. func (s *ListRolePoliciesInput) SetMaxItems(v int64) *ListRolePoliciesInput { s.MaxItems = &v return s } // SetRoleName sets the RoleName field's value. func (s *ListRolePoliciesInput) SetRoleName(v string) *ListRolePoliciesInput { s.RoleName = &v return s } // Contains the response to a successful ListRolePolicies request. type ListRolePoliciesOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A flag that indicates whether there are more items to return. If your results // were truncated, you can make a subsequent pagination request using the Marker // request parameter to retrieve more items. Note that IAM might return fewer // than the MaxItems number of results even when there are more results available. // We recommend that you check IsTruncated after every call to ensure that you // receive all of your results. IsTruncated *bool `type:"boolean"` // When IsTruncated is true, this element is present and contains the value // to use for the Marker parameter in a subsequent pagination request. Marker *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // A list of policy names. // // PolicyNames is a required field PolicyNames []*string `type:"list" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ListRolePoliciesOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ListRolePoliciesOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetIsTruncated sets the IsTruncated field's value. func (s *ListRolePoliciesOutput) SetIsTruncated(v bool) *ListRolePoliciesOutput { s.IsTruncated = &v return s } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *ListRolePoliciesOutput) SetMarker(v string) *ListRolePoliciesOutput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetPolicyNames sets the PolicyNames field's value. func (s *ListRolePoliciesOutput) SetPolicyNames(v []*string) *ListRolePoliciesOutput { s.PolicyNames = v return s } type ListRolesInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Use this parameter only when paginating results and only after you receive // a response indicating that the results are truncated. Set it to the value // of the Marker element in the response that you received to indicate where // the next call should start. Marker *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // (Optional) Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum // number of items you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond // the maximum you specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. // // If you do not include this parameter, it defaults to 100. Note that IAM might // return fewer results, even when there are more results available. In that // case, the IsTruncated response element returns true and Marker contains a // value to include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue // from. MaxItems *int64 `min:"1" type:"integer"` // The path prefix for filtering the results. For example, the prefix /application_abc/component_xyz/ // gets all roles whose path starts with /application_abc/component_xyz/. // // This parameter is optional. If it is not included, it defaults to a slash // (/), listing all roles. This paramater allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of either a forward slash (/) by itself // or a string that must begin and end with forward slashes, containing any // ASCII character from the ! (\u0021) thru the DEL character (\u007F), including // most punctuation characters, digits, and upper and lowercased letters. PathPrefix *string `min:"1" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ListRolesInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ListRolesInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *ListRolesInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ListRolesInput"} if s.Marker != nil && len(*s.Marker) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Marker", 1)) } if s.MaxItems != nil && *s.MaxItems < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("MaxItems", 1)) } if s.PathPrefix != nil && len(*s.PathPrefix) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("PathPrefix", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *ListRolesInput) SetMarker(v string) *ListRolesInput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetMaxItems sets the MaxItems field's value. func (s *ListRolesInput) SetMaxItems(v int64) *ListRolesInput { s.MaxItems = &v return s } // SetPathPrefix sets the PathPrefix field's value. func (s *ListRolesInput) SetPathPrefix(v string) *ListRolesInput { s.PathPrefix = &v return s } // Contains the response to a successful ListRoles request. type ListRolesOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A flag that indicates whether there are more items to return. If your results // were truncated, you can make a subsequent pagination request using the Marker // request parameter to retrieve more items. Note that IAM might return fewer // than the MaxItems number of results even when there are more results available. // We recommend that you check IsTruncated after every call to ensure that you // receive all of your results. IsTruncated *bool `type:"boolean"` // When IsTruncated is true, this element is present and contains the value // to use for the Marker parameter in a subsequent pagination request. Marker *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // A list of roles. // // Roles is a required field Roles []*Role `type:"list" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ListRolesOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ListRolesOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetIsTruncated sets the IsTruncated field's value. func (s *ListRolesOutput) SetIsTruncated(v bool) *ListRolesOutput { s.IsTruncated = &v return s } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *ListRolesOutput) SetMarker(v string) *ListRolesOutput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetRoles sets the Roles field's value. func (s *ListRolesOutput) SetRoles(v []*Role) *ListRolesOutput { s.Roles = v return s } type ListSAMLProvidersInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ListSAMLProvidersInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ListSAMLProvidersInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Contains the response to a successful ListSAMLProviders request. type ListSAMLProvidersOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The list of SAML provider resource objects defined in IAM for this AWS account. SAMLProviderList []*SAMLProviderListEntry `type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ListSAMLProvidersOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ListSAMLProvidersOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetSAMLProviderList sets the SAMLProviderList field's value. func (s *ListSAMLProvidersOutput) SetSAMLProviderList(v []*SAMLProviderListEntry) *ListSAMLProvidersOutput { s.SAMLProviderList = v return s } type ListSSHPublicKeysInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Use this parameter only when paginating results and only after you receive // a response indicating that the results are truncated. Set it to the value // of the Marker element in the response that you received to indicate where // the next call should start. Marker *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // (Optional) Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum // number of items you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond // the maximum you specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. // // If you do not include this parameter, it defaults to 100. Note that IAM might // return fewer results, even when there are more results available. In that // case, the IsTruncated response element returns true and Marker contains a // value to include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue // from. MaxItems *int64 `min:"1" type:"integer"` // The name of the IAM user to list SSH public keys for. If none is specified, // the UserName field is determined implicitly based on the AWS access key used // to sign the request. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- UserName *string `min:"1" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ListSSHPublicKeysInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ListSSHPublicKeysInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *ListSSHPublicKeysInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ListSSHPublicKeysInput"} if s.Marker != nil && len(*s.Marker) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Marker", 1)) } if s.MaxItems != nil && *s.MaxItems < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("MaxItems", 1)) } if s.UserName != nil && len(*s.UserName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("UserName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *ListSSHPublicKeysInput) SetMarker(v string) *ListSSHPublicKeysInput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetMaxItems sets the MaxItems field's value. func (s *ListSSHPublicKeysInput) SetMaxItems(v int64) *ListSSHPublicKeysInput { s.MaxItems = &v return s } // SetUserName sets the UserName field's value. func (s *ListSSHPublicKeysInput) SetUserName(v string) *ListSSHPublicKeysInput { s.UserName = &v return s } // Contains the response to a successful ListSSHPublicKeys request. type ListSSHPublicKeysOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A flag that indicates whether there are more items to return. If your results // were truncated, you can make a subsequent pagination request using the Marker // request parameter to retrieve more items. Note that IAM might return fewer // than the MaxItems number of results even when there are more results available. // We recommend that you check IsTruncated after every call to ensure that you // receive all of your results. IsTruncated *bool `type:"boolean"` // When IsTruncated is true, this element is present and contains the value // to use for the Marker parameter in a subsequent pagination request. Marker *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // A list of the SSH public keys assigned to IAM user. SSHPublicKeys []*SSHPublicKeyMetadata `type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ListSSHPublicKeysOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ListSSHPublicKeysOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetIsTruncated sets the IsTruncated field's value. func (s *ListSSHPublicKeysOutput) SetIsTruncated(v bool) *ListSSHPublicKeysOutput { s.IsTruncated = &v return s } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *ListSSHPublicKeysOutput) SetMarker(v string) *ListSSHPublicKeysOutput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetSSHPublicKeys sets the SSHPublicKeys field's value. func (s *ListSSHPublicKeysOutput) SetSSHPublicKeys(v []*SSHPublicKeyMetadata) *ListSSHPublicKeysOutput { s.SSHPublicKeys = v return s } type ListServerCertificatesInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Use this parameter only when paginating results and only after you receive // a response indicating that the results are truncated. Set it to the value // of the Marker element in the response that you received to indicate where // the next call should start. Marker *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // (Optional) Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum // number of items you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond // the maximum you specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. // // If you do not include this parameter, it defaults to 100. Note that IAM might // return fewer results, even when there are more results available. In that // case, the IsTruncated response element returns true and Marker contains a // value to include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue // from. MaxItems *int64 `min:"1" type:"integer"` // The path prefix for filtering the results. For example: /company/servercerts // would get all server certificates for which the path starts with /company/servercerts. // // This parameter is optional. If it is not included, it defaults to a slash // (/), listing all server certificates. This paramater allows (per its regex // pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters consisting // of either a forward slash (/) by itself or a string that must begin and end // with forward slashes, containing any ASCII character from the ! (\u0021) // thru the DEL character (\u007F), including most punctuation characters, digits, // and upper and lowercased letters. PathPrefix *string `min:"1" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ListServerCertificatesInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ListServerCertificatesInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *ListServerCertificatesInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ListServerCertificatesInput"} if s.Marker != nil && len(*s.Marker) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Marker", 1)) } if s.MaxItems != nil && *s.MaxItems < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("MaxItems", 1)) } if s.PathPrefix != nil && len(*s.PathPrefix) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("PathPrefix", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *ListServerCertificatesInput) SetMarker(v string) *ListServerCertificatesInput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetMaxItems sets the MaxItems field's value. func (s *ListServerCertificatesInput) SetMaxItems(v int64) *ListServerCertificatesInput { s.MaxItems = &v return s } // SetPathPrefix sets the PathPrefix field's value. func (s *ListServerCertificatesInput) SetPathPrefix(v string) *ListServerCertificatesInput { s.PathPrefix = &v return s } // Contains the response to a successful ListServerCertificates request. type ListServerCertificatesOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A flag that indicates whether there are more items to return. If your results // were truncated, you can make a subsequent pagination request using the Marker // request parameter to retrieve more items. Note that IAM might return fewer // than the MaxItems number of results even when there are more results available. // We recommend that you check IsTruncated after every call to ensure that you // receive all of your results. IsTruncated *bool `type:"boolean"` // When IsTruncated is true, this element is present and contains the value // to use for the Marker parameter in a subsequent pagination request. Marker *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // A list of server certificates. // // ServerCertificateMetadataList is a required field ServerCertificateMetadataList []*ServerCertificateMetadata `type:"list" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ListServerCertificatesOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ListServerCertificatesOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetIsTruncated sets the IsTruncated field's value. func (s *ListServerCertificatesOutput) SetIsTruncated(v bool) *ListServerCertificatesOutput { s.IsTruncated = &v return s } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *ListServerCertificatesOutput) SetMarker(v string) *ListServerCertificatesOutput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetServerCertificateMetadataList sets the ServerCertificateMetadataList field's value. func (s *ListServerCertificatesOutput) SetServerCertificateMetadataList(v []*ServerCertificateMetadata) *ListServerCertificatesOutput { s.ServerCertificateMetadataList = v return s } type ListServiceSpecificCredentialsInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Filters the returned results to only those for the specified AWS service. // If not specified, then AWS returns service-specific credentials for all services. ServiceName *string `type:"string"` // The name of the user whose service-specific credentials you want information // about. If this value is not specified then the operation assumes the user // whose credentials are used to call the operation. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- UserName *string `min:"1" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ListServiceSpecificCredentialsInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ListServiceSpecificCredentialsInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *ListServiceSpecificCredentialsInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ListServiceSpecificCredentialsInput"} if s.UserName != nil && len(*s.UserName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("UserName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetServiceName sets the ServiceName field's value. func (s *ListServiceSpecificCredentialsInput) SetServiceName(v string) *ListServiceSpecificCredentialsInput { s.ServiceName = &v return s } // SetUserName sets the UserName field's value. func (s *ListServiceSpecificCredentialsInput) SetUserName(v string) *ListServiceSpecificCredentialsInput { s.UserName = &v return s } type ListServiceSpecificCredentialsOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A list of structures that each contain details about a service-specific credential. ServiceSpecificCredentials []*ServiceSpecificCredentialMetadata `type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ListServiceSpecificCredentialsOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ListServiceSpecificCredentialsOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetServiceSpecificCredentials sets the ServiceSpecificCredentials field's value. func (s *ListServiceSpecificCredentialsOutput) SetServiceSpecificCredentials(v []*ServiceSpecificCredentialMetadata) *ListServiceSpecificCredentialsOutput { s.ServiceSpecificCredentials = v return s } type ListSigningCertificatesInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Use this parameter only when paginating results and only after you receive // a response indicating that the results are truncated. Set it to the value // of the Marker element in the response that you received to indicate where // the next call should start. Marker *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // (Optional) Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum // number of items you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond // the maximum you specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. // // If you do not include this parameter, it defaults to 100. Note that IAM might // return fewer results, even when there are more results available. In that // case, the IsTruncated response element returns true and Marker contains a // value to include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue // from. MaxItems *int64 `min:"1" type:"integer"` // The name of the IAM user whose signing certificates you want to examine. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- UserName *string `min:"1" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ListSigningCertificatesInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ListSigningCertificatesInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *ListSigningCertificatesInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ListSigningCertificatesInput"} if s.Marker != nil && len(*s.Marker) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Marker", 1)) } if s.MaxItems != nil && *s.MaxItems < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("MaxItems", 1)) } if s.UserName != nil && len(*s.UserName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("UserName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *ListSigningCertificatesInput) SetMarker(v string) *ListSigningCertificatesInput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetMaxItems sets the MaxItems field's value. func (s *ListSigningCertificatesInput) SetMaxItems(v int64) *ListSigningCertificatesInput { s.MaxItems = &v return s } // SetUserName sets the UserName field's value. func (s *ListSigningCertificatesInput) SetUserName(v string) *ListSigningCertificatesInput { s.UserName = &v return s } // Contains the response to a successful ListSigningCertificates request. type ListSigningCertificatesOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A list of the user's signing certificate information. // // Certificates is a required field Certificates []*SigningCertificate `type:"list" required:"true"` // A flag that indicates whether there are more items to return. If your results // were truncated, you can make a subsequent pagination request using the Marker // request parameter to retrieve more items. Note that IAM might return fewer // than the MaxItems number of results even when there are more results available. // We recommend that you check IsTruncated after every call to ensure that you // receive all of your results. IsTruncated *bool `type:"boolean"` // When IsTruncated is true, this element is present and contains the value // to use for the Marker parameter in a subsequent pagination request. Marker *string `min:"1" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ListSigningCertificatesOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ListSigningCertificatesOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetCertificates sets the Certificates field's value. func (s *ListSigningCertificatesOutput) SetCertificates(v []*SigningCertificate) *ListSigningCertificatesOutput { s.Certificates = v return s } // SetIsTruncated sets the IsTruncated field's value. func (s *ListSigningCertificatesOutput) SetIsTruncated(v bool) *ListSigningCertificatesOutput { s.IsTruncated = &v return s } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *ListSigningCertificatesOutput) SetMarker(v string) *ListSigningCertificatesOutput { s.Marker = &v return s } type ListUserPoliciesInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Use this parameter only when paginating results and only after you receive // a response indicating that the results are truncated. Set it to the value // of the Marker element in the response that you received to indicate where // the next call should start. Marker *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // (Optional) Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum // number of items you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond // the maximum you specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. // // If you do not include this parameter, it defaults to 100. Note that IAM might // return fewer results, even when there are more results available. In that // case, the IsTruncated response element returns true and Marker contains a // value to include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue // from. MaxItems *int64 `min:"1" type:"integer"` // The name of the user to list policies for. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- // // UserName is a required field UserName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ListUserPoliciesInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ListUserPoliciesInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *ListUserPoliciesInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ListUserPoliciesInput"} if s.Marker != nil && len(*s.Marker) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Marker", 1)) } if s.MaxItems != nil && *s.MaxItems < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("MaxItems", 1)) } if s.UserName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("UserName")) } if s.UserName != nil && len(*s.UserName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("UserName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *ListUserPoliciesInput) SetMarker(v string) *ListUserPoliciesInput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetMaxItems sets the MaxItems field's value. func (s *ListUserPoliciesInput) SetMaxItems(v int64) *ListUserPoliciesInput { s.MaxItems = &v return s } // SetUserName sets the UserName field's value. func (s *ListUserPoliciesInput) SetUserName(v string) *ListUserPoliciesInput { s.UserName = &v return s } // Contains the response to a successful ListUserPolicies request. type ListUserPoliciesOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A flag that indicates whether there are more items to return. If your results // were truncated, you can make a subsequent pagination request using the Marker // request parameter to retrieve more items. Note that IAM might return fewer // than the MaxItems number of results even when there are more results available. // We recommend that you check IsTruncated after every call to ensure that you // receive all of your results. IsTruncated *bool `type:"boolean"` // When IsTruncated is true, this element is present and contains the value // to use for the Marker parameter in a subsequent pagination request. Marker *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // A list of policy names. // // PolicyNames is a required field PolicyNames []*string `type:"list" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ListUserPoliciesOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ListUserPoliciesOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetIsTruncated sets the IsTruncated field's value. func (s *ListUserPoliciesOutput) SetIsTruncated(v bool) *ListUserPoliciesOutput { s.IsTruncated = &v return s } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *ListUserPoliciesOutput) SetMarker(v string) *ListUserPoliciesOutput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetPolicyNames sets the PolicyNames field's value. func (s *ListUserPoliciesOutput) SetPolicyNames(v []*string) *ListUserPoliciesOutput { s.PolicyNames = v return s } type ListUsersInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Use this parameter only when paginating results and only after you receive // a response indicating that the results are truncated. Set it to the value // of the Marker element in the response that you received to indicate where // the next call should start. Marker *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // (Optional) Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum // number of items you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond // the maximum you specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. // // If you do not include this parameter, it defaults to 100. Note that IAM might // return fewer results, even when there are more results available. In that // case, the IsTruncated response element returns true and Marker contains a // value to include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue // from. MaxItems *int64 `min:"1" type:"integer"` // The path prefix for filtering the results. For example: /division_abc/subdivision_xyz/, // which would get all user names whose path starts with /division_abc/subdivision_xyz/. // // This parameter is optional. If it is not included, it defaults to a slash // (/), listing all user names. This paramater allows (per its regex pattern // (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters consisting of either // a forward slash (/) by itself or a string that must begin and end with forward // slashes, containing any ASCII character from the ! (\u0021) thru the DEL // character (\u007F), including most punctuation characters, digits, and upper // and lowercased letters. PathPrefix *string `min:"1" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ListUsersInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ListUsersInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *ListUsersInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ListUsersInput"} if s.Marker != nil && len(*s.Marker) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Marker", 1)) } if s.MaxItems != nil && *s.MaxItems < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("MaxItems", 1)) } if s.PathPrefix != nil && len(*s.PathPrefix) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("PathPrefix", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *ListUsersInput) SetMarker(v string) *ListUsersInput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetMaxItems sets the MaxItems field's value. func (s *ListUsersInput) SetMaxItems(v int64) *ListUsersInput { s.MaxItems = &v return s } // SetPathPrefix sets the PathPrefix field's value. func (s *ListUsersInput) SetPathPrefix(v string) *ListUsersInput { s.PathPrefix = &v return s } // Contains the response to a successful ListUsers request. type ListUsersOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A flag that indicates whether there are more items to return. If your results // were truncated, you can make a subsequent pagination request using the Marker // request parameter to retrieve more items. Note that IAM might return fewer // than the MaxItems number of results even when there are more results available. // We recommend that you check IsTruncated after every call to ensure that you // receive all of your results. IsTruncated *bool `type:"boolean"` // When IsTruncated is true, this element is present and contains the value // to use for the Marker parameter in a subsequent pagination request. Marker *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // A list of users. // // Users is a required field Users []*User `type:"list" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ListUsersOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ListUsersOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetIsTruncated sets the IsTruncated field's value. func (s *ListUsersOutput) SetIsTruncated(v bool) *ListUsersOutput { s.IsTruncated = &v return s } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *ListUsersOutput) SetMarker(v string) *ListUsersOutput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetUsers sets the Users field's value. func (s *ListUsersOutput) SetUsers(v []*User) *ListUsersOutput { s.Users = v return s } type ListVirtualMFADevicesInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The status (Unassigned or Assigned) of the devices to list. If you do not // specify an AssignmentStatus, the action defaults to Any which lists both // assigned and unassigned virtual MFA devices. AssignmentStatus *string `type:"string" enum:"assignmentStatusType"` // Use this parameter only when paginating results and only after you receive // a response indicating that the results are truncated. Set it to the value // of the Marker element in the response that you received to indicate where // the next call should start. Marker *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // (Optional) Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum // number of items you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond // the maximum you specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. // // If you do not include this parameter, it defaults to 100. Note that IAM might // return fewer results, even when there are more results available. In that // case, the IsTruncated response element returns true and Marker contains a // value to include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue // from. MaxItems *int64 `min:"1" type:"integer"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ListVirtualMFADevicesInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ListVirtualMFADevicesInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *ListVirtualMFADevicesInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ListVirtualMFADevicesInput"} if s.Marker != nil && len(*s.Marker) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Marker", 1)) } if s.MaxItems != nil && *s.MaxItems < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("MaxItems", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetAssignmentStatus sets the AssignmentStatus field's value. func (s *ListVirtualMFADevicesInput) SetAssignmentStatus(v string) *ListVirtualMFADevicesInput { s.AssignmentStatus = &v return s } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *ListVirtualMFADevicesInput) SetMarker(v string) *ListVirtualMFADevicesInput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetMaxItems sets the MaxItems field's value. func (s *ListVirtualMFADevicesInput) SetMaxItems(v int64) *ListVirtualMFADevicesInput { s.MaxItems = &v return s } // Contains the response to a successful ListVirtualMFADevices request. type ListVirtualMFADevicesOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A flag that indicates whether there are more items to return. If your results // were truncated, you can make a subsequent pagination request using the Marker // request parameter to retrieve more items. Note that IAM might return fewer // than the MaxItems number of results even when there are more results available. // We recommend that you check IsTruncated after every call to ensure that you // receive all of your results. IsTruncated *bool `type:"boolean"` // When IsTruncated is true, this element is present and contains the value // to use for the Marker parameter in a subsequent pagination request. Marker *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // The list of virtual MFA devices in the current account that match the AssignmentStatus // value that was passed in the request. // // VirtualMFADevices is a required field VirtualMFADevices []*VirtualMFADevice `type:"list" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ListVirtualMFADevicesOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ListVirtualMFADevicesOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetIsTruncated sets the IsTruncated field's value. func (s *ListVirtualMFADevicesOutput) SetIsTruncated(v bool) *ListVirtualMFADevicesOutput { s.IsTruncated = &v return s } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *ListVirtualMFADevicesOutput) SetMarker(v string) *ListVirtualMFADevicesOutput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetVirtualMFADevices sets the VirtualMFADevices field's value. func (s *ListVirtualMFADevicesOutput) SetVirtualMFADevices(v []*VirtualMFADevice) *ListVirtualMFADevicesOutput { s.VirtualMFADevices = v return s } // Contains the user name and password create date for a user. // // This data type is used as a response element in the CreateLoginProfile and // GetLoginProfile actions. type LoginProfile struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The date when the password for the user was created. // // CreateDate is a required field CreateDate *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601" required:"true"` // Specifies whether the user is required to set a new password on next sign-in. PasswordResetRequired *bool `type:"boolean"` // The name of the user, which can be used for signing in to the AWS Management // Console. // // UserName is a required field UserName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s LoginProfile) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s LoginProfile) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetCreateDate sets the CreateDate field's value. func (s *LoginProfile) SetCreateDate(v time.Time) *LoginProfile { s.CreateDate = &v return s } // SetPasswordResetRequired sets the PasswordResetRequired field's value. func (s *LoginProfile) SetPasswordResetRequired(v bool) *LoginProfile { s.PasswordResetRequired = &v return s } // SetUserName sets the UserName field's value. func (s *LoginProfile) SetUserName(v string) *LoginProfile { s.UserName = &v return s } // Contains information about an MFA device. // // This data type is used as a response element in the ListMFADevices action. type MFADevice struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The date when the MFA device was enabled for the user. // // EnableDate is a required field EnableDate *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601" required:"true"` // The serial number that uniquely identifies the MFA device. For virtual MFA // devices, the serial number is the device ARN. // // SerialNumber is a required field SerialNumber *string `min:"9" type:"string" required:"true"` // The user with whom the MFA device is associated. // // UserName is a required field UserName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s MFADevice) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s MFADevice) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetEnableDate sets the EnableDate field's value. func (s *MFADevice) SetEnableDate(v time.Time) *MFADevice { s.EnableDate = &v return s } // SetSerialNumber sets the SerialNumber field's value. func (s *MFADevice) SetSerialNumber(v string) *MFADevice { s.SerialNumber = &v return s } // SetUserName sets the UserName field's value. func (s *MFADevice) SetUserName(v string) *MFADevice { s.UserName = &v return s } // Contains information about a managed policy, including the policy's ARN, // versions, and the number of principal entities (users, groups, and roles) // that the policy is attached to. // // This data type is used as a response element in the GetAccountAuthorizationDetails // action. // // For more information about managed policies, see Managed Policies and Inline // Policies (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) // in the Using IAM guide. type ManagedPolicyDetail struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The Amazon Resource Name (ARN). ARNs are unique identifiers for AWS resources. // // For more information about ARNs, go to Amazon Resource Names (ARNs) and AWS // Service Namespaces (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/aws-arns-and-namespaces.html) // in the AWS General Reference. Arn *string `min:"20" type:"string"` // The number of principal entities (users, groups, and roles) that the policy // is attached to. AttachmentCount *int64 `type:"integer"` // The date and time, in ISO 8601 date-time format (http://www.iso.org/iso/iso8601), // when the policy was created. CreateDate *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"` // The identifier for the version of the policy that is set as the default (operative) // version. // // For more information about policy versions, see Versioning for Managed Policies // (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-versions.html) // in the Using IAM guide. DefaultVersionId *string `type:"string"` // A friendly description of the policy. Description *string `type:"string"` // Specifies whether the policy can be attached to an IAM user, group, or role. IsAttachable *bool `type:"boolean"` // The path to the policy. // // For more information about paths, see IAM Identifiers (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/Using_Identifiers.html) // in the Using IAM guide. Path *string `type:"string"` // The stable and unique string identifying the policy. // // For more information about IDs, see IAM Identifiers (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/Using_Identifiers.html) // in the Using IAM guide. PolicyId *string `min:"16" type:"string"` // The friendly name (not ARN) identifying the policy. PolicyName *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // A list containing information about the versions of the policy. PolicyVersionList []*PolicyVersion `type:"list"` // The date and time, in ISO 8601 date-time format (http://www.iso.org/iso/iso8601), // when the policy was last updated. // // When a policy has only one version, this field contains the date and time // when the policy was created. When a policy has more than one version, this // field contains the date and time when the most recent policy version was // created. UpdateDate *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ManagedPolicyDetail) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ManagedPolicyDetail) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetArn sets the Arn field's value. func (s *ManagedPolicyDetail) SetArn(v string) *ManagedPolicyDetail { s.Arn = &v return s } // SetAttachmentCount sets the AttachmentCount field's value. func (s *ManagedPolicyDetail) SetAttachmentCount(v int64) *ManagedPolicyDetail { s.AttachmentCount = &v return s } // SetCreateDate sets the CreateDate field's value. func (s *ManagedPolicyDetail) SetCreateDate(v time.Time) *ManagedPolicyDetail { s.CreateDate = &v return s } // SetDefaultVersionId sets the DefaultVersionId field's value. func (s *ManagedPolicyDetail) SetDefaultVersionId(v string) *ManagedPolicyDetail { s.DefaultVersionId = &v return s } // SetDescription sets the Description field's value. func (s *ManagedPolicyDetail) SetDescription(v string) *ManagedPolicyDetail { s.Description = &v return s } // SetIsAttachable sets the IsAttachable field's value. func (s *ManagedPolicyDetail) SetIsAttachable(v bool) *ManagedPolicyDetail { s.IsAttachable = &v return s } // SetPath sets the Path field's value. func (s *ManagedPolicyDetail) SetPath(v string) *ManagedPolicyDetail { s.Path = &v return s } // SetPolicyId sets the PolicyId field's value. func (s *ManagedPolicyDetail) SetPolicyId(v string) *ManagedPolicyDetail { s.PolicyId = &v return s } // SetPolicyName sets the PolicyName field's value. func (s *ManagedPolicyDetail) SetPolicyName(v string) *ManagedPolicyDetail { s.PolicyName = &v return s } // SetPolicyVersionList sets the PolicyVersionList field's value. func (s *ManagedPolicyDetail) SetPolicyVersionList(v []*PolicyVersion) *ManagedPolicyDetail { s.PolicyVersionList = v return s } // SetUpdateDate sets the UpdateDate field's value. func (s *ManagedPolicyDetail) SetUpdateDate(v time.Time) *ManagedPolicyDetail { s.UpdateDate = &v return s } // Contains the Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for an IAM OpenID Connect provider. type OpenIDConnectProviderListEntry struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The Amazon Resource Name (ARN). ARNs are unique identifiers for AWS resources. // // For more information about ARNs, go to Amazon Resource Names (ARNs) and AWS // Service Namespaces (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/aws-arns-and-namespaces.html) // in the AWS General Reference. Arn *string `min:"20" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s OpenIDConnectProviderListEntry) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s OpenIDConnectProviderListEntry) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetArn sets the Arn field's value. func (s *OpenIDConnectProviderListEntry) SetArn(v string) *OpenIDConnectProviderListEntry { s.Arn = &v return s } // Contains information about AWS Organizations's affect on a policy simulation. type OrganizationsDecisionDetail struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Specifies whether the simulated action is allowed by the AWS Organizations // service control policies that impact the simulated user's account. AllowedByOrganizations *bool `type:"boolean"` } // String returns the string representation func (s OrganizationsDecisionDetail) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s OrganizationsDecisionDetail) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetAllowedByOrganizations sets the AllowedByOrganizations field's value. func (s *OrganizationsDecisionDetail) SetAllowedByOrganizations(v bool) *OrganizationsDecisionDetail { s.AllowedByOrganizations = &v return s } // Contains information about the account password policy. // // This data type is used as a response element in the GetAccountPasswordPolicy // action. type PasswordPolicy struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Specifies whether IAM users are allowed to change their own password. AllowUsersToChangePassword *bool `type:"boolean"` // Indicates whether passwords in the account expire. Returns true if MaxPasswordAge // is contains a value greater than 0. Returns false if MaxPasswordAge is 0 // or not present. ExpirePasswords *bool `type:"boolean"` // Specifies whether IAM users are prevented from setting a new password after // their password has expired. HardExpiry *bool `type:"boolean"` // The number of days that an IAM user password is valid. MaxPasswordAge *int64 `min:"1" type:"integer"` // Minimum length to require for IAM user passwords. MinimumPasswordLength *int64 `min:"6" type:"integer"` // Specifies the number of previous passwords that IAM users are prevented from // reusing. PasswordReusePrevention *int64 `min:"1" type:"integer"` // Specifies whether to require lowercase characters for IAM user passwords. RequireLowercaseCharacters *bool `type:"boolean"` // Specifies whether to require numbers for IAM user passwords. RequireNumbers *bool `type:"boolean"` // Specifies whether to require symbols for IAM user passwords. RequireSymbols *bool `type:"boolean"` // Specifies whether to require uppercase characters for IAM user passwords. RequireUppercaseCharacters *bool `type:"boolean"` } // String returns the string representation func (s PasswordPolicy) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s PasswordPolicy) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetAllowUsersToChangePassword sets the AllowUsersToChangePassword field's value. func (s *PasswordPolicy) SetAllowUsersToChangePassword(v bool) *PasswordPolicy { s.AllowUsersToChangePassword = &v return s } // SetExpirePasswords sets the ExpirePasswords field's value. func (s *PasswordPolicy) SetExpirePasswords(v bool) *PasswordPolicy { s.ExpirePasswords = &v return s } // SetHardExpiry sets the HardExpiry field's value. func (s *PasswordPolicy) SetHardExpiry(v bool) *PasswordPolicy { s.HardExpiry = &v return s } // SetMaxPasswordAge sets the MaxPasswordAge field's value. func (s *PasswordPolicy) SetMaxPasswordAge(v int64) *PasswordPolicy { s.MaxPasswordAge = &v return s } // SetMinimumPasswordLength sets the MinimumPasswordLength field's value. func (s *PasswordPolicy) SetMinimumPasswordLength(v int64) *PasswordPolicy { s.MinimumPasswordLength = &v return s } // SetPasswordReusePrevention sets the PasswordReusePrevention field's value. func (s *PasswordPolicy) SetPasswordReusePrevention(v int64) *PasswordPolicy { s.PasswordReusePrevention = &v return s } // SetRequireLowercaseCharacters sets the RequireLowercaseCharacters field's value. func (s *PasswordPolicy) SetRequireLowercaseCharacters(v bool) *PasswordPolicy { s.RequireLowercaseCharacters = &v return s } // SetRequireNumbers sets the RequireNumbers field's value. func (s *PasswordPolicy) SetRequireNumbers(v bool) *PasswordPolicy { s.RequireNumbers = &v return s } // SetRequireSymbols sets the RequireSymbols field's value. func (s *PasswordPolicy) SetRequireSymbols(v bool) *PasswordPolicy { s.RequireSymbols = &v return s } // SetRequireUppercaseCharacters sets the RequireUppercaseCharacters field's value. func (s *PasswordPolicy) SetRequireUppercaseCharacters(v bool) *PasswordPolicy { s.RequireUppercaseCharacters = &v return s } // Contains information about a managed policy. // // This data type is used as a response element in the CreatePolicy, GetPolicy, // and ListPolicies actions. // // For more information about managed policies, refer to Managed Policies and // Inline Policies (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) // in the Using IAM guide. type Policy struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The Amazon Resource Name (ARN). ARNs are unique identifiers for AWS resources. // // For more information about ARNs, go to Amazon Resource Names (ARNs) and AWS // Service Namespaces (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/aws-arns-and-namespaces.html) // in the AWS General Reference. Arn *string `min:"20" type:"string"` // The number of entities (users, groups, and roles) that the policy is attached // to. AttachmentCount *int64 `type:"integer"` // The date and time, in ISO 8601 date-time format (http://www.iso.org/iso/iso8601), // when the policy was created. CreateDate *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"` // The identifier for the version of the policy that is set as the default version. DefaultVersionId *string `type:"string"` // A friendly description of the policy. // // This element is included in the response to the GetPolicy operation. It is // not included in the response to the ListPolicies operation. Description *string `type:"string"` // Specifies whether the policy can be attached to an IAM user, group, or role. IsAttachable *bool `type:"boolean"` // The path to the policy. // // For more information about paths, see IAM Identifiers (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/Using_Identifiers.html) // in the Using IAM guide. Path *string `type:"string"` // The stable and unique string identifying the policy. // // For more information about IDs, see IAM Identifiers (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/Using_Identifiers.html) // in the Using IAM guide. PolicyId *string `min:"16" type:"string"` // The friendly name (not ARN) identifying the policy. PolicyName *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // The date and time, in ISO 8601 date-time format (http://www.iso.org/iso/iso8601), // when the policy was last updated. // // When a policy has only one version, this field contains the date and time // when the policy was created. When a policy has more than one version, this // field contains the date and time when the most recent policy version was // created. UpdateDate *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"` } // String returns the string representation func (s Policy) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s Policy) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetArn sets the Arn field's value. func (s *Policy) SetArn(v string) *Policy { s.Arn = &v return s } // SetAttachmentCount sets the AttachmentCount field's value. func (s *Policy) SetAttachmentCount(v int64) *Policy { s.AttachmentCount = &v return s } // SetCreateDate sets the CreateDate field's value. func (s *Policy) SetCreateDate(v time.Time) *Policy { s.CreateDate = &v return s } // SetDefaultVersionId sets the DefaultVersionId field's value. func (s *Policy) SetDefaultVersionId(v string) *Policy { s.DefaultVersionId = &v return s } // SetDescription sets the Description field's value. func (s *Policy) SetDescription(v string) *Policy { s.Description = &v return s } // SetIsAttachable sets the IsAttachable field's value. func (s *Policy) SetIsAttachable(v bool) *Policy { s.IsAttachable = &v return s } // SetPath sets the Path field's value. func (s *Policy) SetPath(v string) *Policy { s.Path = &v return s } // SetPolicyId sets the PolicyId field's value. func (s *Policy) SetPolicyId(v string) *Policy { s.PolicyId = &v return s } // SetPolicyName sets the PolicyName field's value. func (s *Policy) SetPolicyName(v string) *Policy { s.PolicyName = &v return s } // SetUpdateDate sets the UpdateDate field's value. func (s *Policy) SetUpdateDate(v time.Time) *Policy { s.UpdateDate = &v return s } // Contains information about an IAM policy, including the policy document. // // This data type is used as a response element in the GetAccountAuthorizationDetails // action. type PolicyDetail struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The policy document. PolicyDocument *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // The name of the policy. PolicyName *string `min:"1" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s PolicyDetail) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s PolicyDetail) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetPolicyDocument sets the PolicyDocument field's value. func (s *PolicyDetail) SetPolicyDocument(v string) *PolicyDetail { s.PolicyDocument = &v return s } // SetPolicyName sets the PolicyName field's value. func (s *PolicyDetail) SetPolicyName(v string) *PolicyDetail { s.PolicyName = &v return s } // Contains information about a group that a managed policy is attached to. // // This data type is used as a response element in the ListEntitiesForPolicy // action. // // For more information about managed policies, refer to Managed Policies and // Inline Policies (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) // in the Using IAM guide. type PolicyGroup struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The stable and unique string identifying the group. For more information // about IDs, see IAM Identifiers (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/reference_identifiers.html) // in the IAM User Guide. GroupId *string `min:"16" type:"string"` // The name (friendly name, not ARN) identifying the group. GroupName *string `min:"1" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s PolicyGroup) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s PolicyGroup) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetGroupId sets the GroupId field's value. func (s *PolicyGroup) SetGroupId(v string) *PolicyGroup { s.GroupId = &v return s } // SetGroupName sets the GroupName field's value. func (s *PolicyGroup) SetGroupName(v string) *PolicyGroup { s.GroupName = &v return s } // Contains information about a role that a managed policy is attached to. // // This data type is used as a response element in the ListEntitiesForPolicy // action. // // For more information about managed policies, refer to Managed Policies and // Inline Policies (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) // in the Using IAM guide. type PolicyRole struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The stable and unique string identifying the role. For more information about // IDs, see IAM Identifiers (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/reference_identifiers.html) // in the IAM User Guide. RoleId *string `min:"16" type:"string"` // The name (friendly name, not ARN) identifying the role. RoleName *string `min:"1" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s PolicyRole) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s PolicyRole) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetRoleId sets the RoleId field's value. func (s *PolicyRole) SetRoleId(v string) *PolicyRole { s.RoleId = &v return s } // SetRoleName sets the RoleName field's value. func (s *PolicyRole) SetRoleName(v string) *PolicyRole { s.RoleName = &v return s } // Contains information about a user that a managed policy is attached to. // // This data type is used as a response element in the ListEntitiesForPolicy // action. // // For more information about managed policies, refer to Managed Policies and // Inline Policies (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) // in the Using IAM guide. type PolicyUser struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The stable and unique string identifying the user. For more information about // IDs, see IAM Identifiers (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/reference_identifiers.html) // in the IAM User Guide. UserId *string `min:"16" type:"string"` // The name (friendly name, not ARN) identifying the user. UserName *string `min:"1" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s PolicyUser) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s PolicyUser) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetUserId sets the UserId field's value. func (s *PolicyUser) SetUserId(v string) *PolicyUser { s.UserId = &v return s } // SetUserName sets the UserName field's value. func (s *PolicyUser) SetUserName(v string) *PolicyUser { s.UserName = &v return s } // Contains information about a version of a managed policy. // // This data type is used as a response element in the CreatePolicyVersion, // GetPolicyVersion, ListPolicyVersions, and GetAccountAuthorizationDetails // actions. // // For more information about managed policies, refer to Managed Policies and // Inline Policies (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) // in the Using IAM guide. type PolicyVersion struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The date and time, in ISO 8601 date-time format (http://www.iso.org/iso/iso8601), // when the policy version was created. CreateDate *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"` // The policy document. // // The policy document is returned in the response to the GetPolicyVersion and // GetAccountAuthorizationDetails operations. It is not returned in the response // to the CreatePolicyVersion or ListPolicyVersions operations. Document *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // Specifies whether the policy version is set as the policy's default version. IsDefaultVersion *bool `type:"boolean"` // The identifier for the policy version. // // Policy version identifiers always begin with v (always lowercase). When a // policy is created, the first policy version is v1. VersionId *string `type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s PolicyVersion) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s PolicyVersion) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetCreateDate sets the CreateDate field's value. func (s *PolicyVersion) SetCreateDate(v time.Time) *PolicyVersion { s.CreateDate = &v return s } // SetDocument sets the Document field's value. func (s *PolicyVersion) SetDocument(v string) *PolicyVersion { s.Document = &v return s } // SetIsDefaultVersion sets the IsDefaultVersion field's value. func (s *PolicyVersion) SetIsDefaultVersion(v bool) *PolicyVersion { s.IsDefaultVersion = &v return s } // SetVersionId sets the VersionId field's value. func (s *PolicyVersion) SetVersionId(v string) *PolicyVersion { s.VersionId = &v return s } // Contains the row and column of a location of a Statement element in a policy // document. // // This data type is used as a member of the Statement type. type Position struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The column in the line containing the specified position in the document. Column *int64 `type:"integer"` // The line containing the specified position in the document. Line *int64 `type:"integer"` } // String returns the string representation func (s Position) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s Position) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetColumn sets the Column field's value. func (s *Position) SetColumn(v int64) *Position { s.Column = &v return s } // SetLine sets the Line field's value. func (s *Position) SetLine(v int64) *Position { s.Line = &v return s } type PutGroupPolicyInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name of the group to associate the policy with. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- // // GroupName is a required field GroupName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` // The policy document. // // The regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex) used to validate this // parameter is a string of characters consisting of any printable ASCII character // ranging from the space character (\u0020) through end of the ASCII character // range as well as the printable characters in the Basic Latin and Latin-1 // Supplement character set (through \u00FF). It also includes the special characters // tab (\u0009), line feed (\u000A), and carriage return (\u000D). // // PolicyDocument is a required field PolicyDocument *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` // The name of the policy document. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@-+ // // PolicyName is a required field PolicyName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s PutGroupPolicyInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s PutGroupPolicyInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *PutGroupPolicyInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "PutGroupPolicyInput"} if s.GroupName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("GroupName")) } if s.GroupName != nil && len(*s.GroupName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("GroupName", 1)) } if s.PolicyDocument == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("PolicyDocument")) } if s.PolicyDocument != nil && len(*s.PolicyDocument) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("PolicyDocument", 1)) } if s.PolicyName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("PolicyName")) } if s.PolicyName != nil && len(*s.PolicyName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("PolicyName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetGroupName sets the GroupName field's value. func (s *PutGroupPolicyInput) SetGroupName(v string) *PutGroupPolicyInput { s.GroupName = &v return s } // SetPolicyDocument sets the PolicyDocument field's value. func (s *PutGroupPolicyInput) SetPolicyDocument(v string) *PutGroupPolicyInput { s.PolicyDocument = &v return s } // SetPolicyName sets the PolicyName field's value. func (s *PutGroupPolicyInput) SetPolicyName(v string) *PutGroupPolicyInput { s.PolicyName = &v return s } type PutGroupPolicyOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s PutGroupPolicyOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s PutGroupPolicyOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } type PutRolePolicyInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The policy document. // // The regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex) used to validate this // parameter is a string of characters consisting of any printable ASCII character // ranging from the space character (\u0020) through end of the ASCII character // range as well as the printable characters in the Basic Latin and Latin-1 // Supplement character set (through \u00FF). It also includes the special characters // tab (\u0009), line feed (\u000A), and carriage return (\u000D). // // PolicyDocument is a required field PolicyDocument *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` // The name of the policy document. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@-+ // // PolicyName is a required field PolicyName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` // The name of the role to associate the policy with. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@- // // RoleName is a required field RoleName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s PutRolePolicyInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s PutRolePolicyInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *PutRolePolicyInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "PutRolePolicyInput"} if s.PolicyDocument == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("PolicyDocument")) } if s.PolicyDocument != nil && len(*s.PolicyDocument) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("PolicyDocument", 1)) } if s.PolicyName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("PolicyName")) } if s.PolicyName != nil && len(*s.PolicyName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("PolicyName", 1)) } if s.RoleName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("RoleName")) } if s.RoleName != nil && len(*s.RoleName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("RoleName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetPolicyDocument sets the PolicyDocument field's value. func (s *PutRolePolicyInput) SetPolicyDocument(v string) *PutRolePolicyInput { s.PolicyDocument = &v return s } // SetPolicyName sets the PolicyName field's value. func (s *PutRolePolicyInput) SetPolicyName(v string) *PutRolePolicyInput { s.PolicyName = &v return s } // SetRoleName sets the RoleName field's value. func (s *PutRolePolicyInput) SetRoleName(v string) *PutRolePolicyInput { s.RoleName = &v return s } type PutRolePolicyOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s PutRolePolicyOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s PutRolePolicyOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } type PutUserPolicyInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The policy document. // // The regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex) used to validate this // parameter is a string of characters consisting of any printable ASCII character // ranging from the space character (\u0020) through end of the ASCII character // range as well as the printable characters in the Basic Latin and Latin-1 // Supplement character set (through \u00FF). It also includes the special characters // tab (\u0009), line feed (\u000A), and carriage return (\u000D). // // PolicyDocument is a required field PolicyDocument *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` // The name of the policy document. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@-+ // // PolicyName is a required field PolicyName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` // The name of the user to associate the policy with. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- // // UserName is a required field UserName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s PutUserPolicyInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s PutUserPolicyInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *PutUserPolicyInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "PutUserPolicyInput"} if s.PolicyDocument == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("PolicyDocument")) } if s.PolicyDocument != nil && len(*s.PolicyDocument) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("PolicyDocument", 1)) } if s.PolicyName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("PolicyName")) } if s.PolicyName != nil && len(*s.PolicyName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("PolicyName", 1)) } if s.UserName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("UserName")) } if s.UserName != nil && len(*s.UserName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("UserName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetPolicyDocument sets the PolicyDocument field's value. func (s *PutUserPolicyInput) SetPolicyDocument(v string) *PutUserPolicyInput { s.PolicyDocument = &v return s } // SetPolicyName sets the PolicyName field's value. func (s *PutUserPolicyInput) SetPolicyName(v string) *PutUserPolicyInput { s.PolicyName = &v return s } // SetUserName sets the UserName field's value. func (s *PutUserPolicyInput) SetUserName(v string) *PutUserPolicyInput { s.UserName = &v return s } type PutUserPolicyOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s PutUserPolicyOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s PutUserPolicyOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } type RemoveClientIDFromOpenIDConnectProviderInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The client ID (also known as audience) to remove from the IAM OIDC provider // resource. For more information about client IDs, see CreateOpenIDConnectProvider. // // ClientID is a required field ClientID *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` // The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the IAM OIDC provider resource to remove // the client ID from. You can get a list of OIDC provider ARNs by using the // ListOpenIDConnectProviders action. // // For more information about ARNs, see Amazon Resource Names (ARNs) and AWS // Service Namespaces (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/aws-arns-and-namespaces.html) // in the AWS General Reference. // // OpenIDConnectProviderArn is a required field OpenIDConnectProviderArn *string `min:"20" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s RemoveClientIDFromOpenIDConnectProviderInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s RemoveClientIDFromOpenIDConnectProviderInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *RemoveClientIDFromOpenIDConnectProviderInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "RemoveClientIDFromOpenIDConnectProviderInput"} if s.ClientID == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ClientID")) } if s.ClientID != nil && len(*s.ClientID) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("ClientID", 1)) } if s.OpenIDConnectProviderArn == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("OpenIDConnectProviderArn")) } if s.OpenIDConnectProviderArn != nil && len(*s.OpenIDConnectProviderArn) < 20 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("OpenIDConnectProviderArn", 20)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetClientID sets the ClientID field's value. func (s *RemoveClientIDFromOpenIDConnectProviderInput) SetClientID(v string) *RemoveClientIDFromOpenIDConnectProviderInput { s.ClientID = &v return s } // SetOpenIDConnectProviderArn sets the OpenIDConnectProviderArn field's value. func (s *RemoveClientIDFromOpenIDConnectProviderInput) SetOpenIDConnectProviderArn(v string) *RemoveClientIDFromOpenIDConnectProviderInput { s.OpenIDConnectProviderArn = &v return s } type RemoveClientIDFromOpenIDConnectProviderOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s RemoveClientIDFromOpenIDConnectProviderOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s RemoveClientIDFromOpenIDConnectProviderOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } type RemoveRoleFromInstanceProfileInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name of the instance profile to update. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- // // InstanceProfileName is a required field InstanceProfileName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` // The name of the role to remove. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@- // // RoleName is a required field RoleName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s RemoveRoleFromInstanceProfileInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s RemoveRoleFromInstanceProfileInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *RemoveRoleFromInstanceProfileInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "RemoveRoleFromInstanceProfileInput"} if s.InstanceProfileName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("InstanceProfileName")) } if s.InstanceProfileName != nil && len(*s.InstanceProfileName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("InstanceProfileName", 1)) } if s.RoleName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("RoleName")) } if s.RoleName != nil && len(*s.RoleName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("RoleName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetInstanceProfileName sets the InstanceProfileName field's value. func (s *RemoveRoleFromInstanceProfileInput) SetInstanceProfileName(v string) *RemoveRoleFromInstanceProfileInput { s.InstanceProfileName = &v return s } // SetRoleName sets the RoleName field's value. func (s *RemoveRoleFromInstanceProfileInput) SetRoleName(v string) *RemoveRoleFromInstanceProfileInput { s.RoleName = &v return s } type RemoveRoleFromInstanceProfileOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s RemoveRoleFromInstanceProfileOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s RemoveRoleFromInstanceProfileOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } type RemoveUserFromGroupInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name of the group to update. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- // // GroupName is a required field GroupName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` // The name of the user to remove. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- // // UserName is a required field UserName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s RemoveUserFromGroupInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s RemoveUserFromGroupInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *RemoveUserFromGroupInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "RemoveUserFromGroupInput"} if s.GroupName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("GroupName")) } if s.GroupName != nil && len(*s.GroupName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("GroupName", 1)) } if s.UserName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("UserName")) } if s.UserName != nil && len(*s.UserName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("UserName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetGroupName sets the GroupName field's value. func (s *RemoveUserFromGroupInput) SetGroupName(v string) *RemoveUserFromGroupInput { s.GroupName = &v return s } // SetUserName sets the UserName field's value. func (s *RemoveUserFromGroupInput) SetUserName(v string) *RemoveUserFromGroupInput { s.UserName = &v return s } type RemoveUserFromGroupOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s RemoveUserFromGroupOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s RemoveUserFromGroupOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } type ResetServiceSpecificCredentialInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The unique identifier of the service-specific credential. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters that can consist of any upper or lowercased letter // or digit. // // ServiceSpecificCredentialId is a required field ServiceSpecificCredentialId *string `min:"20" type:"string" required:"true"` // The name of the IAM user associated with the service-specific credential. // If this value is not specified, then the operation assumes the user whose // credentials are used to call the operation. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- UserName *string `min:"1" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ResetServiceSpecificCredentialInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ResetServiceSpecificCredentialInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *ResetServiceSpecificCredentialInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ResetServiceSpecificCredentialInput"} if s.ServiceSpecificCredentialId == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ServiceSpecificCredentialId")) } if s.ServiceSpecificCredentialId != nil && len(*s.ServiceSpecificCredentialId) < 20 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("ServiceSpecificCredentialId", 20)) } if s.UserName != nil && len(*s.UserName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("UserName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetServiceSpecificCredentialId sets the ServiceSpecificCredentialId field's value. func (s *ResetServiceSpecificCredentialInput) SetServiceSpecificCredentialId(v string) *ResetServiceSpecificCredentialInput { s.ServiceSpecificCredentialId = &v return s } // SetUserName sets the UserName field's value. func (s *ResetServiceSpecificCredentialInput) SetUserName(v string) *ResetServiceSpecificCredentialInput { s.UserName = &v return s } type ResetServiceSpecificCredentialOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A structure with details about the updated service-specific credential, including // the new password. // // This is the only time that you can access the password. You cannot recover // the password later, but you can reset it again. ServiceSpecificCredential *ServiceSpecificCredential `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ResetServiceSpecificCredentialOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ResetServiceSpecificCredentialOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetServiceSpecificCredential sets the ServiceSpecificCredential field's value. func (s *ResetServiceSpecificCredentialOutput) SetServiceSpecificCredential(v *ServiceSpecificCredential) *ResetServiceSpecificCredentialOutput { s.ServiceSpecificCredential = v return s } // Contains the result of the simulation of a single API action call on a single // resource. // // This data type is used by a member of the EvaluationResult data type. type ResourceSpecificResult struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Additional details about the results of the evaluation decision. When there // are both IAM policies and resource policies, this parameter explains how // each set of policies contributes to the final evaluation decision. When simulating // cross-account access to a resource, both the resource-based policy and the // caller's IAM policy must grant access. EvalDecisionDetails map[string]*string `type:"map"` // The result of the simulation of the simulated API action on the resource // specified in EvalResourceName. // // EvalResourceDecision is a required field EvalResourceDecision *string `type:"string" required:"true" enum:"PolicyEvaluationDecisionType"` // The name of the simulated resource, in Amazon Resource Name (ARN) format. // // EvalResourceName is a required field EvalResourceName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` // A list of the statements in the input policies that determine the result // for this part of the simulation. Remember that even if multiple statements // allow the action on the resource, if any statement denies that action, then // the explicit deny overrides any allow, and the deny statement is the only // entry included in the result. MatchedStatements []*Statement `type:"list"` // A list of context keys that are required by the included input policies but // that were not provided by one of the input parameters. This list is used // when a list of ARNs is included in the ResourceArns parameter instead of // "*". If you do not specify individual resources, by setting ResourceArns // to "*" or by not including the ResourceArns parameter, then any missing context // values are instead included under the EvaluationResults section. To discover // the context keys used by a set of policies, you can call GetContextKeysForCustomPolicy // or GetContextKeysForPrincipalPolicy. MissingContextValues []*string `type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ResourceSpecificResult) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ResourceSpecificResult) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetEvalDecisionDetails sets the EvalDecisionDetails field's value. func (s *ResourceSpecificResult) SetEvalDecisionDetails(v map[string]*string) *ResourceSpecificResult { s.EvalDecisionDetails = v return s } // SetEvalResourceDecision sets the EvalResourceDecision field's value. func (s *ResourceSpecificResult) SetEvalResourceDecision(v string) *ResourceSpecificResult { s.EvalResourceDecision = &v return s } // SetEvalResourceName sets the EvalResourceName field's value. func (s *ResourceSpecificResult) SetEvalResourceName(v string) *ResourceSpecificResult { s.EvalResourceName = &v return s } // SetMatchedStatements sets the MatchedStatements field's value. func (s *ResourceSpecificResult) SetMatchedStatements(v []*Statement) *ResourceSpecificResult { s.MatchedStatements = v return s } // SetMissingContextValues sets the MissingContextValues field's value. func (s *ResourceSpecificResult) SetMissingContextValues(v []*string) *ResourceSpecificResult { s.MissingContextValues = v return s } type ResyncMFADeviceInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // An authentication code emitted by the device. // // The format for this parameter is a sequence of six digits. // // AuthenticationCode1 is a required field AuthenticationCode1 *string `min:"6" type:"string" required:"true"` // A subsequent authentication code emitted by the device. // // The format for this parameter is a sequence of six digits. // // AuthenticationCode2 is a required field AuthenticationCode2 *string `min:"6" type:"string" required:"true"` // Serial number that uniquely identifies the MFA device. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- // // SerialNumber is a required field SerialNumber *string `min:"9" type:"string" required:"true"` // The name of the user whose MFA device you want to resynchronize. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- // // UserName is a required field UserName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ResyncMFADeviceInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ResyncMFADeviceInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *ResyncMFADeviceInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ResyncMFADeviceInput"} if s.AuthenticationCode1 == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("AuthenticationCode1")) } if s.AuthenticationCode1 != nil && len(*s.AuthenticationCode1) < 6 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("AuthenticationCode1", 6)) } if s.AuthenticationCode2 == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("AuthenticationCode2")) } if s.AuthenticationCode2 != nil && len(*s.AuthenticationCode2) < 6 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("AuthenticationCode2", 6)) } if s.SerialNumber == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SerialNumber")) } if s.SerialNumber != nil && len(*s.SerialNumber) < 9 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("SerialNumber", 9)) } if s.UserName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("UserName")) } if s.UserName != nil && len(*s.UserName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("UserName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetAuthenticationCode1 sets the AuthenticationCode1 field's value. func (s *ResyncMFADeviceInput) SetAuthenticationCode1(v string) *ResyncMFADeviceInput { s.AuthenticationCode1 = &v return s } // SetAuthenticationCode2 sets the AuthenticationCode2 field's value. func (s *ResyncMFADeviceInput) SetAuthenticationCode2(v string) *ResyncMFADeviceInput { s.AuthenticationCode2 = &v return s } // SetSerialNumber sets the SerialNumber field's value. func (s *ResyncMFADeviceInput) SetSerialNumber(v string) *ResyncMFADeviceInput { s.SerialNumber = &v return s } // SetUserName sets the UserName field's value. func (s *ResyncMFADeviceInput) SetUserName(v string) *ResyncMFADeviceInput { s.UserName = &v return s } type ResyncMFADeviceOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ResyncMFADeviceOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ResyncMFADeviceOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Contains information about an IAM role. This structure is returned as a response // element in several APIs that interact with roles. type Role struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) specifying the role. For more information // about ARNs and how to use them in policies, see IAM Identifiers (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/Using_Identifiers.html) // in the IAM User Guide guide. // // Arn is a required field Arn *string `min:"20" type:"string" required:"true"` // The policy that grants an entity permission to assume the role. AssumeRolePolicyDocument *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // The date and time, in ISO 8601 date-time format (http://www.iso.org/iso/iso8601), // when the role was created. // // CreateDate is a required field CreateDate *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601" required:"true"` // A description of the role that you provide. Description *string `type:"string"` // The path to the role. For more information about paths, see IAM Identifiers // (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/Using_Identifiers.html) // in the Using IAM guide. // // Path is a required field Path *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` // The stable and unique string identifying the role. For more information about // IDs, see IAM Identifiers (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/Using_Identifiers.html) // in the Using IAM guide. // // RoleId is a required field RoleId *string `min:"16" type:"string" required:"true"` // The friendly name that identifies the role. // // RoleName is a required field RoleName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s Role) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s Role) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetArn sets the Arn field's value. func (s *Role) SetArn(v string) *Role { s.Arn = &v return s } // SetAssumeRolePolicyDocument sets the AssumeRolePolicyDocument field's value. func (s *Role) SetAssumeRolePolicyDocument(v string) *Role { s.AssumeRolePolicyDocument = &v return s } // SetCreateDate sets the CreateDate field's value. func (s *Role) SetCreateDate(v time.Time) *Role { s.CreateDate = &v return s } // SetDescription sets the Description field's value. func (s *Role) SetDescription(v string) *Role { s.Description = &v return s } // SetPath sets the Path field's value. func (s *Role) SetPath(v string) *Role { s.Path = &v return s } // SetRoleId sets the RoleId field's value. func (s *Role) SetRoleId(v string) *Role { s.RoleId = &v return s } // SetRoleName sets the RoleName field's value. func (s *Role) SetRoleName(v string) *Role { s.RoleName = &v return s } // Contains information about an IAM role, including all of the role's policies. // // This data type is used as a response element in the GetAccountAuthorizationDetails // action. type RoleDetail struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The Amazon Resource Name (ARN). ARNs are unique identifiers for AWS resources. // // For more information about ARNs, go to Amazon Resource Names (ARNs) and AWS // Service Namespaces (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/aws-arns-and-namespaces.html) // in the AWS General Reference. Arn *string `min:"20" type:"string"` // The trust policy that grants permission to assume the role. AssumeRolePolicyDocument *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // A list of managed policies attached to the role. These policies are the role's // access (permissions) policies. AttachedManagedPolicies []*AttachedPolicy `type:"list"` // The date and time, in ISO 8601 date-time format (http://www.iso.org/iso/iso8601), // when the role was created. CreateDate *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"` // A list of instance profiles that contain this role. InstanceProfileList []*InstanceProfile `type:"list"` // The path to the role. For more information about paths, see IAM Identifiers // (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/Using_Identifiers.html) // in the Using IAM guide. Path *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // The stable and unique string identifying the role. For more information about // IDs, see IAM Identifiers (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/Using_Identifiers.html) // in the Using IAM guide. RoleId *string `min:"16" type:"string"` // The friendly name that identifies the role. RoleName *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // A list of inline policies embedded in the role. These policies are the role's // access (permissions) policies. RolePolicyList []*PolicyDetail `type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s RoleDetail) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s RoleDetail) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetArn sets the Arn field's value. func (s *RoleDetail) SetArn(v string) *RoleDetail { s.Arn = &v return s } // SetAssumeRolePolicyDocument sets the AssumeRolePolicyDocument field's value. func (s *RoleDetail) SetAssumeRolePolicyDocument(v string) *RoleDetail { s.AssumeRolePolicyDocument = &v return s } // SetAttachedManagedPolicies sets the AttachedManagedPolicies field's value. func (s *RoleDetail) SetAttachedManagedPolicies(v []*AttachedPolicy) *RoleDetail { s.AttachedManagedPolicies = v return s } // SetCreateDate sets the CreateDate field's value. func (s *RoleDetail) SetCreateDate(v time.Time) *RoleDetail { s.CreateDate = &v return s } // SetInstanceProfileList sets the InstanceProfileList field's value. func (s *RoleDetail) SetInstanceProfileList(v []*InstanceProfile) *RoleDetail { s.InstanceProfileList = v return s } // SetPath sets the Path field's value. func (s *RoleDetail) SetPath(v string) *RoleDetail { s.Path = &v return s } // SetRoleId sets the RoleId field's value. func (s *RoleDetail) SetRoleId(v string) *RoleDetail { s.RoleId = &v return s } // SetRoleName sets the RoleName field's value. func (s *RoleDetail) SetRoleName(v string) *RoleDetail { s.RoleName = &v return s } // SetRolePolicyList sets the RolePolicyList field's value. func (s *RoleDetail) SetRolePolicyList(v []*PolicyDetail) *RoleDetail { s.RolePolicyList = v return s } // An object that contains details about how a service-linked role is used. // // This data type is used as a response element in the GetServiceLinkedRoleDeletionStatus // operation. type RoleUsageType struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name of the region where the service-linked role is being used. Region *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // The name of the resource that is using the service-linked role. Resources []*string `type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s RoleUsageType) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s RoleUsageType) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetRegion sets the Region field's value. func (s *RoleUsageType) SetRegion(v string) *RoleUsageType { s.Region = &v return s } // SetResources sets the Resources field's value. func (s *RoleUsageType) SetResources(v []*string) *RoleUsageType { s.Resources = v return s } // Contains the list of SAML providers for this account. type SAMLProviderListEntry struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the SAML provider. Arn *string `min:"20" type:"string"` // The date and time when the SAML provider was created. CreateDate *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"` // The expiration date and time for the SAML provider. ValidUntil *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"` } // String returns the string representation func (s SAMLProviderListEntry) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s SAMLProviderListEntry) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetArn sets the Arn field's value. func (s *SAMLProviderListEntry) SetArn(v string) *SAMLProviderListEntry { s.Arn = &v return s } // SetCreateDate sets the CreateDate field's value. func (s *SAMLProviderListEntry) SetCreateDate(v time.Time) *SAMLProviderListEntry { s.CreateDate = &v return s } // SetValidUntil sets the ValidUntil field's value. func (s *SAMLProviderListEntry) SetValidUntil(v time.Time) *SAMLProviderListEntry { s.ValidUntil = &v return s } // Contains information about an SSH public key. // // This data type is used as a response element in the GetSSHPublicKey and UploadSSHPublicKey // actions. type SSHPublicKey struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The MD5 message digest of the SSH public key. // // Fingerprint is a required field Fingerprint *string `min:"48" type:"string" required:"true"` // The SSH public key. // // SSHPublicKeyBody is a required field SSHPublicKeyBody *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` // The unique identifier for the SSH public key. // // SSHPublicKeyId is a required field SSHPublicKeyId *string `min:"20" type:"string" required:"true"` // The status of the SSH public key. Active means the key can be used for authentication // with an AWS CodeCommit repository. Inactive means the key cannot be used. // // Status is a required field Status *string `type:"string" required:"true" enum:"statusType"` // The date and time, in ISO 8601 date-time format (http://www.iso.org/iso/iso8601), // when the SSH public key was uploaded. UploadDate *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"` // The name of the IAM user associated with the SSH public key. // // UserName is a required field UserName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s SSHPublicKey) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s SSHPublicKey) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetFingerprint sets the Fingerprint field's value. func (s *SSHPublicKey) SetFingerprint(v string) *SSHPublicKey { s.Fingerprint = &v return s } // SetSSHPublicKeyBody sets the SSHPublicKeyBody field's value. func (s *SSHPublicKey) SetSSHPublicKeyBody(v string) *SSHPublicKey { s.SSHPublicKeyBody = &v return s } // SetSSHPublicKeyId sets the SSHPublicKeyId field's value. func (s *SSHPublicKey) SetSSHPublicKeyId(v string) *SSHPublicKey { s.SSHPublicKeyId = &v return s } // SetStatus sets the Status field's value. func (s *SSHPublicKey) SetStatus(v string) *SSHPublicKey { s.Status = &v return s } // SetUploadDate sets the UploadDate field's value. func (s *SSHPublicKey) SetUploadDate(v time.Time) *SSHPublicKey { s.UploadDate = &v return s } // SetUserName sets the UserName field's value. func (s *SSHPublicKey) SetUserName(v string) *SSHPublicKey { s.UserName = &v return s } // Contains information about an SSH public key, without the key's body or fingerprint. // // This data type is used as a response element in the ListSSHPublicKeys action. type SSHPublicKeyMetadata struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The unique identifier for the SSH public key. // // SSHPublicKeyId is a required field SSHPublicKeyId *string `min:"20" type:"string" required:"true"` // The status of the SSH public key. Active means the key can be used for authentication // with an AWS CodeCommit repository. Inactive means the key cannot be used. // // Status is a required field Status *string `type:"string" required:"true" enum:"statusType"` // The date and time, in ISO 8601 date-time format (http://www.iso.org/iso/iso8601), // when the SSH public key was uploaded. // // UploadDate is a required field UploadDate *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601" required:"true"` // The name of the IAM user associated with the SSH public key. // // UserName is a required field UserName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s SSHPublicKeyMetadata) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s SSHPublicKeyMetadata) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetSSHPublicKeyId sets the SSHPublicKeyId field's value. func (s *SSHPublicKeyMetadata) SetSSHPublicKeyId(v string) *SSHPublicKeyMetadata { s.SSHPublicKeyId = &v return s } // SetStatus sets the Status field's value. func (s *SSHPublicKeyMetadata) SetStatus(v string) *SSHPublicKeyMetadata { s.Status = &v return s } // SetUploadDate sets the UploadDate field's value. func (s *SSHPublicKeyMetadata) SetUploadDate(v time.Time) *SSHPublicKeyMetadata { s.UploadDate = &v return s } // SetUserName sets the UserName field's value. func (s *SSHPublicKeyMetadata) SetUserName(v string) *SSHPublicKeyMetadata { s.UserName = &v return s } // Contains information about a server certificate. // // This data type is used as a response element in the GetServerCertificate // action. type ServerCertificate struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The contents of the public key certificate. // // CertificateBody is a required field CertificateBody *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` // The contents of the public key certificate chain. CertificateChain *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // The meta information of the server certificate, such as its name, path, ID, // and ARN. // // ServerCertificateMetadata is a required field ServerCertificateMetadata *ServerCertificateMetadata `type:"structure" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ServerCertificate) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ServerCertificate) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetCertificateBody sets the CertificateBody field's value. func (s *ServerCertificate) SetCertificateBody(v string) *ServerCertificate { s.CertificateBody = &v return s } // SetCertificateChain sets the CertificateChain field's value. func (s *ServerCertificate) SetCertificateChain(v string) *ServerCertificate { s.CertificateChain = &v return s } // SetServerCertificateMetadata sets the ServerCertificateMetadata field's value. func (s *ServerCertificate) SetServerCertificateMetadata(v *ServerCertificateMetadata) *ServerCertificate { s.ServerCertificateMetadata = v return s } // Contains information about a server certificate without its certificate body, // certificate chain, and private key. // // This data type is used as a response element in the UploadServerCertificate // and ListServerCertificates actions. type ServerCertificateMetadata struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) specifying the server certificate. For more // information about ARNs and how to use them in policies, see IAM Identifiers // (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/Using_Identifiers.html) // in the Using IAM guide. // // Arn is a required field Arn *string `min:"20" type:"string" required:"true"` // The date on which the certificate is set to expire. Expiration *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"` // The path to the server certificate. For more information about paths, see // IAM Identifiers (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/Using_Identifiers.html) // in the Using IAM guide. // // Path is a required field Path *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` // The stable and unique string identifying the server certificate. For more // information about IDs, see IAM Identifiers (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/Using_Identifiers.html) // in the Using IAM guide. // // ServerCertificateId is a required field ServerCertificateId *string `min:"16" type:"string" required:"true"` // The name that identifies the server certificate. // // ServerCertificateName is a required field ServerCertificateName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` // The date when the server certificate was uploaded. UploadDate *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ServerCertificateMetadata) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ServerCertificateMetadata) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetArn sets the Arn field's value. func (s *ServerCertificateMetadata) SetArn(v string) *ServerCertificateMetadata { s.Arn = &v return s } // SetExpiration sets the Expiration field's value. func (s *ServerCertificateMetadata) SetExpiration(v time.Time) *ServerCertificateMetadata { s.Expiration = &v return s } // SetPath sets the Path field's value. func (s *ServerCertificateMetadata) SetPath(v string) *ServerCertificateMetadata { s.Path = &v return s } // SetServerCertificateId sets the ServerCertificateId field's value. func (s *ServerCertificateMetadata) SetServerCertificateId(v string) *ServerCertificateMetadata { s.ServerCertificateId = &v return s } // SetServerCertificateName sets the ServerCertificateName field's value. func (s *ServerCertificateMetadata) SetServerCertificateName(v string) *ServerCertificateMetadata { s.ServerCertificateName = &v return s } // SetUploadDate sets the UploadDate field's value. func (s *ServerCertificateMetadata) SetUploadDate(v time.Time) *ServerCertificateMetadata { s.UploadDate = &v return s } // Contains the details of a service specific credential. type ServiceSpecificCredential struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The date and time, in ISO 8601 date-time format (http://www.iso.org/iso/iso8601), // when the service-specific credential were created. // // CreateDate is a required field CreateDate *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601" required:"true"` // The name of the service associated with the service-specific credential. // // ServiceName is a required field ServiceName *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // The generated password for the service-specific credential. // // ServicePassword is a required field ServicePassword *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // The unique identifier for the service-specific credential. // // ServiceSpecificCredentialId is a required field ServiceSpecificCredentialId *string `min:"20" type:"string" required:"true"` // The generated user name for the service-specific credential. This value is // generated by combining the IAM user's name combined with the ID number of // the AWS account, as in jane-at-123456789012, for example. This value cannot // be configured by the user. // // ServiceUserName is a required field ServiceUserName *string `min:"17" type:"string" required:"true"` // The status of the service-specific credential. Active means the key is valid // for API calls, while Inactive means it is not. // // Status is a required field Status *string `type:"string" required:"true" enum:"statusType"` // The name of the IAM user associated with the service-specific credential. // // UserName is a required field UserName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ServiceSpecificCredential) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ServiceSpecificCredential) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetCreateDate sets the CreateDate field's value. func (s *ServiceSpecificCredential) SetCreateDate(v time.Time) *ServiceSpecificCredential { s.CreateDate = &v return s } // SetServiceName sets the ServiceName field's value. func (s *ServiceSpecificCredential) SetServiceName(v string) *ServiceSpecificCredential { s.ServiceName = &v return s } // SetServicePassword sets the ServicePassword field's value. func (s *ServiceSpecificCredential) SetServicePassword(v string) *ServiceSpecificCredential { s.ServicePassword = &v return s } // SetServiceSpecificCredentialId sets the ServiceSpecificCredentialId field's value. func (s *ServiceSpecificCredential) SetServiceSpecificCredentialId(v string) *ServiceSpecificCredential { s.ServiceSpecificCredentialId = &v return s } // SetServiceUserName sets the ServiceUserName field's value. func (s *ServiceSpecificCredential) SetServiceUserName(v string) *ServiceSpecificCredential { s.ServiceUserName = &v return s } // SetStatus sets the Status field's value. func (s *ServiceSpecificCredential) SetStatus(v string) *ServiceSpecificCredential { s.Status = &v return s } // SetUserName sets the UserName field's value. func (s *ServiceSpecificCredential) SetUserName(v string) *ServiceSpecificCredential { s.UserName = &v return s } // Contains additional details about a service-specific credential. type ServiceSpecificCredentialMetadata struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The date and time, in ISO 8601 date-time format (http://www.iso.org/iso/iso8601), // when the service-specific credential were created. // // CreateDate is a required field CreateDate *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601" required:"true"` // The name of the service associated with the service-specific credential. // // ServiceName is a required field ServiceName *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // The unique identifier for the service-specific credential. // // ServiceSpecificCredentialId is a required field ServiceSpecificCredentialId *string `min:"20" type:"string" required:"true"` // The generated user name for the service-specific credential. // // ServiceUserName is a required field ServiceUserName *string `min:"17" type:"string" required:"true"` // The status of the service-specific credential. Active means the key is valid // for API calls, while Inactive means it is not. // // Status is a required field Status *string `type:"string" required:"true" enum:"statusType"` // The name of the IAM user associated with the service-specific credential. // // UserName is a required field UserName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ServiceSpecificCredentialMetadata) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ServiceSpecificCredentialMetadata) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetCreateDate sets the CreateDate field's value. func (s *ServiceSpecificCredentialMetadata) SetCreateDate(v time.Time) *ServiceSpecificCredentialMetadata { s.CreateDate = &v return s } // SetServiceName sets the ServiceName field's value. func (s *ServiceSpecificCredentialMetadata) SetServiceName(v string) *ServiceSpecificCredentialMetadata { s.ServiceName = &v return s } // SetServiceSpecificCredentialId sets the ServiceSpecificCredentialId field's value. func (s *ServiceSpecificCredentialMetadata) SetServiceSpecificCredentialId(v string) *ServiceSpecificCredentialMetadata { s.ServiceSpecificCredentialId = &v return s } // SetServiceUserName sets the ServiceUserName field's value. func (s *ServiceSpecificCredentialMetadata) SetServiceUserName(v string) *ServiceSpecificCredentialMetadata { s.ServiceUserName = &v return s } // SetStatus sets the Status field's value. func (s *ServiceSpecificCredentialMetadata) SetStatus(v string) *ServiceSpecificCredentialMetadata { s.Status = &v return s } // SetUserName sets the UserName field's value. func (s *ServiceSpecificCredentialMetadata) SetUserName(v string) *ServiceSpecificCredentialMetadata { s.UserName = &v return s } type SetDefaultPolicyVersionInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the IAM policy whose default version you // want to set. // // For more information about ARNs, see Amazon Resource Names (ARNs) and AWS // Service Namespaces (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/aws-arns-and-namespaces.html) // in the AWS General Reference. // // PolicyArn is a required field PolicyArn *string `min:"20" type:"string" required:"true"` // The version of the policy to set as the default (operative) version. // // For more information about managed policy versions, see Versioning for Managed // Policies (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-versions.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // VersionId is a required field VersionId *string `type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s SetDefaultPolicyVersionInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s SetDefaultPolicyVersionInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *SetDefaultPolicyVersionInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "SetDefaultPolicyVersionInput"} if s.PolicyArn == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("PolicyArn")) } if s.PolicyArn != nil && len(*s.PolicyArn) < 20 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("PolicyArn", 20)) } if s.VersionId == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("VersionId")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetPolicyArn sets the PolicyArn field's value. func (s *SetDefaultPolicyVersionInput) SetPolicyArn(v string) *SetDefaultPolicyVersionInput { s.PolicyArn = &v return s } // SetVersionId sets the VersionId field's value. func (s *SetDefaultPolicyVersionInput) SetVersionId(v string) *SetDefaultPolicyVersionInput { s.VersionId = &v return s } type SetDefaultPolicyVersionOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s SetDefaultPolicyVersionOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s SetDefaultPolicyVersionOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Contains information about an X.509 signing certificate. // // This data type is used as a response element in the UploadSigningCertificate // and ListSigningCertificates actions. type SigningCertificate struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The contents of the signing certificate. // // CertificateBody is a required field CertificateBody *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` // The ID for the signing certificate. // // CertificateId is a required field CertificateId *string `min:"24" type:"string" required:"true"` // The status of the signing certificate. Active means the key is valid for // API calls, while Inactive means it is not. // // Status is a required field Status *string `type:"string" required:"true" enum:"statusType"` // The date when the signing certificate was uploaded. UploadDate *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"` // The name of the user the signing certificate is associated with. // // UserName is a required field UserName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s SigningCertificate) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s SigningCertificate) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetCertificateBody sets the CertificateBody field's value. func (s *SigningCertificate) SetCertificateBody(v string) *SigningCertificate { s.CertificateBody = &v return s } // SetCertificateId sets the CertificateId field's value. func (s *SigningCertificate) SetCertificateId(v string) *SigningCertificate { s.CertificateId = &v return s } // SetStatus sets the Status field's value. func (s *SigningCertificate) SetStatus(v string) *SigningCertificate { s.Status = &v return s } // SetUploadDate sets the UploadDate field's value. func (s *SigningCertificate) SetUploadDate(v time.Time) *SigningCertificate { s.UploadDate = &v return s } // SetUserName sets the UserName field's value. func (s *SigningCertificate) SetUserName(v string) *SigningCertificate { s.UserName = &v return s } type SimulateCustomPolicyInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A list of names of API actions to evaluate in the simulation. Each action // is evaluated against each resource. Each action must include the service // identifier, such as iam:CreateUser. // // ActionNames is a required field ActionNames []*string `type:"list" required:"true"` // The ARN of the IAM user that you want to use as the simulated caller of the // APIs. CallerArn is required if you include a ResourcePolicy so that the policy's // Principal element has a value to use in evaluating the policy. // // You can specify only the ARN of an IAM user. You cannot specify the ARN of // an assumed role, federated user, or a service principal. CallerArn *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // A list of context keys and corresponding values for the simulation to use. // Whenever a context key is evaluated in one of the simulated IAM permission // policies, the corresponding value is supplied. ContextEntries []*ContextEntry `type:"list"` // Use this parameter only when paginating results and only after you receive // a response indicating that the results are truncated. Set it to the value // of the Marker element in the response that you received to indicate where // the next call should start. Marker *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // (Optional) Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum // number of items you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond // the maximum you specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. // // If you do not include this parameter, it defaults to 100. Note that IAM might // return fewer results, even when there are more results available. In that // case, the IsTruncated response element returns true and Marker contains a // value to include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue // from. MaxItems *int64 `min:"1" type:"integer"` // A list of policy documents to include in the simulation. Each document is // specified as a string containing the complete, valid JSON text of an IAM // policy. Do not include any resource-based policies in this parameter. Any // resource-based policy must be submitted with the ResourcePolicy parameter. // The policies cannot be "scope-down" policies, such as you could include in // a call to GetFederationToken (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/APIReference/API_GetFederationToken.html) // or one of the AssumeRole (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/APIReference/API_AssumeRole.html) // APIs to restrict what a user can do while using the temporary credentials. // // The regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex) used to validate this // parameter is a string of characters consisting of any printable ASCII character // ranging from the space character (\u0020) through end of the ASCII character // range as well as the printable characters in the Basic Latin and Latin-1 // Supplement character set (through \u00FF). It also includes the special characters // tab (\u0009), line feed (\u000A), and carriage return (\u000D). // // PolicyInputList is a required field PolicyInputList []*string `type:"list" required:"true"` // A list of ARNs of AWS resources to include in the simulation. If this parameter // is not provided then the value defaults to * (all resources). Each API in // the ActionNames parameter is evaluated for each resource in this list. The // simulation determines the access result (allowed or denied) of each combination // and reports it in the response. // // The simulation does not automatically retrieve policies for the specified // resources. If you want to include a resource policy in the simulation, then // you must include the policy as a string in the ResourcePolicy parameter. // // If you include a ResourcePolicy, then it must be applicable to all of the // resources included in the simulation or you receive an invalid input error. // // For more information about ARNs, see Amazon Resource Names (ARNs) and AWS // Service Namespaces (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/aws-arns-and-namespaces.html) // in the AWS General Reference. ResourceArns []*string `type:"list"` // Specifies the type of simulation to run. Different APIs that support resource-based // policies require different combinations of resources. By specifying the type // of simulation to run, you enable the policy simulator to enforce the presence // of the required resources to ensure reliable simulation results. If your // simulation does not match one of the following scenarios, then you can omit // this parameter. The following list shows each of the supported scenario values // and the resources that you must define to run the simulation. // // Each of the EC2 scenarios requires that you specify instance, image, and // security-group resources. If your scenario includes an EBS volume, then you // must specify that volume as a resource. If the EC2 scenario includes VPC, // then you must supply the network-interface resource. If it includes an IP // subnet, then you must specify the subnet resource. For more information on // the EC2 scenario options, see Supported Platforms (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AWSEC2/latest/UserGuide/ec2-supported-platforms.html) // in the AWS EC2 User Guide. // // * EC2-Classic-InstanceStore // // instance, image, security-group // // * EC2-Classic-EBS // // instance, image, security-group, volume // // * EC2-VPC-InstanceStore // // instance, image, security-group, network-interface // // * EC2-VPC-InstanceStore-Subnet // // instance, image, security-group, network-interface, subnet // // * EC2-VPC-EBS // // instance, image, security-group, network-interface, volume // // * EC2-VPC-EBS-Subnet // // instance, image, security-group, network-interface, subnet, volume ResourceHandlingOption *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // An AWS account ID that specifies the owner of any simulated resource that // does not identify its owner in the resource ARN, such as an S3 bucket or // object. If ResourceOwner is specified, it is also used as the account owner // of any ResourcePolicy included in the simulation. If the ResourceOwner parameter // is not specified, then the owner of the resources and the resource policy // defaults to the account of the identity provided in CallerArn. This parameter // is required only if you specify a resource-based policy and account that // owns the resource is different from the account that owns the simulated calling // user CallerArn. ResourceOwner *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // A resource-based policy to include in the simulation provided as a string. // Each resource in the simulation is treated as if it had this policy attached. // You can include only one resource-based policy in a simulation. // // The regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex) used to validate this // parameter is a string of characters consisting of any printable ASCII character // ranging from the space character (\u0020) through end of the ASCII character // range as well as the printable characters in the Basic Latin and Latin-1 // Supplement character set (through \u00FF). It also includes the special characters // tab (\u0009), line feed (\u000A), and carriage return (\u000D). ResourcePolicy *string `min:"1" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s SimulateCustomPolicyInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s SimulateCustomPolicyInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *SimulateCustomPolicyInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "SimulateCustomPolicyInput"} if s.ActionNames == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ActionNames")) } if s.CallerArn != nil && len(*s.CallerArn) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("CallerArn", 1)) } if s.Marker != nil && len(*s.Marker) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Marker", 1)) } if s.MaxItems != nil && *s.MaxItems < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("MaxItems", 1)) } if s.PolicyInputList == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("PolicyInputList")) } if s.ResourceHandlingOption != nil && len(*s.ResourceHandlingOption) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("ResourceHandlingOption", 1)) } if s.ResourceOwner != nil && len(*s.ResourceOwner) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("ResourceOwner", 1)) } if s.ResourcePolicy != nil && len(*s.ResourcePolicy) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("ResourcePolicy", 1)) } if s.ContextEntries != nil { for i, v := range s.ContextEntries { if v == nil { continue } if err := v.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "ContextEntries", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetActionNames sets the ActionNames field's value. func (s *SimulateCustomPolicyInput) SetActionNames(v []*string) *SimulateCustomPolicyInput { s.ActionNames = v return s } // SetCallerArn sets the CallerArn field's value. func (s *SimulateCustomPolicyInput) SetCallerArn(v string) *SimulateCustomPolicyInput { s.CallerArn = &v return s } // SetContextEntries sets the ContextEntries field's value. func (s *SimulateCustomPolicyInput) SetContextEntries(v []*ContextEntry) *SimulateCustomPolicyInput { s.ContextEntries = v return s } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *SimulateCustomPolicyInput) SetMarker(v string) *SimulateCustomPolicyInput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetMaxItems sets the MaxItems field's value. func (s *SimulateCustomPolicyInput) SetMaxItems(v int64) *SimulateCustomPolicyInput { s.MaxItems = &v return s } // SetPolicyInputList sets the PolicyInputList field's value. func (s *SimulateCustomPolicyInput) SetPolicyInputList(v []*string) *SimulateCustomPolicyInput { s.PolicyInputList = v return s } // SetResourceArns sets the ResourceArns field's value. func (s *SimulateCustomPolicyInput) SetResourceArns(v []*string) *SimulateCustomPolicyInput { s.ResourceArns = v return s } // SetResourceHandlingOption sets the ResourceHandlingOption field's value. func (s *SimulateCustomPolicyInput) SetResourceHandlingOption(v string) *SimulateCustomPolicyInput { s.ResourceHandlingOption = &v return s } // SetResourceOwner sets the ResourceOwner field's value. func (s *SimulateCustomPolicyInput) SetResourceOwner(v string) *SimulateCustomPolicyInput { s.ResourceOwner = &v return s } // SetResourcePolicy sets the ResourcePolicy field's value. func (s *SimulateCustomPolicyInput) SetResourcePolicy(v string) *SimulateCustomPolicyInput { s.ResourcePolicy = &v return s } // Contains the response to a successful SimulatePrincipalPolicy or SimulateCustomPolicy // request. type SimulatePolicyResponse struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The results of the simulation. EvaluationResults []*EvaluationResult `type:"list"` // A flag that indicates whether there are more items to return. If your results // were truncated, you can make a subsequent pagination request using the Marker // request parameter to retrieve more items. Note that IAM might return fewer // than the MaxItems number of results even when there are more results available. // We recommend that you check IsTruncated after every call to ensure that you // receive all of your results. IsTruncated *bool `type:"boolean"` // When IsTruncated is true, this element is present and contains the value // to use for the Marker parameter in a subsequent pagination request. Marker *string `min:"1" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s SimulatePolicyResponse) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s SimulatePolicyResponse) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetEvaluationResults sets the EvaluationResults field's value. func (s *SimulatePolicyResponse) SetEvaluationResults(v []*EvaluationResult) *SimulatePolicyResponse { s.EvaluationResults = v return s } // SetIsTruncated sets the IsTruncated field's value. func (s *SimulatePolicyResponse) SetIsTruncated(v bool) *SimulatePolicyResponse { s.IsTruncated = &v return s } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *SimulatePolicyResponse) SetMarker(v string) *SimulatePolicyResponse { s.Marker = &v return s } type SimulatePrincipalPolicyInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A list of names of API actions to evaluate in the simulation. Each action // is evaluated for each resource. Each action must include the service identifier, // such as iam:CreateUser. // // ActionNames is a required field ActionNames []*string `type:"list" required:"true"` // The ARN of the IAM user that you want to specify as the simulated caller // of the APIs. If you do not specify a CallerArn, it defaults to the ARN of // the user that you specify in PolicySourceArn, if you specified a user. If // you include both a PolicySourceArn (for example, arn:aws:iam::123456789012:user/David) // and a CallerArn (for example, arn:aws:iam::123456789012:user/Bob), the result // is that you simulate calling the APIs as Bob, as if Bob had David's policies. // // You can specify only the ARN of an IAM user. You cannot specify the ARN of // an assumed role, federated user, or a service principal. // // CallerArn is required if you include a ResourcePolicy and the PolicySourceArn // is not the ARN for an IAM user. This is required so that the resource-based // policy's Principal element has a value to use in evaluating the policy. // // For more information about ARNs, see Amazon Resource Names (ARNs) and AWS // Service Namespaces (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/aws-arns-and-namespaces.html) // in the AWS General Reference. CallerArn *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // A list of context keys and corresponding values for the simulation to use. // Whenever a context key is evaluated in one of the simulated IAM permission // policies, the corresponding value is supplied. ContextEntries []*ContextEntry `type:"list"` // Use this parameter only when paginating results and only after you receive // a response indicating that the results are truncated. Set it to the value // of the Marker element in the response that you received to indicate where // the next call should start. Marker *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // (Optional) Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum // number of items you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond // the maximum you specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. // // If you do not include this parameter, it defaults to 100. Note that IAM might // return fewer results, even when there are more results available. In that // case, the IsTruncated response element returns true and Marker contains a // value to include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue // from. MaxItems *int64 `min:"1" type:"integer"` // An optional list of additional policy documents to include in the simulation. // Each document is specified as a string containing the complete, valid JSON // text of an IAM policy. // // The regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex) used to validate this // parameter is a string of characters consisting of any printable ASCII character // ranging from the space character (\u0020) through end of the ASCII character // range as well as the printable characters in the Basic Latin and Latin-1 // Supplement character set (through \u00FF). It also includes the special characters // tab (\u0009), line feed (\u000A), and carriage return (\u000D). PolicyInputList []*string `type:"list"` // The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of a user, group, or role whose policies you // want to include in the simulation. If you specify a user, group, or role, // the simulation includes all policies that are associated with that entity. // If you specify a user, the simulation also includes all policies that are // attached to any groups the user belongs to. // // For more information about ARNs, see Amazon Resource Names (ARNs) and AWS // Service Namespaces (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/aws-arns-and-namespaces.html) // in the AWS General Reference. // // PolicySourceArn is a required field PolicySourceArn *string `min:"20" type:"string" required:"true"` // A list of ARNs of AWS resources to include in the simulation. If this parameter // is not provided then the value defaults to * (all resources). Each API in // the ActionNames parameter is evaluated for each resource in this list. The // simulation determines the access result (allowed or denied) of each combination // and reports it in the response. // // The simulation does not automatically retrieve policies for the specified // resources. If you want to include a resource policy in the simulation, then // you must include the policy as a string in the ResourcePolicy parameter. // // For more information about ARNs, see Amazon Resource Names (ARNs) and AWS // Service Namespaces (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/aws-arns-and-namespaces.html) // in the AWS General Reference. ResourceArns []*string `type:"list"` // Specifies the type of simulation to run. Different APIs that support resource-based // policies require different combinations of resources. By specifying the type // of simulation to run, you enable the policy simulator to enforce the presence // of the required resources to ensure reliable simulation results. If your // simulation does not match one of the following scenarios, then you can omit // this parameter. The following list shows each of the supported scenario values // and the resources that you must define to run the simulation. // // Each of the EC2 scenarios requires that you specify instance, image, and // security-group resources. If your scenario includes an EBS volume, then you // must specify that volume as a resource. If the EC2 scenario includes VPC, // then you must supply the network-interface resource. If it includes an IP // subnet, then you must specify the subnet resource. For more information on // the EC2 scenario options, see Supported Platforms (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AWSEC2/latest/UserGuide/ec2-supported-platforms.html) // in the AWS EC2 User Guide. // // * EC2-Classic-InstanceStore // // instance, image, security-group // // * EC2-Classic-EBS // // instance, image, security-group, volume // // * EC2-VPC-InstanceStore // // instance, image, security-group, network-interface // // * EC2-VPC-InstanceStore-Subnet // // instance, image, security-group, network-interface, subnet // // * EC2-VPC-EBS // // instance, image, security-group, network-interface, volume // // * EC2-VPC-EBS-Subnet // // instance, image, security-group, network-interface, subnet, volume ResourceHandlingOption *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // An AWS account ID that specifies the owner of any simulated resource that // does not identify its owner in the resource ARN, such as an S3 bucket or // object. If ResourceOwner is specified, it is also used as the account owner // of any ResourcePolicy included in the simulation. If the ResourceOwner parameter // is not specified, then the owner of the resources and the resource policy // defaults to the account of the identity provided in CallerArn. This parameter // is required only if you specify a resource-based policy and account that // owns the resource is different from the account that owns the simulated calling // user CallerArn. ResourceOwner *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // A resource-based policy to include in the simulation provided as a string. // Each resource in the simulation is treated as if it had this policy attached. // You can include only one resource-based policy in a simulation. // // The regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex) used to validate this // parameter is a string of characters consisting of any printable ASCII character // ranging from the space character (\u0020) through end of the ASCII character // range as well as the printable characters in the Basic Latin and Latin-1 // Supplement character set (through \u00FF). It also includes the special characters // tab (\u0009), line feed (\u000A), and carriage return (\u000D). ResourcePolicy *string `min:"1" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s SimulatePrincipalPolicyInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s SimulatePrincipalPolicyInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *SimulatePrincipalPolicyInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "SimulatePrincipalPolicyInput"} if s.ActionNames == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ActionNames")) } if s.CallerArn != nil && len(*s.CallerArn) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("CallerArn", 1)) } if s.Marker != nil && len(*s.Marker) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Marker", 1)) } if s.MaxItems != nil && *s.MaxItems < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("MaxItems", 1)) } if s.PolicySourceArn == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("PolicySourceArn")) } if s.PolicySourceArn != nil && len(*s.PolicySourceArn) < 20 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("PolicySourceArn", 20)) } if s.ResourceHandlingOption != nil && len(*s.ResourceHandlingOption) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("ResourceHandlingOption", 1)) } if s.ResourceOwner != nil && len(*s.ResourceOwner) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("ResourceOwner", 1)) } if s.ResourcePolicy != nil && len(*s.ResourcePolicy) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("ResourcePolicy", 1)) } if s.ContextEntries != nil { for i, v := range s.ContextEntries { if v == nil { continue } if err := v.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "ContextEntries", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetActionNames sets the ActionNames field's value. func (s *SimulatePrincipalPolicyInput) SetActionNames(v []*string) *SimulatePrincipalPolicyInput { s.ActionNames = v return s } // SetCallerArn sets the CallerArn field's value. func (s *SimulatePrincipalPolicyInput) SetCallerArn(v string) *SimulatePrincipalPolicyInput { s.CallerArn = &v return s } // SetContextEntries sets the ContextEntries field's value. func (s *SimulatePrincipalPolicyInput) SetContextEntries(v []*ContextEntry) *SimulatePrincipalPolicyInput { s.ContextEntries = v return s } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *SimulatePrincipalPolicyInput) SetMarker(v string) *SimulatePrincipalPolicyInput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetMaxItems sets the MaxItems field's value. func (s *SimulatePrincipalPolicyInput) SetMaxItems(v int64) *SimulatePrincipalPolicyInput { s.MaxItems = &v return s } // SetPolicyInputList sets the PolicyInputList field's value. func (s *SimulatePrincipalPolicyInput) SetPolicyInputList(v []*string) *SimulatePrincipalPolicyInput { s.PolicyInputList = v return s } // SetPolicySourceArn sets the PolicySourceArn field's value. func (s *SimulatePrincipalPolicyInput) SetPolicySourceArn(v string) *SimulatePrincipalPolicyInput { s.PolicySourceArn = &v return s } // SetResourceArns sets the ResourceArns field's value. func (s *SimulatePrincipalPolicyInput) SetResourceArns(v []*string) *SimulatePrincipalPolicyInput { s.ResourceArns = v return s } // SetResourceHandlingOption sets the ResourceHandlingOption field's value. func (s *SimulatePrincipalPolicyInput) SetResourceHandlingOption(v string) *SimulatePrincipalPolicyInput { s.ResourceHandlingOption = &v return s } // SetResourceOwner sets the ResourceOwner field's value. func (s *SimulatePrincipalPolicyInput) SetResourceOwner(v string) *SimulatePrincipalPolicyInput { s.ResourceOwner = &v return s } // SetResourcePolicy sets the ResourcePolicy field's value. func (s *SimulatePrincipalPolicyInput) SetResourcePolicy(v string) *SimulatePrincipalPolicyInput { s.ResourcePolicy = &v return s } // Contains a reference to a Statement element in a policy document that determines // the result of the simulation. // // This data type is used by the MatchedStatements member of the EvaluationResult // type. type Statement struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The row and column of the end of a Statement in an IAM policy. EndPosition *Position `type:"structure"` // The identifier of the policy that was provided as an input. SourcePolicyId *string `type:"string"` // The type of the policy. SourcePolicyType *string `type:"string" enum:"PolicySourceType"` // The row and column of the beginning of the Statement in an IAM policy. StartPosition *Position `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s Statement) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s Statement) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetEndPosition sets the EndPosition field's value. func (s *Statement) SetEndPosition(v *Position) *Statement { s.EndPosition = v return s } // SetSourcePolicyId sets the SourcePolicyId field's value. func (s *Statement) SetSourcePolicyId(v string) *Statement { s.SourcePolicyId = &v return s } // SetSourcePolicyType sets the SourcePolicyType field's value. func (s *Statement) SetSourcePolicyType(v string) *Statement { s.SourcePolicyType = &v return s } // SetStartPosition sets the StartPosition field's value. func (s *Statement) SetStartPosition(v *Position) *Statement { s.StartPosition = v return s } type UpdateAccessKeyInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The access key ID of the secret access key you want to update. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters that can consist of any upper or lowercased letter // or digit. // // AccessKeyId is a required field AccessKeyId *string `min:"16" type:"string" required:"true"` // The status you want to assign to the secret access key. Active means the // key can be used for API calls to AWS, while Inactive means the key cannot // be used. // // Status is a required field Status *string `type:"string" required:"true" enum:"statusType"` // The name of the user whose key you want to update. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- UserName *string `min:"1" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s UpdateAccessKeyInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s UpdateAccessKeyInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *UpdateAccessKeyInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "UpdateAccessKeyInput"} if s.AccessKeyId == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("AccessKeyId")) } if s.AccessKeyId != nil && len(*s.AccessKeyId) < 16 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("AccessKeyId", 16)) } if s.Status == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Status")) } if s.UserName != nil && len(*s.UserName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("UserName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetAccessKeyId sets the AccessKeyId field's value. func (s *UpdateAccessKeyInput) SetAccessKeyId(v string) *UpdateAccessKeyInput { s.AccessKeyId = &v return s } // SetStatus sets the Status field's value. func (s *UpdateAccessKeyInput) SetStatus(v string) *UpdateAccessKeyInput { s.Status = &v return s } // SetUserName sets the UserName field's value. func (s *UpdateAccessKeyInput) SetUserName(v string) *UpdateAccessKeyInput { s.UserName = &v return s } type UpdateAccessKeyOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s UpdateAccessKeyOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s UpdateAccessKeyOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } type UpdateAccountPasswordPolicyInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Allows all IAM users in your account to use the AWS Management Console to // change their own passwords. For more information, see Letting IAM Users Change // Their Own Passwords (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/HowToPwdIAMUser.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // Default value: false AllowUsersToChangePassword *bool `type:"boolean"` // Prevents IAM users from setting a new password after their password has expired. // // Default value: false HardExpiry *bool `type:"boolean"` // The number of days that an IAM user password is valid. The default value // of 0 means IAM user passwords never expire. // // Default value: 0 MaxPasswordAge *int64 `min:"1" type:"integer"` // The minimum number of characters allowed in an IAM user password. // // Default value: 6 MinimumPasswordLength *int64 `min:"6" type:"integer"` // Specifies the number of previous passwords that IAM users are prevented from // reusing. The default value of 0 means IAM users are not prevented from reusing // previous passwords. // // Default value: 0 PasswordReusePrevention *int64 `min:"1" type:"integer"` // Specifies whether IAM user passwords must contain at least one lowercase // character from the ISO basic Latin alphabet (a to z). // // Default value: false RequireLowercaseCharacters *bool `type:"boolean"` // Specifies whether IAM user passwords must contain at least one numeric character // (0 to 9). // // Default value: false RequireNumbers *bool `type:"boolean"` // Specifies whether IAM user passwords must contain at least one of the following // non-alphanumeric characters: // // ! @ # $ % ^ & * ( ) _ + - = [ ] { } | ' // // Default value: false RequireSymbols *bool `type:"boolean"` // Specifies whether IAM user passwords must contain at least one uppercase // character from the ISO basic Latin alphabet (A to Z). // // Default value: false RequireUppercaseCharacters *bool `type:"boolean"` } // String returns the string representation func (s UpdateAccountPasswordPolicyInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s UpdateAccountPasswordPolicyInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *UpdateAccountPasswordPolicyInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "UpdateAccountPasswordPolicyInput"} if s.MaxPasswordAge != nil && *s.MaxPasswordAge < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("MaxPasswordAge", 1)) } if s.MinimumPasswordLength != nil && *s.MinimumPasswordLength < 6 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("MinimumPasswordLength", 6)) } if s.PasswordReusePrevention != nil && *s.PasswordReusePrevention < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("PasswordReusePrevention", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetAllowUsersToChangePassword sets the AllowUsersToChangePassword field's value. func (s *UpdateAccountPasswordPolicyInput) SetAllowUsersToChangePassword(v bool) *UpdateAccountPasswordPolicyInput { s.AllowUsersToChangePassword = &v return s } // SetHardExpiry sets the HardExpiry field's value. func (s *UpdateAccountPasswordPolicyInput) SetHardExpiry(v bool) *UpdateAccountPasswordPolicyInput { s.HardExpiry = &v return s } // SetMaxPasswordAge sets the MaxPasswordAge field's value. func (s *UpdateAccountPasswordPolicyInput) SetMaxPasswordAge(v int64) *UpdateAccountPasswordPolicyInput { s.MaxPasswordAge = &v return s } // SetMinimumPasswordLength sets the MinimumPasswordLength field's value. func (s *UpdateAccountPasswordPolicyInput) SetMinimumPasswordLength(v int64) *UpdateAccountPasswordPolicyInput { s.MinimumPasswordLength = &v return s } // SetPasswordReusePrevention sets the PasswordReusePrevention field's value. func (s *UpdateAccountPasswordPolicyInput) SetPasswordReusePrevention(v int64) *UpdateAccountPasswordPolicyInput { s.PasswordReusePrevention = &v return s } // SetRequireLowercaseCharacters sets the RequireLowercaseCharacters field's value. func (s *UpdateAccountPasswordPolicyInput) SetRequireLowercaseCharacters(v bool) *UpdateAccountPasswordPolicyInput { s.RequireLowercaseCharacters = &v return s } // SetRequireNumbers sets the RequireNumbers field's value. func (s *UpdateAccountPasswordPolicyInput) SetRequireNumbers(v bool) *UpdateAccountPasswordPolicyInput { s.RequireNumbers = &v return s } // SetRequireSymbols sets the RequireSymbols field's value. func (s *UpdateAccountPasswordPolicyInput) SetRequireSymbols(v bool) *UpdateAccountPasswordPolicyInput { s.RequireSymbols = &v return s } // SetRequireUppercaseCharacters sets the RequireUppercaseCharacters field's value. func (s *UpdateAccountPasswordPolicyInput) SetRequireUppercaseCharacters(v bool) *UpdateAccountPasswordPolicyInput { s.RequireUppercaseCharacters = &v return s } type UpdateAccountPasswordPolicyOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s UpdateAccountPasswordPolicyOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s UpdateAccountPasswordPolicyOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } type UpdateAssumeRolePolicyInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The policy that grants an entity permission to assume the role. // // The regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex) used to validate this // parameter is a string of characters consisting of any printable ASCII character // ranging from the space character (\u0020) through end of the ASCII character // range as well as the printable characters in the Basic Latin and Latin-1 // Supplement character set (through \u00FF). It also includes the special characters // tab (\u0009), line feed (\u000A), and carriage return (\u000D). // // PolicyDocument is a required field PolicyDocument *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` // The name of the role to update with the new policy. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@- // // RoleName is a required field RoleName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s UpdateAssumeRolePolicyInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s UpdateAssumeRolePolicyInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *UpdateAssumeRolePolicyInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "UpdateAssumeRolePolicyInput"} if s.PolicyDocument == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("PolicyDocument")) } if s.PolicyDocument != nil && len(*s.PolicyDocument) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("PolicyDocument", 1)) } if s.RoleName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("RoleName")) } if s.RoleName != nil && len(*s.RoleName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("RoleName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetPolicyDocument sets the PolicyDocument field's value. func (s *UpdateAssumeRolePolicyInput) SetPolicyDocument(v string) *UpdateAssumeRolePolicyInput { s.PolicyDocument = &v return s } // SetRoleName sets the RoleName field's value. func (s *UpdateAssumeRolePolicyInput) SetRoleName(v string) *UpdateAssumeRolePolicyInput { s.RoleName = &v return s } type UpdateAssumeRolePolicyOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s UpdateAssumeRolePolicyOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s UpdateAssumeRolePolicyOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } type UpdateGroupInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Name of the IAM group to update. If you're changing the name of the group, // this is the original name. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- // // GroupName is a required field GroupName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` // New name for the IAM group. Only include this if changing the group's name. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- NewGroupName *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // New path for the IAM group. Only include this if changing the group's path. // // This paramater allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of either a forward slash (/) by itself // or a string that must begin and end with forward slashes, containing any // ASCII character from the ! (\u0021) thru the DEL character (\u007F), including // most punctuation characters, digits, and upper and lowercased letters. NewPath *string `min:"1" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s UpdateGroupInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s UpdateGroupInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *UpdateGroupInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "UpdateGroupInput"} if s.GroupName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("GroupName")) } if s.GroupName != nil && len(*s.GroupName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("GroupName", 1)) } if s.NewGroupName != nil && len(*s.NewGroupName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("NewGroupName", 1)) } if s.NewPath != nil && len(*s.NewPath) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("NewPath", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetGroupName sets the GroupName field's value. func (s *UpdateGroupInput) SetGroupName(v string) *UpdateGroupInput { s.GroupName = &v return s } // SetNewGroupName sets the NewGroupName field's value. func (s *UpdateGroupInput) SetNewGroupName(v string) *UpdateGroupInput { s.NewGroupName = &v return s } // SetNewPath sets the NewPath field's value. func (s *UpdateGroupInput) SetNewPath(v string) *UpdateGroupInput { s.NewPath = &v return s } type UpdateGroupOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s UpdateGroupOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s UpdateGroupOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } type UpdateLoginProfileInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The new password for the specified IAM user. // // The regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex) used to validate this // parameter is a string of characters consisting of any printable ASCII character // ranging from the space character (\u0020) through end of the ASCII character // range as well as the printable characters in the Basic Latin and Latin-1 // Supplement character set (through \u00FF). It also includes the special characters // tab (\u0009), line feed (\u000A), and carriage return (\u000D). However, // the format can be further restricted by the account administrator by setting // a password policy on the AWS account. For more information, see UpdateAccountPasswordPolicy. Password *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // Allows this new password to be used only once by requiring the specified // IAM user to set a new password on next sign-in. PasswordResetRequired *bool `type:"boolean"` // The name of the user whose password you want to update. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- // // UserName is a required field UserName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s UpdateLoginProfileInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s UpdateLoginProfileInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *UpdateLoginProfileInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "UpdateLoginProfileInput"} if s.Password != nil && len(*s.Password) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Password", 1)) } if s.UserName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("UserName")) } if s.UserName != nil && len(*s.UserName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("UserName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetPassword sets the Password field's value. func (s *UpdateLoginProfileInput) SetPassword(v string) *UpdateLoginProfileInput { s.Password = &v return s } // SetPasswordResetRequired sets the PasswordResetRequired field's value. func (s *UpdateLoginProfileInput) SetPasswordResetRequired(v bool) *UpdateLoginProfileInput { s.PasswordResetRequired = &v return s } // SetUserName sets the UserName field's value. func (s *UpdateLoginProfileInput) SetUserName(v string) *UpdateLoginProfileInput { s.UserName = &v return s } type UpdateLoginProfileOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s UpdateLoginProfileOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s UpdateLoginProfileOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } type UpdateOpenIDConnectProviderThumbprintInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the IAM OIDC provider resource object for // which you want to update the thumbprint. You can get a list of OIDC provider // ARNs by using the ListOpenIDConnectProviders action. // // For more information about ARNs, see Amazon Resource Names (ARNs) and AWS // Service Namespaces (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/aws-arns-and-namespaces.html) // in the AWS General Reference. // // OpenIDConnectProviderArn is a required field OpenIDConnectProviderArn *string `min:"20" type:"string" required:"true"` // A list of certificate thumbprints that are associated with the specified // IAM OpenID Connect provider. For more information, see CreateOpenIDConnectProvider. // // ThumbprintList is a required field ThumbprintList []*string `type:"list" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s UpdateOpenIDConnectProviderThumbprintInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s UpdateOpenIDConnectProviderThumbprintInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *UpdateOpenIDConnectProviderThumbprintInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "UpdateOpenIDConnectProviderThumbprintInput"} if s.OpenIDConnectProviderArn == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("OpenIDConnectProviderArn")) } if s.OpenIDConnectProviderArn != nil && len(*s.OpenIDConnectProviderArn) < 20 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("OpenIDConnectProviderArn", 20)) } if s.ThumbprintList == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ThumbprintList")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetOpenIDConnectProviderArn sets the OpenIDConnectProviderArn field's value. func (s *UpdateOpenIDConnectProviderThumbprintInput) SetOpenIDConnectProviderArn(v string) *UpdateOpenIDConnectProviderThumbprintInput { s.OpenIDConnectProviderArn = &v return s } // SetThumbprintList sets the ThumbprintList field's value. func (s *UpdateOpenIDConnectProviderThumbprintInput) SetThumbprintList(v []*string) *UpdateOpenIDConnectProviderThumbprintInput { s.ThumbprintList = v return s } type UpdateOpenIDConnectProviderThumbprintOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s UpdateOpenIDConnectProviderThumbprintOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s UpdateOpenIDConnectProviderThumbprintOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } type UpdateRoleDescriptionInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The new description that you want to apply to the specified role. // // Description is a required field Description *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // The name of the role that you want to modify. // // RoleName is a required field RoleName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s UpdateRoleDescriptionInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s UpdateRoleDescriptionInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *UpdateRoleDescriptionInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "UpdateRoleDescriptionInput"} if s.Description == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Description")) } if s.RoleName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("RoleName")) } if s.RoleName != nil && len(*s.RoleName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("RoleName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetDescription sets the Description field's value. func (s *UpdateRoleDescriptionInput) SetDescription(v string) *UpdateRoleDescriptionInput { s.Description = &v return s } // SetRoleName sets the RoleName field's value. func (s *UpdateRoleDescriptionInput) SetRoleName(v string) *UpdateRoleDescriptionInput { s.RoleName = &v return s } type UpdateRoleDescriptionOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A structure that contains details about the modified role. Role *Role `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s UpdateRoleDescriptionOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s UpdateRoleDescriptionOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetRole sets the Role field's value. func (s *UpdateRoleDescriptionOutput) SetRole(v *Role) *UpdateRoleDescriptionOutput { s.Role = v return s } type UpdateSAMLProviderInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // An XML document generated by an identity provider (IdP) that supports SAML // 2.0. The document includes the issuer's name, expiration information, and // keys that can be used to validate the SAML authentication response (assertions) // that are received from the IdP. You must generate the metadata document using // the identity management software that is used as your organization's IdP. // // SAMLMetadataDocument is a required field SAMLMetadataDocument *string `min:"1000" type:"string" required:"true"` // The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the SAML provider to update. // // For more information about ARNs, see Amazon Resource Names (ARNs) and AWS // Service Namespaces (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/aws-arns-and-namespaces.html) // in the AWS General Reference. // // SAMLProviderArn is a required field SAMLProviderArn *string `min:"20" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s UpdateSAMLProviderInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s UpdateSAMLProviderInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *UpdateSAMLProviderInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "UpdateSAMLProviderInput"} if s.SAMLMetadataDocument == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SAMLMetadataDocument")) } if s.SAMLMetadataDocument != nil && len(*s.SAMLMetadataDocument) < 1000 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("SAMLMetadataDocument", 1000)) } if s.SAMLProviderArn == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SAMLProviderArn")) } if s.SAMLProviderArn != nil && len(*s.SAMLProviderArn) < 20 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("SAMLProviderArn", 20)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetSAMLMetadataDocument sets the SAMLMetadataDocument field's value. func (s *UpdateSAMLProviderInput) SetSAMLMetadataDocument(v string) *UpdateSAMLProviderInput { s.SAMLMetadataDocument = &v return s } // SetSAMLProviderArn sets the SAMLProviderArn field's value. func (s *UpdateSAMLProviderInput) SetSAMLProviderArn(v string) *UpdateSAMLProviderInput { s.SAMLProviderArn = &v return s } // Contains the response to a successful UpdateSAMLProvider request. type UpdateSAMLProviderOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the SAML provider that was updated. SAMLProviderArn *string `min:"20" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s UpdateSAMLProviderOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s UpdateSAMLProviderOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetSAMLProviderArn sets the SAMLProviderArn field's value. func (s *UpdateSAMLProviderOutput) SetSAMLProviderArn(v string) *UpdateSAMLProviderOutput { s.SAMLProviderArn = &v return s } type UpdateSSHPublicKeyInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The unique identifier for the SSH public key. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters that can consist of any upper or lowercased letter // or digit. // // SSHPublicKeyId is a required field SSHPublicKeyId *string `min:"20" type:"string" required:"true"` // The status to assign to the SSH public key. Active means the key can be used // for authentication with an AWS CodeCommit repository. Inactive means the // key cannot be used. // // Status is a required field Status *string `type:"string" required:"true" enum:"statusType"` // The name of the IAM user associated with the SSH public key. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- // // UserName is a required field UserName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s UpdateSSHPublicKeyInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s UpdateSSHPublicKeyInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *UpdateSSHPublicKeyInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "UpdateSSHPublicKeyInput"} if s.SSHPublicKeyId == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SSHPublicKeyId")) } if s.SSHPublicKeyId != nil && len(*s.SSHPublicKeyId) < 20 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("SSHPublicKeyId", 20)) } if s.Status == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Status")) } if s.UserName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("UserName")) } if s.UserName != nil && len(*s.UserName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("UserName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetSSHPublicKeyId sets the SSHPublicKeyId field's value. func (s *UpdateSSHPublicKeyInput) SetSSHPublicKeyId(v string) *UpdateSSHPublicKeyInput { s.SSHPublicKeyId = &v return s } // SetStatus sets the Status field's value. func (s *UpdateSSHPublicKeyInput) SetStatus(v string) *UpdateSSHPublicKeyInput { s.Status = &v return s } // SetUserName sets the UserName field's value. func (s *UpdateSSHPublicKeyInput) SetUserName(v string) *UpdateSSHPublicKeyInput { s.UserName = &v return s } type UpdateSSHPublicKeyOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s UpdateSSHPublicKeyOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s UpdateSSHPublicKeyOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } type UpdateServerCertificateInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The new path for the server certificate. Include this only if you are updating // the server certificate's path. // // This paramater allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of either a forward slash (/) by itself // or a string that must begin and end with forward slashes, containing any // ASCII character from the ! (\u0021) thru the DEL character (\u007F), including // most punctuation characters, digits, and upper and lowercased letters. NewPath *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // The new name for the server certificate. Include this only if you are updating // the server certificate's name. The name of the certificate cannot contain // any spaces. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- NewServerCertificateName *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // The name of the server certificate that you want to update. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- // // ServerCertificateName is a required field ServerCertificateName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s UpdateServerCertificateInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s UpdateServerCertificateInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *UpdateServerCertificateInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "UpdateServerCertificateInput"} if s.NewPath != nil && len(*s.NewPath) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("NewPath", 1)) } if s.NewServerCertificateName != nil && len(*s.NewServerCertificateName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("NewServerCertificateName", 1)) } if s.ServerCertificateName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ServerCertificateName")) } if s.ServerCertificateName != nil && len(*s.ServerCertificateName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("ServerCertificateName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetNewPath sets the NewPath field's value. func (s *UpdateServerCertificateInput) SetNewPath(v string) *UpdateServerCertificateInput { s.NewPath = &v return s } // SetNewServerCertificateName sets the NewServerCertificateName field's value. func (s *UpdateServerCertificateInput) SetNewServerCertificateName(v string) *UpdateServerCertificateInput { s.NewServerCertificateName = &v return s } // SetServerCertificateName sets the ServerCertificateName field's value. func (s *UpdateServerCertificateInput) SetServerCertificateName(v string) *UpdateServerCertificateInput { s.ServerCertificateName = &v return s } type UpdateServerCertificateOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s UpdateServerCertificateOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s UpdateServerCertificateOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } type UpdateServiceSpecificCredentialInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The unique identifier of the service-specific credential. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters that can consist of any upper or lowercased letter // or digit. // // ServiceSpecificCredentialId is a required field ServiceSpecificCredentialId *string `min:"20" type:"string" required:"true"` // The status to be assigned to the service-specific credential. // // Status is a required field Status *string `type:"string" required:"true" enum:"statusType"` // The name of the IAM user associated with the service-specific credential. // If you do not specify this value, then the operation assumes the user whose // credentials are used to call the operation. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- UserName *string `min:"1" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s UpdateServiceSpecificCredentialInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s UpdateServiceSpecificCredentialInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *UpdateServiceSpecificCredentialInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "UpdateServiceSpecificCredentialInput"} if s.ServiceSpecificCredentialId == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ServiceSpecificCredentialId")) } if s.ServiceSpecificCredentialId != nil && len(*s.ServiceSpecificCredentialId) < 20 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("ServiceSpecificCredentialId", 20)) } if s.Status == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Status")) } if s.UserName != nil && len(*s.UserName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("UserName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetServiceSpecificCredentialId sets the ServiceSpecificCredentialId field's value. func (s *UpdateServiceSpecificCredentialInput) SetServiceSpecificCredentialId(v string) *UpdateServiceSpecificCredentialInput { s.ServiceSpecificCredentialId = &v return s } // SetStatus sets the Status field's value. func (s *UpdateServiceSpecificCredentialInput) SetStatus(v string) *UpdateServiceSpecificCredentialInput { s.Status = &v return s } // SetUserName sets the UserName field's value. func (s *UpdateServiceSpecificCredentialInput) SetUserName(v string) *UpdateServiceSpecificCredentialInput { s.UserName = &v return s } type UpdateServiceSpecificCredentialOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s UpdateServiceSpecificCredentialOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s UpdateServiceSpecificCredentialOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } type UpdateSigningCertificateInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The ID of the signing certificate you want to update. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters that can consist of any upper or lowercased letter // or digit. // // CertificateId is a required field CertificateId *string `min:"24" type:"string" required:"true"` // The status you want to assign to the certificate. Active means the certificate // can be used for API calls to AWS, while Inactive means the certificate cannot // be used. // // Status is a required field Status *string `type:"string" required:"true" enum:"statusType"` // The name of the IAM user the signing certificate belongs to. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- UserName *string `min:"1" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s UpdateSigningCertificateInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s UpdateSigningCertificateInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *UpdateSigningCertificateInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "UpdateSigningCertificateInput"} if s.CertificateId == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("CertificateId")) } if s.CertificateId != nil && len(*s.CertificateId) < 24 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("CertificateId", 24)) } if s.Status == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Status")) } if s.UserName != nil && len(*s.UserName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("UserName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetCertificateId sets the CertificateId field's value. func (s *UpdateSigningCertificateInput) SetCertificateId(v string) *UpdateSigningCertificateInput { s.CertificateId = &v return s } // SetStatus sets the Status field's value. func (s *UpdateSigningCertificateInput) SetStatus(v string) *UpdateSigningCertificateInput { s.Status = &v return s } // SetUserName sets the UserName field's value. func (s *UpdateSigningCertificateInput) SetUserName(v string) *UpdateSigningCertificateInput { s.UserName = &v return s } type UpdateSigningCertificateOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s UpdateSigningCertificateOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s UpdateSigningCertificateOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } type UpdateUserInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // New path for the IAM user. Include this parameter only if you're changing // the user's path. // // This paramater allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of either a forward slash (/) by itself // or a string that must begin and end with forward slashes, containing any // ASCII character from the ! (\u0021) thru the DEL character (\u007F), including // most punctuation characters, digits, and upper and lowercased letters. NewPath *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // New name for the user. Include this parameter only if you're changing the // user's name. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- NewUserName *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // Name of the user to update. If you're changing the name of the user, this // is the original user name. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- // // UserName is a required field UserName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s UpdateUserInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s UpdateUserInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *UpdateUserInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "UpdateUserInput"} if s.NewPath != nil && len(*s.NewPath) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("NewPath", 1)) } if s.NewUserName != nil && len(*s.NewUserName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("NewUserName", 1)) } if s.UserName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("UserName")) } if s.UserName != nil && len(*s.UserName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("UserName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetNewPath sets the NewPath field's value. func (s *UpdateUserInput) SetNewPath(v string) *UpdateUserInput { s.NewPath = &v return s } // SetNewUserName sets the NewUserName field's value. func (s *UpdateUserInput) SetNewUserName(v string) *UpdateUserInput { s.NewUserName = &v return s } // SetUserName sets the UserName field's value. func (s *UpdateUserInput) SetUserName(v string) *UpdateUserInput { s.UserName = &v return s } type UpdateUserOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s UpdateUserOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s UpdateUserOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } type UploadSSHPublicKeyInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The SSH public key. The public key must be encoded in ssh-rsa format or PEM // format. // // The regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex) used to validate this // parameter is a string of characters consisting of any printable ASCII character // ranging from the space character (\u0020) through end of the ASCII character // range as well as the printable characters in the Basic Latin and Latin-1 // Supplement character set (through \u00FF). It also includes the special characters // tab (\u0009), line feed (\u000A), and carriage return (\u000D). // // SSHPublicKeyBody is a required field SSHPublicKeyBody *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` // The name of the IAM user to associate the SSH public key with. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- // // UserName is a required field UserName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s UploadSSHPublicKeyInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s UploadSSHPublicKeyInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *UploadSSHPublicKeyInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "UploadSSHPublicKeyInput"} if s.SSHPublicKeyBody == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SSHPublicKeyBody")) } if s.SSHPublicKeyBody != nil && len(*s.SSHPublicKeyBody) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("SSHPublicKeyBody", 1)) } if s.UserName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("UserName")) } if s.UserName != nil && len(*s.UserName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("UserName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetSSHPublicKeyBody sets the SSHPublicKeyBody field's value. func (s *UploadSSHPublicKeyInput) SetSSHPublicKeyBody(v string) *UploadSSHPublicKeyInput { s.SSHPublicKeyBody = &v return s } // SetUserName sets the UserName field's value. func (s *UploadSSHPublicKeyInput) SetUserName(v string) *UploadSSHPublicKeyInput { s.UserName = &v return s } // Contains the response to a successful UploadSSHPublicKey request. type UploadSSHPublicKeyOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Contains information about the SSH public key. SSHPublicKey *SSHPublicKey `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s UploadSSHPublicKeyOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s UploadSSHPublicKeyOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetSSHPublicKey sets the SSHPublicKey field's value. func (s *UploadSSHPublicKeyOutput) SetSSHPublicKey(v *SSHPublicKey) *UploadSSHPublicKeyOutput { s.SSHPublicKey = v return s } type UploadServerCertificateInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The contents of the public key certificate in PEM-encoded format. // // The regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex) used to validate this // parameter is a string of characters consisting of any printable ASCII character // ranging from the space character (\u0020) through end of the ASCII character // range as well as the printable characters in the Basic Latin and Latin-1 // Supplement character set (through \u00FF). It also includes the special characters // tab (\u0009), line feed (\u000A), and carriage return (\u000D). // // CertificateBody is a required field CertificateBody *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` // The contents of the certificate chain. This is typically a concatenation // of the PEM-encoded public key certificates of the chain. // // The regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex) used to validate this // parameter is a string of characters consisting of any printable ASCII character // ranging from the space character (\u0020) through end of the ASCII character // range as well as the printable characters in the Basic Latin and Latin-1 // Supplement character set (through \u00FF). It also includes the special characters // tab (\u0009), line feed (\u000A), and carriage return (\u000D). CertificateChain *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // The path for the server certificate. For more information about paths, see // IAM Identifiers (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/Using_Identifiers.html) // in the IAM User Guide. // // This parameter is optional. If it is not included, it defaults to a slash // (/). This paramater allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of either a forward slash (/) by itself // or a string that must begin and end with forward slashes, containing any // ASCII character from the ! (\u0021) thru the DEL character (\u007F), including // most punctuation characters, digits, and upper and lowercased letters. // // If you are uploading a server certificate specifically for use with Amazon // CloudFront distributions, you must specify a path using the --path option. // The path must begin with /cloudfront and must include a trailing slash (for // example, /cloudfront/test/). Path *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // The contents of the private key in PEM-encoded format. // // The regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex) used to validate this // parameter is a string of characters consisting of any printable ASCII character // ranging from the space character (\u0020) through end of the ASCII character // range as well as the printable characters in the Basic Latin and Latin-1 // Supplement character set (through \u00FF). It also includes the special characters // tab (\u0009), line feed (\u000A), and carriage return (\u000D). // // PrivateKey is a required field PrivateKey *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` // The name for the server certificate. Do not include the path in this value. // The name of the certificate cannot contain any spaces. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- // // ServerCertificateName is a required field ServerCertificateName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s UploadServerCertificateInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s UploadServerCertificateInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *UploadServerCertificateInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "UploadServerCertificateInput"} if s.CertificateBody == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("CertificateBody")) } if s.CertificateBody != nil && len(*s.CertificateBody) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("CertificateBody", 1)) } if s.CertificateChain != nil && len(*s.CertificateChain) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("CertificateChain", 1)) } if s.Path != nil && len(*s.Path) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Path", 1)) } if s.PrivateKey == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("PrivateKey")) } if s.PrivateKey != nil && len(*s.PrivateKey) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("PrivateKey", 1)) } if s.ServerCertificateName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ServerCertificateName")) } if s.ServerCertificateName != nil && len(*s.ServerCertificateName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("ServerCertificateName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetCertificateBody sets the CertificateBody field's value. func (s *UploadServerCertificateInput) SetCertificateBody(v string) *UploadServerCertificateInput { s.CertificateBody = &v return s } // SetCertificateChain sets the CertificateChain field's value. func (s *UploadServerCertificateInput) SetCertificateChain(v string) *UploadServerCertificateInput { s.CertificateChain = &v return s } // SetPath sets the Path field's value. func (s *UploadServerCertificateInput) SetPath(v string) *UploadServerCertificateInput { s.Path = &v return s } // SetPrivateKey sets the PrivateKey field's value. func (s *UploadServerCertificateInput) SetPrivateKey(v string) *UploadServerCertificateInput { s.PrivateKey = &v return s } // SetServerCertificateName sets the ServerCertificateName field's value. func (s *UploadServerCertificateInput) SetServerCertificateName(v string) *UploadServerCertificateInput { s.ServerCertificateName = &v return s } // Contains the response to a successful UploadServerCertificate request. type UploadServerCertificateOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The meta information of the uploaded server certificate without its certificate // body, certificate chain, and private key. ServerCertificateMetadata *ServerCertificateMetadata `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s UploadServerCertificateOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s UploadServerCertificateOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetServerCertificateMetadata sets the ServerCertificateMetadata field's value. func (s *UploadServerCertificateOutput) SetServerCertificateMetadata(v *ServerCertificateMetadata) *UploadServerCertificateOutput { s.ServerCertificateMetadata = v return s } type UploadSigningCertificateInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The contents of the signing certificate. // // The regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex) used to validate this // parameter is a string of characters consisting of any printable ASCII character // ranging from the space character (\u0020) through end of the ASCII character // range as well as the printable characters in the Basic Latin and Latin-1 // Supplement character set (through \u00FF). It also includes the special characters // tab (\u0009), line feed (\u000A), and carriage return (\u000D). // // CertificateBody is a required field CertificateBody *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` // The name of the user the signing certificate is for. // // This parameter allows (per its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) // a string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters // with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@- UserName *string `min:"1" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s UploadSigningCertificateInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s UploadSigningCertificateInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *UploadSigningCertificateInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "UploadSigningCertificateInput"} if s.CertificateBody == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("CertificateBody")) } if s.CertificateBody != nil && len(*s.CertificateBody) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("CertificateBody", 1)) } if s.UserName != nil && len(*s.UserName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("UserName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetCertificateBody sets the CertificateBody field's value. func (s *UploadSigningCertificateInput) SetCertificateBody(v string) *UploadSigningCertificateInput { s.CertificateBody = &v return s } // SetUserName sets the UserName field's value. func (s *UploadSigningCertificateInput) SetUserName(v string) *UploadSigningCertificateInput { s.UserName = &v return s } // Contains the response to a successful UploadSigningCertificate request. type UploadSigningCertificateOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Information about the certificate. // // Certificate is a required field Certificate *SigningCertificate `type:"structure" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s UploadSigningCertificateOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s UploadSigningCertificateOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetCertificate sets the Certificate field's value. func (s *UploadSigningCertificateOutput) SetCertificate(v *SigningCertificate) *UploadSigningCertificateOutput { s.Certificate = v return s } // Contains information about an IAM user entity. // // This data type is used as a response element in the following actions: // // * CreateUser // // * GetUser // // * ListUsers type User struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) that identifies the user. For more information // about ARNs and how to use ARNs in policies, see IAM Identifiers (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/Using_Identifiers.html) // in the Using IAM guide. // // Arn is a required field Arn *string `min:"20" type:"string" required:"true"` // The date and time, in ISO 8601 date-time format (http://www.iso.org/iso/iso8601), // when the user was created. // // CreateDate is a required field CreateDate *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601" required:"true"` // The date and time, in ISO 8601 date-time format (http://www.iso.org/iso/iso8601), // when the user's password was last used to sign in to an AWS website. For // a list of AWS websites that capture a user's last sign-in time, see the Credential // Reports (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/credential-reports.html) // topic in the Using IAM guide. If a password is used more than once in a five-minute // span, only the first use is returned in this field. If the field is null // (no value) then it indicates that they never signed in with a password. This // can be because: // // * The user never had a password. // // * A password exists but has not been used since IAM started tracking this // information on October 20th, 2014. // // A null does not mean that the user never had a password. Also, if the user // does not currently have a password, but had one in the past, then this field // contains the date and time the most recent password was used. // // This value is returned only in the GetUser and ListUsers actions. PasswordLastUsed *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"` // The path to the user. For more information about paths, see IAM Identifiers // (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/Using_Identifiers.html) // in the Using IAM guide. // // Path is a required field Path *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` // The stable and unique string identifying the user. For more information about // IDs, see IAM Identifiers (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/Using_Identifiers.html) // in the Using IAM guide. // // UserId is a required field UserId *string `min:"16" type:"string" required:"true"` // The friendly name identifying the user. // // UserName is a required field UserName *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s User) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s User) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetArn sets the Arn field's value. func (s *User) SetArn(v string) *User { s.Arn = &v return s } // SetCreateDate sets the CreateDate field's value. func (s *User) SetCreateDate(v time.Time) *User { s.CreateDate = &v return s } // SetPasswordLastUsed sets the PasswordLastUsed field's value. func (s *User) SetPasswordLastUsed(v time.Time) *User { s.PasswordLastUsed = &v return s } // SetPath sets the Path field's value. func (s *User) SetPath(v string) *User { s.Path = &v return s } // SetUserId sets the UserId field's value. func (s *User) SetUserId(v string) *User { s.UserId = &v return s } // SetUserName sets the UserName field's value. func (s *User) SetUserName(v string) *User { s.UserName = &v return s } // Contains information about an IAM user, including all the user's policies // and all the IAM groups the user is in. // // This data type is used as a response element in the GetAccountAuthorizationDetails // action. type UserDetail struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The Amazon Resource Name (ARN). ARNs are unique identifiers for AWS resources. // // For more information about ARNs, go to Amazon Resource Names (ARNs) and AWS // Service Namespaces (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/aws-arns-and-namespaces.html) // in the AWS General Reference. Arn *string `min:"20" type:"string"` // A list of the managed policies attached to the user. AttachedManagedPolicies []*AttachedPolicy `type:"list"` // The date and time, in ISO 8601 date-time format (http://www.iso.org/iso/iso8601), // when the user was created. CreateDate *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"` // A list of IAM groups that the user is in. GroupList []*string `type:"list"` // The path to the user. For more information about paths, see IAM Identifiers // (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/Using_Identifiers.html) // in the Using IAM guide. Path *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // The stable and unique string identifying the user. For more information about // IDs, see IAM Identifiers (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/Using_Identifiers.html) // in the Using IAM guide. UserId *string `min:"16" type:"string"` // The friendly name identifying the user. UserName *string `min:"1" type:"string"` // A list of the inline policies embedded in the user. UserPolicyList []*PolicyDetail `type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s UserDetail) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s UserDetail) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetArn sets the Arn field's value. func (s *UserDetail) SetArn(v string) *UserDetail { s.Arn = &v return s } // SetAttachedManagedPolicies sets the AttachedManagedPolicies field's value. func (s *UserDetail) SetAttachedManagedPolicies(v []*AttachedPolicy) *UserDetail { s.AttachedManagedPolicies = v return s } // SetCreateDate sets the CreateDate field's value. func (s *UserDetail) SetCreateDate(v time.Time) *UserDetail { s.CreateDate = &v return s } // SetGroupList sets the GroupList field's value. func (s *UserDetail) SetGroupList(v []*string) *UserDetail { s.GroupList = v return s } // SetPath sets the Path field's value. func (s *UserDetail) SetPath(v string) *UserDetail { s.Path = &v return s } // SetUserId sets the UserId field's value. func (s *UserDetail) SetUserId(v string) *UserDetail { s.UserId = &v return s } // SetUserName sets the UserName field's value. func (s *UserDetail) SetUserName(v string) *UserDetail { s.UserName = &v return s } // SetUserPolicyList sets the UserPolicyList field's value. func (s *UserDetail) SetUserPolicyList(v []*PolicyDetail) *UserDetail { s.UserPolicyList = v return s } // Contains information about a virtual MFA device. type VirtualMFADevice struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The Base32 seed defined as specified in RFC3548 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3548.txt). // The Base32StringSeed is Base64-encoded. // // Base32StringSeed is automatically base64 encoded/decoded by the SDK. Base32StringSeed []byte `type:"blob"` // The date and time on which the virtual MFA device was enabled. EnableDate *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"` // A QR code PNG image that encodes otpauth://totp/$virtualMFADeviceName@$AccountName?secret=$Base32String // where $virtualMFADeviceName is one of the create call arguments, AccountName // is the user name if set (otherwise, the account ID otherwise), and Base32String // is the seed in Base32 format. The Base32String value is Base64-encoded. // // QRCodePNG is automatically base64 encoded/decoded by the SDK. QRCodePNG []byte `type:"blob"` // The serial number associated with VirtualMFADevice. // // SerialNumber is a required field SerialNumber *string `min:"9" type:"string" required:"true"` // The IAM user associated with this virtual MFA device. User *User `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s VirtualMFADevice) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s VirtualMFADevice) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetBase32StringSeed sets the Base32StringSeed field's value. func (s *VirtualMFADevice) SetBase32StringSeed(v []byte) *VirtualMFADevice { s.Base32StringSeed = v return s } // SetEnableDate sets the EnableDate field's value. func (s *VirtualMFADevice) SetEnableDate(v time.Time) *VirtualMFADevice { s.EnableDate = &v return s } // SetQRCodePNG sets the QRCodePNG field's value. func (s *VirtualMFADevice) SetQRCodePNG(v []byte) *VirtualMFADevice { s.QRCodePNG = v return s } // SetSerialNumber sets the SerialNumber field's value. func (s *VirtualMFADevice) SetSerialNumber(v string) *VirtualMFADevice { s.SerialNumber = &v return s } // SetUser sets the User field's value. func (s *VirtualMFADevice) SetUser(v *User) *VirtualMFADevice { s.User = v return s } const ( // ContextKeyTypeEnumString is a ContextKeyTypeEnum enum value ContextKeyTypeEnumString = "string" // ContextKeyTypeEnumStringList is a ContextKeyTypeEnum enum value ContextKeyTypeEnumStringList = "stringList" // ContextKeyTypeEnumNumeric is a ContextKeyTypeEnum enum value ContextKeyTypeEnumNumeric = "numeric" // ContextKeyTypeEnumNumericList is a ContextKeyTypeEnum enum value ContextKeyTypeEnumNumericList = "numericList" // ContextKeyTypeEnumBoolean is a ContextKeyTypeEnum enum value ContextKeyTypeEnumBoolean = "boolean" // ContextKeyTypeEnumBooleanList is a ContextKeyTypeEnum enum value ContextKeyTypeEnumBooleanList = "booleanList" // ContextKeyTypeEnumIp is a ContextKeyTypeEnum enum value ContextKeyTypeEnumIp = "ip" // ContextKeyTypeEnumIpList is a ContextKeyTypeEnum enum value ContextKeyTypeEnumIpList = "ipList" // ContextKeyTypeEnumBinary is a ContextKeyTypeEnum enum value ContextKeyTypeEnumBinary = "binary" // ContextKeyTypeEnumBinaryList is a ContextKeyTypeEnum enum value ContextKeyTypeEnumBinaryList = "binaryList" // ContextKeyTypeEnumDate is a ContextKeyTypeEnum enum value ContextKeyTypeEnumDate = "date" // ContextKeyTypeEnumDateList is a ContextKeyTypeEnum enum value ContextKeyTypeEnumDateList = "dateList" ) const ( // DeletionTaskStatusTypeSucceeded is a DeletionTaskStatusType enum value DeletionTaskStatusTypeSucceeded = "SUCCEEDED" // DeletionTaskStatusTypeInProgress is a DeletionTaskStatusType enum value DeletionTaskStatusTypeInProgress = "IN_PROGRESS" // DeletionTaskStatusTypeFailed is a DeletionTaskStatusType enum value DeletionTaskStatusTypeFailed = "FAILED" // DeletionTaskStatusTypeNotStarted is a DeletionTaskStatusType enum value DeletionTaskStatusTypeNotStarted = "NOT_STARTED" ) const ( // EntityTypeUser is a EntityType enum value EntityTypeUser = "User" // EntityTypeRole is a EntityType enum value EntityTypeRole = "Role" // EntityTypeGroup is a EntityType enum value EntityTypeGroup = "Group" // EntityTypeLocalManagedPolicy is a EntityType enum value EntityTypeLocalManagedPolicy = "LocalManagedPolicy" // EntityTypeAwsmanagedPolicy is a EntityType enum value EntityTypeAwsmanagedPolicy = "AWSManagedPolicy" ) const ( // PolicyEvaluationDecisionTypeAllowed is a PolicyEvaluationDecisionType enum value PolicyEvaluationDecisionTypeAllowed = "allowed" // PolicyEvaluationDecisionTypeExplicitDeny is a PolicyEvaluationDecisionType enum value PolicyEvaluationDecisionTypeExplicitDeny = "explicitDeny" // PolicyEvaluationDecisionTypeImplicitDeny is a PolicyEvaluationDecisionType enum value PolicyEvaluationDecisionTypeImplicitDeny = "implicitDeny" ) const ( // PolicySourceTypeUser is a PolicySourceType enum value PolicySourceTypeUser = "user" // PolicySourceTypeGroup is a PolicySourceType enum value PolicySourceTypeGroup = "group" // PolicySourceTypeRole is a PolicySourceType enum value PolicySourceTypeRole = "role" // PolicySourceTypeAwsManaged is a PolicySourceType enum value PolicySourceTypeAwsManaged = "aws-managed" // PolicySourceTypeUserManaged is a PolicySourceType enum value PolicySourceTypeUserManaged = "user-managed" // PolicySourceTypeResource is a PolicySourceType enum value PolicySourceTypeResource = "resource" // PolicySourceTypeNone is a PolicySourceType enum value PolicySourceTypeNone = "none" ) const ( // ReportFormatTypeTextCsv is a ReportFormatType enum value ReportFormatTypeTextCsv = "text/csv" ) const ( // ReportStateTypeStarted is a ReportStateType enum value ReportStateTypeStarted = "STARTED" // ReportStateTypeInprogress is a ReportStateType enum value ReportStateTypeInprogress = "INPROGRESS" // ReportStateTypeComplete is a ReportStateType enum value ReportStateTypeComplete = "COMPLETE" ) const ( // AssignmentStatusTypeAssigned is a assignmentStatusType enum value AssignmentStatusTypeAssigned = "Assigned" // AssignmentStatusTypeUnassigned is a assignmentStatusType enum value AssignmentStatusTypeUnassigned = "Unassigned" // AssignmentStatusTypeAny is a assignmentStatusType enum value AssignmentStatusTypeAny = "Any" ) const ( // EncodingTypeSsh is a encodingType enum value EncodingTypeSsh = "SSH" // EncodingTypePem is a encodingType enum value EncodingTypePem = "PEM" ) const ( // PolicyScopeTypeAll is a policyScopeType enum value PolicyScopeTypeAll = "All" // PolicyScopeTypeAws is a policyScopeType enum value PolicyScopeTypeAws = "AWS" // PolicyScopeTypeLocal is a policyScopeType enum value PolicyScopeTypeLocal = "Local" ) const ( // StatusTypeActive is a statusType enum value StatusTypeActive = "Active" // StatusTypeInactive is a statusType enum value StatusTypeInactive = "Inactive" ) const ( // SummaryKeyTypeUsers is a summaryKeyType enum value SummaryKeyTypeUsers = "Users" // SummaryKeyTypeUsersQuota is a summaryKeyType enum value SummaryKeyTypeUsersQuota = "UsersQuota" // SummaryKeyTypeGroups is a summaryKeyType enum value SummaryKeyTypeGroups = "Groups" // SummaryKeyTypeGroupsQuota is a summaryKeyType enum value SummaryKeyTypeGroupsQuota = "GroupsQuota" // SummaryKeyTypeServerCertificates is a summaryKeyType enum value SummaryKeyTypeServerCertificates = "ServerCertificates" // SummaryKeyTypeServerCertificatesQuota is a summaryKeyType enum value SummaryKeyTypeServerCertificatesQuota = "ServerCertificatesQuota" // SummaryKeyTypeUserPolicySizeQuota is a summaryKeyType enum value SummaryKeyTypeUserPolicySizeQuota = "UserPolicySizeQuota" // SummaryKeyTypeGroupPolicySizeQuota is a summaryKeyType enum value SummaryKeyTypeGroupPolicySizeQuota = "GroupPolicySizeQuota" // SummaryKeyTypeGroupsPerUserQuota is a summaryKeyType enum value SummaryKeyTypeGroupsPerUserQuota = "GroupsPerUserQuota" // SummaryKeyTypeSigningCertificatesPerUserQuota is a summaryKeyType enum value SummaryKeyTypeSigningCertificatesPerUserQuota = "SigningCertificatesPerUserQuota" // SummaryKeyTypeAccessKeysPerUserQuota is a summaryKeyType enum value SummaryKeyTypeAccessKeysPerUserQuota = "AccessKeysPerUserQuota" // SummaryKeyTypeMfadevices is a summaryKeyType enum value SummaryKeyTypeMfadevices = "MFADevices" // SummaryKeyTypeMfadevicesInUse is a summaryKeyType enum value SummaryKeyTypeMfadevicesInUse = "MFADevicesInUse" // SummaryKeyTypeAccountMfaenabled is a summaryKeyType enum value SummaryKeyTypeAccountMfaenabled = "AccountMFAEnabled" // SummaryKeyTypeAccountAccessKeysPresent is a summaryKeyType enum value SummaryKeyTypeAccountAccessKeysPresent = "AccountAccessKeysPresent" // SummaryKeyTypeAccountSigningCertificatesPresent is a summaryKeyType enum value SummaryKeyTypeAccountSigningCertificatesPresent = "AccountSigningCertificatesPresent" // SummaryKeyTypeAttachedPoliciesPerGroupQuota is a summaryKeyType enum value SummaryKeyTypeAttachedPoliciesPerGroupQuota = "AttachedPoliciesPerGroupQuota" // SummaryKeyTypeAttachedPoliciesPerRoleQuota is a summaryKeyType enum value SummaryKeyTypeAttachedPoliciesPerRoleQuota = "AttachedPoliciesPerRoleQuota" // SummaryKeyTypeAttachedPoliciesPerUserQuota is a summaryKeyType enum value SummaryKeyTypeAttachedPoliciesPerUserQuota = "AttachedPoliciesPerUserQuota" // SummaryKeyTypePolicies is a summaryKeyType enum value SummaryKeyTypePolicies = "Policies" // SummaryKeyTypePoliciesQuota is a summaryKeyType enum value SummaryKeyTypePoliciesQuota = "PoliciesQuota" // SummaryKeyTypePolicySizeQuota is a summaryKeyType enum value SummaryKeyTypePolicySizeQuota = "PolicySizeQuota" // SummaryKeyTypePolicyVersionsInUse is a summaryKeyType enum value SummaryKeyTypePolicyVersionsInUse = "PolicyVersionsInUse" // SummaryKeyTypePolicyVersionsInUseQuota is a summaryKeyType enum value SummaryKeyTypePolicyVersionsInUseQuota = "PolicyVersionsInUseQuota" // SummaryKeyTypeVersionsPerPolicyQuota is a summaryKeyType enum value SummaryKeyTypeVersionsPerPolicyQuota = "VersionsPerPolicyQuota" )